132 26 17MB
English Pages [284] Year 1972
Understanding The Scientific Bases of
Human Movement ALICE
L O'CONNELL,
ELIZABETH
B.
Ph.D.
GARDNER,
Ph.D.
Understanding
The
Scientific
Bases of
Human Movement
Understanding The Scientific Bases of
Human Movement ALICE
L O'CONNELL,
Ph.D.
F.A.C.S.M.: F.A.A.H.P.E.R. Associate Professor of Biomechanics
Boston University Sargent College of Allied Health Professions
ELIZABETH
B.
GARDNER,
Ph.D.
F.A.C.S.M.
and Physiology, Emerita Boston University Sargent College of Allied Health Professions Professor of Biology
The Williams
& Wilkins Co.
Baltimore 1972
^osSspJF
Copyright ©, 1972
The Williams & Wilkins Company 428 E. Preston Street Baltimore,
Md.
21202, U.S.A.
book is protected by copyright. No part of book may be reproduced in any form or by any means, including photocopying, or utilized by any information storage and retrieval system without written permission from the copyright owner. All rights reserved. This this
Made
in the
United States of America
Library of Congress Catalog Card SBN 683-06622-6
Composed and printed
at the
Waverly Press, Inc. Mt. Royal and Guilford Aves. Baltimore,
Md.
Reprinted 1973
21202, U.S.A.
Number
78-188932
is dedicated to Ruth B. Glassow who has stimulated and inspired many, including the authors, to pursue the study of human movement.
77ms book so
The authors wish
to record their gratitude to the Boston University Graduate School for a grant-in-aid which contributed to the preparation of this manuscript.
Foreword The term kinesiology, long used in referring to the science or study of human motion, has been giving way to the term biomechanics. Certainly this latter term is more self-explanatory and hence its rising popularity. In the past half century the change in the content of textbooks in this field reflects the changing concepts of kinesiology: the early texts were basically applications of the principles of anatomy and mechanics to human movement. Some physiology of muscle was included, and a little material on the central nervous system was added as that field advanced. The neuromuscular physiology which appeared in these early kinesiological texts it
was greatly
seems that way now
simplified, or perhaps
in the light of our present
knowl-
edge.
Early kinesiologists were concerned primarily with the anatomy of motion: with action occuring at the different joints with the identity of muscles that could produce these actions and. in many cases, with the use of this knowledge to develop those particular muscles to a high peak of efficiency. That this is still the case with a majority of the kinesiology instructors of undergraduate students today is illustrated indirectly by a survey made during the middle 1960's by Neuberger of Eastern Michigan University which was concerned with the visual aids used by these instructors. Of the replies reported in detail. 60% leaned very heavily to almost entirely on anatomical materials. Also, of the seven best known kinesiology texts on the market as this is written, all but two devote 50% or more of their content to musculoskeletal anatomy, and some labora-
manuals do likewise. However, we seem to be moving away from the applied anatomy concept; the trend in some instances has swung so far afield that there appeared a tendency to include the effects of emotions, physiological condition, progress in motor learning, etc. under a kinesiological umbrella. This text has no such ambitions: it is written for those kinesiologists who are concerned with the rapidly expanding ways and means of studying, and so arriving at a better understanding of. human motor control. tory
Today the modem kinesiologist asks many questions about human movement and eagerly seeks the answers. He not only wants to know what movement pattern(s) or sequence of movements is involved in a given skill,
but how those movements can be made more efficient. This in turn involves him in seeking answers to a number of other questions such as: What is the mass of the body, body part(s), or extremity? What is the angular or linear acceleration of a body, body segment, or extremity? What force does a body, or body part, exert as a re-
mass and acceleration? How, and in what direction, is this
sult of its
force applied to an external object, (ball, club, discus, etc.) or to the body itself (as in
jumping
or running)?
Where is the center of gravity of the body, not only when it is motionless but during performance of a motor skill?
Where
the center of gravity of any combination of an entire or partial extremity, the entire or upper trunk plus one or both upper limbs, the entire or lower trunk plus one or both of the lower limbs,
body
is
parts: e.g.,
etc.?
What is the angular velocity of a body segment at any given instant? What linear velocity becomes available at the distal end of a kinematic chain as a result of the angular velocity of a particular joint action, and which can be imparted to a ball or other throwing or striking implement? Finding these answers is made possible by our modern technology. The motion picture camera with speeds ranging up to thousands of frames per second provides the means for capturing a single motor performance for an indefinite period of study. Repeated viewing of the film with the aid of a time-motion study projector, a film editor-viewer or a microfilm reader gives ample opportunity for analysis. Finally, as has been illustrated by Plagenhoef* at the University of Michigan and then by Garrett et al.,t the computer can be elegantly used to *
Plagenhoef, S.
netics of Selected
C, 1962. An Analysis of the Kinematics and KiSymmetrical Body Actions. Doctoral Dissertation,
University of Michigan. t Garrett, R. E., Widule, C. J., and Garrett, G. E., 1968. Computer aided analysis. Kinesiol. Rev. pp. 1-4; Garrett, G. E., Widule, C. J., Reed, W. S., and Garrett, R. E., 1969. Human movement via
computer graphics. Paper presented
at convention of the
American
Association for Health, Physical Education and Recreation, Boston, 1969.
vii
VIM
FOREWORD
expedite matters. Many of the available methods for attaining these answers and for using various of .the investigative tools* available will be found in the text of this book.
Perhaps more difficult to answer are the questions asked by some of today's kinesiologists involving the initiation of movement and control of the body in performing motor skills. They are aware that true understanding of human movement requires knowledge of the means by which the central nervous system integrates proprioceptive input and coordinates the activity of the muscles so that each will contribute properly to the intended movement. However, knowledge of the functioning of the nervous system is now so extensive and is increasing so rapidly that it is difficult for the neurophysiologist, and impossible for the layman, to keep abreast of it. There is therefore a real need for material which will assist the kinesiologist in maintaining a general overview of advances in this area which may be of significance to his field. Up to the present, relatively few writers in the fields of physical education and physical therapy have been able to write in this field with assurance and authority. Hopefully, however, this situation is in the process of change. This text is one of *
Methodology of computer usage per
in this text.
se has not
been included
first to attempt to interpret and apply some of the expanding knowledge of neurophysiology to the field of motor performance. It includes four chapters on the neuromuscular bases of movement (Chapters 10 to 13), to supplement the too often scanty coverage of such information in undergraduate curricula. The inclusion of Section III on proprioceptive reflexes is unique with this text and is presented to provide a background for en-
the
larging the scope of kinesiological analysis. The final chapter deals with speculative postulations of reflex involvement in certain skills. It is offered in the hope that it may encourage the kinesiologist to include consideration of this aspect of human movement in his analysis and research, to recognize and investigate reflexes which may be assisting a performance, and to identify those which may be interfering and require voluntary inhibition. With such information available, he should be better equipped to understand the difficulties encountered by the beginner in learning a new skill, and why the use of one method or technique produces better results than another. He can then improve the best of the older techniques and design new and more effective methods based on his expanded knowl-
edge. A. L. O'C. E. B. G.
Contents SECTION TWO KINETICS
Foreword
chapter 6. The Laws of Motion and Energy Newton's Laws of Motion
Part I
BIOMECHANICS
Momentum Energy
SECTION ONE
KINEMATICS chapter
1
Skeletal
.
Joint Axes
Mechanisms
and Degrees
of
Freedom
3 3
Links and Chains
3
Movements
6
Joint
2. Mechanics of Muscle Action Muscle Classification Muscle Function Muscle Attachments and Their Effect on Function Application of Muscle Force to Skeletal
chapter
Levers
The Range
Classification of Levers
Torque
4. Motion Types of Motion
chapter
Human Motion Mechanics of Motion Linear Motion
Relation to
Rotational Movement Circular Motion 5.
chapter 9. Kinetic Analysis: Statics 113 Location of Line of Gravity by Segmental
Kinematics of
Human Movement
Analysis: The Scale Usefulness of Motion and Static Analysis Acceleration of Body Parts Analysis of Segmental Velocities
Value Determining Segmental Velocities
Equilib103 103 107
Method
113
Determinations of Estimates of Total Muscle Force 114 Compression Forces at the Acetabulum 119
39 39
Part II
NEUROMUSCULAR INTEGRATION
49 49 49 49 52
chapter
54
tal
56
Movement Analysis Sample of Movement
Gravity,
Locating the Center of Gravity Equilibrium
41 41
Moment Arms
chapter
32
8.
rium
36
Leverage
3.
29 29 29
Muscle Extensibility and Con-
tractility
cr\pter
Equilibrating Forces
chapter
35 of
77 78 81
85 85 86 88 88 98
chapter 7. Forces Mass. Weight, and Gravity Force Relations Typical Problems Met in Force Analysis Composition and Resolution of Forces
Man, and His
77
59 59 61 64 64 64 72
SECTION ONE
PHYSIOLOGY OF SKELETAL MUSCLE 10.
Structure and Chemistry of Skele-
Muscle Introduction Properties of Skeletal Muscle Structure of Skeletal Muscle The Nature of Contraction
127 127 127 127 134
Summary
144
chapter 11. Factors Which Affect the nitude of Contractile Tension The Magnitude of Contractile Tension
Mag147 147 ix
CONTENTS
Summary
159
Analysis
chapter
15.
flexes in
Motor
Involvement
of
Proprioceptive
Re223 223 226
Skills in
Motor
Skills
Neurokinesiological Analyses
SECTION
TWO
Types of Reflex Activity to be Identified Motor Skills Proprioceptors and Physical Education
NEUROPHYSIOLOGY chapter
12. Basic Neurophysiology The Neuron: Structure and Function Structure and Function of the Synapse
161 161 168
13. Basic Organization of the Neuromuscular System 179 The Sensory System: Structure and Function
chapter
of Receptors
179 184 188 191
The Motor System: Motor Units The Integrative System: Neural Circuits
Summary SECTION THREE
THE INTEGRATIVE ROLE OF THE PROPRIOCEPTIVE REFLEXES
appendix
in
231 231
A
Figure A.l. Link boundaries (at the joint centers) and percentage of distance of the cen233 ters of gravity from link boundaries appendix
B
Table B.l.
A, average segment characteristics of three cadavers dissected by Braune and Fischer (1889). B, average segment characteristics of two cadavers described bv Braune and Fischer (1892) 235 Table B.2. Average segment characteristics of 235 eight cadavers Table B.3. Location of centers of gravity of body
segments Table B.4. Specific gravity of body segments Table B.5. Segmental fractions of body weight according to somatotype Table B.6. Regression equations for calculating mass (in kg) of body segments Table B.7. Gravity and distance .
chapter 14. The Proprioceptors Associated Reflexes
and
Introduction Muscle Proprioceptors Joint and Cutaneous Receptors Labyrinthine and Neck Receptors Role of Reflexes in Skilled Movement
Their 193 193 194 209 212
219
APPENDIX
C
Table C.
1.
.
Tables of the trigonometric functions
.
236 237
238 238 239
241
Part I
BIOMECHANICS
Introduction There are two approaches to the study of the mechanics of human motion, the kinematic and the kinetic. The kinematic approach is purely descriptive, concerned with the geometry and temporal qualities of motion. While forces may be named or described, there is no attempt to quantify them, no concern for the size or direction of the forces involved. On the other hand, the kinetic approach to the study of movement is concerned with the forces that produce or change the state of rest or motion of a body. It determines the size and direction of the forces, their points of application, the ultimate results and resultant of the forces involved. The human body is a complicated apparatus, selfmaintaining, self-regulatory, and autonomous. It is also a system of levers whose cores are formed of long, short, or irregularly shaped bones linked together by capsules reinforced by ligaments to form joints. This system, although controlled and operated by the central nervous system's neural control of muscular tension, obeys all of the laws of mechanics involving both statics and dynamics. Statics deals with bodies at rest and forces in equilibrium, while dynamics is concerned with bodies in motion. A model who sits or poses for a photographer or artist is an example of statics as the body must be held motionless for a given period of time. The muscular effort required naturally depends on the assumed pose. The muscles must exert enough force to counteract the pull of gravity on the body parts so that equilibrium is established between gravitational force and the force exerted by the muscles. As long as the pose is held, this balance of forces is maintained and the situation remains static. As the force of gravity is constant, any increase or decrease in muscular force will result in movement, and the situation changes from static to dynamic.
Kinematic Analysis If
the kinesiologist limits himself to describing the
pose, i.e., the anatomical position of each joint and body segment, and names the muscles that he believes
are responsible for maintaining the pose, the analysis is anatomical as well as kinematic. If, under the changing conditions indicated above, he limits himself to stating whether there is (1) an increase in muscular force moving the body segment or segments against gravity or (2) a decrease in muscular tension which allows a segment or segments to move with gravity, and if he names the resulting movements and the segments moved, he is still making a kinematic analysis. Also, if when the pose is broken he determines the accelerations or velocities of joint and/or segment movement, or the direction and amount of change of the position of the center of gravity and its acceleration and/or velocity, he is continuing with the kinematic analysis of a now dynamic situation.
Kinetic Analysis
However,
the kinesiologist calculates the forces the muscles in supporting the pose and the compression forces being exerted on the major and/or weight-bearing joints as a result of the muscle tension and gravity, the analysis has become or force
if
moments exerted by
kinetic.
The first section of this part of the book is concerned with kinematics and presents the tools necessary for kinematic analyses of human movement. At the same time it presents many related concepts which should be of value to any student of human movement. Finally, all of these are applied to sample analyses of motor
skills in
Chapter
5.
The second
section deals with kinetics: the forces which act on the body, those which the body can exert, and the equilibrium which may or may not exist between them. As in Section I, the early chapters present the tools and concepts of analysis, while the use of these tools
Chapter
9.
in
a
sample analysis
is
presented in
SECTION ONE
CHAPTER
KINEMATICS
Skeletal
I
Mechanisms
The
skeletal system is the bony framework that supbody organs, protects many of them, and forms the hard core of all bodv segments. Its manv articula-
ports
tions provide mobility,
and
mobile articulations that
is
it is the function of these the concern of the kinesiolo-
gist.
JOINT AXES AND DEGREES OF FREEDOM Both the anatomist and the kinesiologist speak of
tween the
and as
a limited
joints as being uniaxial, biaxial, or multiaxial
having certain degrees of freedom (Steindler; Brunnstrom: Tern and Trotter). A joint with only one axis (uniaxial!: has one degree of freedom: that is to say, the articulating bones can move only in one plane. Examples in the human body include hinge and pivot joints. Hinge joints occur at the elbow, knee, interphalangeal. and ankle joints. The pivot joints are the -
atlantooccipital in the vertebral column and the radioulnar joints in the forearm. Joints that can move about two axes (biaxial) have two degrees of freedom and so
produce movement in two different planes. The wrist. the metacarpophalangeal and the metatarsophalangeal joints are biaxial. Joints that can permit movement in all three planes have three degrees of freedom but are called multiaxial by the anatomist rather than triaxial, as movement can occur in oblique planes as well as in the three cardinal planes. socket joints at the
Examples include the ball and hips and shoulders and the
numerous plane joints of the axial skeleton. In this instance the term "plane" is an adjective referring to the almost flat articular surfaces which can glide over one another, with movement being limited only by ligaments or by the joint capsule. Examples include those joints between the articular processes of the vertebrae and be-
LINKS
the degrees of freedom of the pianist's fingertips involved listing the joints occurring between the distal phalanges and the pelvis. These joints unite the various body segments which move upon each other in the manner of links in a chain. The concept of links and chains, first used by engineers, can be applied very elegantly by the kinesiologist to many phases of the study and analysis of movement.
Links in the Body first
degrees of freedom. For the kinesiologist there is a distinct advantage in using the term "degrees of freedom." While no one joint can have more than three degrees of freedom, the degrees at adjacent joints can be summed to express the total
amount
of freedom of motion of a distal
segment
proximal one. For instance, the distal phalanges of a pianist enjoy 17 degrees of freedom relative to his trunk: one degree at each of the distal and proximal phalangeal joints; two degrees at the metacarpophalangeal joints; two degrees at the wrist joint; one degree in the forearm at the radioulnar joints; one degree at the elbow; three degrees at the shoulder; relative
to a
three degrees at the acromioclavicular joint; three degrees at the sternoclavicular joint. Observation of many pianists might, however, lead us to add three more degrees of freedom arising from the motion in the vertebral column. This would express the freedom of the phalanges relative to the pelvis which is resting on the piano bench, rather than relative to his torso, making a total of 20 degrees of freedom available at the fingertips.
AND CHAINS
Summing up
Dempster was the
ribs and the vertebrae. These joints have such amount of movement at any one articulation that total movement of the torso occurs only because of the combined action of many or all of the joints and their
kinesiologist to adapt the link
concept to the problems involving kinetic and kinematic treatment of movements of the human body. Since engineering links involve overlapping articulating members held together by pins which act as axes of rotation. a link is considered to be a straight line of constant length running from axis to axis. A system of links is essentially a geometric entity for analysis of motion by geometric or kinematic methods. "...In engineering mechanisms the links move in relation to a framework, and this framework itself forms a link in the system. Thus, to transmit power, the links of machinery must
UNDERSTANDING THE
SCIENTIFIC
BASES OF HUMAN MOVEMENT
form a closed system in which the motion of one link has determinate relations to every other link in the system" (Reuleaux, quoted by Dempster). In the appendicular skeleton a body segment consists of a hard core made up of one or more bones enclosed in an irregular mass of soft tissue (muscle, connective
and skin). Ligaments and muscle tendons cross the joint between contiguous body segments, anchoring to the adjacent bone or bones and holding the segments together. The axis around which one segment moves on tissue,
another generally passes through one of the bones through an area near the joint; e.g., the axis for knee flexion and extension passes through the epicondyles of the femur (Fig. 1.13; see also Figs. 1.7 through 1.15 for locations of other joint axes). Thus during flexion and extension of the knee, the tibia moves around this axis which is constantly changing because of the shape of the femoral condyles, while at the same time it is gliding over these condyles. When the person is stand-
Kinematic Chains Reuleaux also introduced the term "kinematic chain" system of links. In engineering, the chain forms a closed system where, as quoted earlier, "the motion of one link has determinate relato refer to a mechanical
tions to every other link in the system,"
and "the closed
system assures that forces are transmitted in positive predetermined ways." Thus in engineering a kinematic chain is a closed system of links joined in such a manner that if any one is moved on a fixed link, all of the other links will move in a predictable pattern (Fig. 1.2). This
ing, the distal tibiofibular configuration rotates around an axis through the talus (and the two malleoli) when the leg moves over the talar head during forward or backward body sways (Fig. 1.14). Because the bones of the body rarely overlap at joints as at the ankle and, except for the atlantoaxial joint, have no pin-centered axes, and because at many joints movement can occur in different directions and planes, the engineering concept of links must be redefined to fit the need of the kinesiologist. Dempster has proposed the use of the term "link" in kinesiology as the distance between joint axes; e.g., the leg link becomes the linear distance between the joint axes passing through the distal end of the femur and the proximal end of the talus (or through the two malleoli), thus spanning both the knee and ankle joints (Fig. 1.1). Figure 9.2 in Chapter 9 on kinetics is a scale drawing made from actual
measurements of the in the same chapter.
links of the subject in Figure 9.1.
Leg Link
FIGURE FIGURE
1.1.
Leg
link.
1.2.
Types
of closed kinematic chains. All joints are
pin-centered and free to move.
Skeletal is
not true
m
the living body.
With
Mectunisms
tew exceptions the
system of skeletal links is not composed oi closed chains but of open ones, as the peripheral ends of the extrenu ties are tree (Pig. L.3). Forces may be transmitted in positive ways, predetermined by the central nervous system, but the central nervous system is notorious for never accomplishing the same act in exactly the same nay from one time to the next, even though the external results may appear similar. Thus when speaking of a living kinematic chain, we are usually speaking of a
FIGURE
1.4.
Example suggested by Steindler
of a
human
closed
kinematic chain.
in an open system, whose dimenby the linear distance from joint axis to joint axis, ignoring muscle mass, bone structure, and type of articulation between body segments. Although most living kinematic chains are open, Brunnstrom defines two closed kinematic chains in the body. The first is the pelvic girdle, which is made up of three bony segments united at the two sacroiliac joints and at the symphysis pubis. This can hardly be classified as a kinematic chain because normally no movement occurs at the joints mentioned. Dempster classes
series of links
arranged
sions are determined
the pelvis as a single triangular link (Fig. 1.3). The second closed kinematic chain in the body according to Brunnstrom is the thorax where the upper 10 ribs are jointed to the vertebral column and sternum. The rib cage, however, does constitute a system of closed kinematic chains because the upper 10 ribs of the left side cannot move without similar movement by the upper 10 ribs of the right side when they lift the sternum on inhalation. Steindler* considers a closed living chain (which he terms kinetic rather than kinematic) to exist in "all situations in which the peripheral joint of the chain meets with overwhelming resistance" (Fig. 1.4).
FIGURE
The human skeleton as a system of links. (From T.. 1955. Space Requirements for the Seated Operator Wright Air Development Center Technical Report 55159 Dempster.
1.3.
W
* While Brunnstrom and Steindler used the term "chain" modified by kinematic or kinetic respectively when referring to a series of body segments, they did not use the term "links" in their discussions.
UNDERSTANDING THE
SCIENTIFIC BASES OF
HUMAN MOVEMENT
JOINT MOVEMENTS The type and range of movement at any given joint depend upon the structure of the joint and the number of its axes, the restraint imposed by ligaments and muscles crossing the joint, and the bulk of adjacent tissue. A joint with three degrees of freedom may because of its structure have a very limited range of motion as was indicated earlier in regard to the intervertebral joints, while a joint with only one degree of freedom may have a large range of motion. For example, the forearm can move through an average range of 150° from the position in line with the arm to full flexion. The range may be increased by from 5 to 15° in the individual who has a smaller than average olecranon process or a deeper than average olecranon fossa which permits the forearm to hyperextend. Conversely, in an individual with overdeveloped biceps and brachialis muscles or with excessive adipose tissue, flexion may be limited by the very bulk of the soft tissue of the arm. Similar factors can also affect the range of mobility of
straightens the joint. While this definition is adequate it is not applicable to all joints. A more satisfactory one which can be applied to all except the
to a degree,
shoulder joints is based on the anatomical concept that flexion is the approximation of ventral or volar surfaces. This concept is based on the embryological development of the human fetus. Soon after the limb buds first appear in the embryo (Fig. 1.16. A), they project laterally with the thumbs and great toes uppermost (Fig. 1.16.B). As the limbs develop, they bend ventrad at the elbows and knees so that the apices of these joints are pointed outward and the palms of the hands and soles of the feet (the volar surfaces) face the torso (Fig. 1.16.C). Finally, both pairs of limbs rotate 90° but in opposite directions, the rotations taking place about the long axes of the limbs (Fig. 1.16.D). The upper
other joints. The following discussion presents a brief review of the motions occurring at the various joints, the axes around which these movements take place, and the plane in which the body part or parts are moved as a result of the joint action. As all movements are described as being initiated from the anatomical position (Fig. 1.5), each body part will generally* move in a plane parallel to one of the three primary planest of the body, i.e., the midsagittal, frontal (or coronal), or transverse plane. The midsagittal plane divides the body into right and left halves (Fig. 1.6. A), and any plane parallel to it is known as a sagittal plane. Similarly the primary frontal plane divides the body anteroposteriad into front and back halves (Fig. 1.6.B), and any plane parallel to it is known as a frontal plane. The third primary plane is transverse and divides the body into upper and lower halves (Fig. 1.6. C), and all horizontal planes parallel to it are also known as transverse planes. The typical motions are presented first, followed by special cases, e.g., movements of the forearm, foot, etc. (Figs. 1.7 to 1.15).
Flexion-Extension Flexion and extension are movements in which the moving segments travel in a sagittalf plane around a horizontal axis defined by anatomical frontal and transverse planest through the axis. Flexion is popularly considered to be a movement which decreases the angle between the moving part and the adjacent segment (as in
to
elbow or finger flexion), and extension is considered be a movement which increases this angle or
* It
is
recognized that
which are oblique
many movements
to the three
occur
at multiaxial joints
perpendicular planes, but these are
considered as combinations of the primary movements discussed here. t
As each primary plane divides the body into equal
halves, these
planes must pass through the center of gravity of the body.
FIGURE
1.5.
Anatomical position.
Skeletal Mrch.inisms
B FIGURE
1.6.
Medial planes of the body.
A. sagittal plane.
FIGURE
1.6.
B, frontal plane.
FIGURE
1.6.
C. transverse plane.
FIGURE L.
Major axes of the shoulder girdle as seen from above.
1.7.
retraction
of the
shoulder girdle;
T,
transverse axis for elevation
longitudinal axis for the limited rotational
axis at the acromial J. C.
ton
B..
end
and Smith. C
Company
movements
V. vertical axis for
of the clavicle.
VA
.
vertical axis,
of clavicle for scapular motion. (Joint axes in Figures
G..
1953.
In
Morris'
Human Anatomy,
protraction and
and depression of the shoulder
edited by
J. P.
17
to 1.15
and TA
drawn
New
Schaeffer
York:
.
girdle;
transverse
after Grant.
The
Blakis-
)
V
T-F
FIGURE
1.8.
Axes
for
movements
axis in the frontal plane for
at the shoulder joint. A. from the anatomical position
movements
of flexion
and extension; T-S. transverse axis
in
T-F, transverse
the sagittal plane for
movements of abduction and adduction; V. vertical axis running the length of the humerus for movements of inward and outward rotation of the arm. B, same axes but arm is abducted 90°. Note altered positions of T-F axes.
Skeletal
FIGURE
1.9.
ments are
flexion
Transverse Axis through the elbow
joint.
Mechanisms
Move-
and extension
B FIGURE
1.11.
transverse
extension
of the
metacarpals metacarpal
Axes
phalangeal for
axes
of the
axes
fingers:
ab-
not
and
V.
the
The
fingers;
plane
frontal
volar-dorsal
adduction
shown.
A.
fingers.
in
of
axis
the
B.
thumb.
for
flexion
through the
fingers
First
metatarsophalangeal
terphalangeal axes of the foot are similar.
T-F,
and distal
carpo-
and
in-
FIGURE 1.10. Axes of the forearm and wrist. L. long axis of the forearm for pronation and supination; T-F, compromise transverse axis in the frontal plane for wrist flexion
dorsal wrist.
axis
for
radial
and
ulnar
and extension; V. volarof the hand at the
deviation
10
UNDERSTANDING THE
FIGURE
1.12.
Axes
for
SCIENTIFIC BASES OF
movements
HUMAN MOVEMENT
at the hip joint. T-F. transverse axis
in
the frontal plane for flexion
and extension of the thigh. T-S, transverse axis in the sagittal plane for ab- and adduction of the thigh; V. vertical axis for inward and outward (lateral and medial) rotation of the thigh. Note location of axis through the lower limb
in B.
FIGURE in
the
1.14.
frontal
Axes plane
of the ankle
and
foot.
T-F. transverse axis
passing through both malleoli and the talar
head The only movements are dorsi- and plantar flexion. A and are compromise axes for inversion and eversion at the intertarsal through the talo-calcaneal joints. A through Chopart's joint and and talonavicular joints
FIGURE 1 axis m the axis
13.
Axes through the knee
frontal
plane
around which the
tibia
for
flexion
joint.
T-F.
and extension;
can rotate when the knee
is
transverse V.
vertical
flexed
FIGURE movement
1.15. of
Joint the
axes of the axial skeleton. A. axes on the vertebrae. 0-S. oblique axis
skull
the sagittal plane for lateral flexion of the head; axis in the frontal plane for dorsiV. vertical axis for
FIGURE
head
rotation, right
in
transverse
and ventriflexion of the head; and left.
1.15. B. axes for movement of one vertebra on the adjacent one below; 1. cervical. 2, thoracic. 3. lumbar vertebrae 0-S. oblique axis in the sagittal plane for movements of rotation combined with abduction; T-F. transverse axis in the frontal plane for movements of flexion and extension; T-S. transverse axis in the sagittal plane for movements of lateral flexion (abduction) right and left
11
T-F.
for
12
UNDERSTANDING THE
SCIENTIFIC BASES OF
HUMAN MOVEMENT ext
limb
auditory meatus
W
bud
pericardial liver bu
pericardial
swelling
FIGURE
1.16.
Langman, J, Williams
&
The human embryo. A. at 5 weeks: B. at 6 weeks; C. at 7 weeks: D. at 8 weeks. (From 1969. Medical Embryology Human Development. Normal and Abnormal Baltimore: The
Wilkins
Company
)
extremities rotate laterad so that the elbow points backward, the thumbs are outward, and the ventral and surfaces face forward. The lower extremity rotates mediad so that the knees point forward, the great toes are inward, and the ventral surfaces face backward, as do the soles of the feet (volar surface) when one is standing on the toes. The proximal surface of the limbs retains its embryological orientation in the regions of the axillae and groin. Because of this situation a large portion of the upper part of the thigh still presents some ventral surface on the anterior aspect, therefore a movement of the lower extremity forward and upward at the hip joint is an approximation of ventral surfaces and conforms to the definition of flexion (Fig. 1.17.B). Because the rotation is complete at the knee, flexion of this joint also meets the anatomical definition. Shoulder flexion and extension are not easily reconciled to either definition, so these movements are correlated with the direction of the movements at the hip: flexion of the arm at the shoulder is defined as movement forward and upward in the sagittal plane and extension as movement downward and backward in the same plane (Fig. 1.18). Flexion of the elbow, wrist, fingers, toes, and vertebral volar (palmar)
all conform to both concepts: i.e.. the anatomiconcept of approximating the ventral or volar surfaces and the popular concept of decreasing the angle between the body segments. Extension of these same joints is. of course, movement in the opposite direction. However, this agreement between anatomical and popular definitions breaks down when the concepts on which the definitions are based are applied to the movements occurring at the ankle joint. Study of Figure 1.19. A illustrates the divergence. Decrease of the angle between the foot and the leg, anatomical extension, is popularly called ankle flexion: "pointing the toes." anatomical flexion, is popularly known as ankle extension. If Figure 1.19.B is consulted one sees how the anatomical terminology is arrived at. Because of this paradoxical situation the term dorsiflexion has been adopted for anatomical extension/ popular flexion, and plantar flexion is the term applied for anatomical flexion/popular extension.
column cal
Abduction- Adduction This pair of movements takes place in the frontal plane and occurs at biaxial (metacarpophalangeal and
Skeletal
FIGURE
1.17.
A, hip extension.
FIGURE
1.17.
Mechanisms
B, hip flexion.
FIGURE
1.18.
A, shoulder extension.
FIGURE
FIGURE
1.19.
B,
lateral
1.18.
1.19. flexion.
Movements
the ankle joint. A, dorsi- and and Recording Joint Motion. of Orthopaedic Surgeons.)
(From
American Academy
1.
anterior surface of leg.
lateral
homo-
1' 2. Instep or dorsum of the foot, homologous to the back of the hand. 2'. 3, Sole of foot, homologous to palm of the hand. 3'. 4, Back of leg. homologous ventral surface of forearm. 4'. 5. Popliteal fossa homologous to the cubital fossa
logous to back of forearm.
FIGURE
shoulder flexion.
aspect of right lower extremity: C.
aspect of right upper extremity
plantar
B,
at
Measuring
of the forearm. 5'.
14
Skeletal
FIGURE
1.20.
Abduction-adduction. A, abduction
metatarsophalangeal) joints and at multiaxial (shoulder, and first carpometacarpal) joints. Abduction of the fingers and toes is movement away from the middle digit, while adduction is movement toward that digit. Abduction at a ball and socket joint (shoulder or hipl is movement of the limb upward and away from the midline (Fig. 1.20.A). At the glenohumeral joint the arm can be raised only 90° before the greater tuberosity of the humerus contacts the acromion process. Further abduction is accomplished by upward rotation of the glenoid fossa of the scapula (Fig. 1.21).* As a result the total range of abduction of the upper extremity can be as much as 180° In adduction of either the upper or lower extremity the limb may be drawn across the midline of the body (Fig. 1.20.B). hip.
.
Circumduction This *
may
occur at any biaxial or multiaxial joint and
is
See also discussion under "Movements of the Scapula," below.
at
both shoulders and at the right
Mechanisms
hip.
a combination of flexion-abduction-extension-adduction or the reverse, and it may involve rotation of the limb concerned. The extremity travels in a cone-shaped path with the apex at the fulcrum of the joint at which the movement originates (Fig. 1.22).
Horizontal Flexion-Extension Horizontal flexion is performed by the upper extremity from a position of abduction; the motion of the extremity is in a horizontal plane and the limb is carried forward across the front of the body. Horizontal extension is similar movement in the opposite direction (Fig. 1.23). There has been a tendency among therapists to use the term horizontal adduction for horizontal flexion because the arm is moved across the midline of the body. It should be noted, however, that those horizontal movements occur around the same axis through the head of the humerus as do flexion and extension of the
16
UNDERSTANDING THE
SCIENTIFIC BASES OF
HUMAN MOVEMENT
180
180
RANGE OF TRUE GLENOHUMERAL MOTION
180*
COMBINED GLENOHUMERAL AND SCAPUL0TH0RACIC MOTION
FIGURE of the
1.21.
Recording
FIGURE
1.20.
B.
adduction at both shoulders and at the right hip
Glenohumeral motion. Note the upward
Surgeons.)
Joint
Motion.
rotation
completed (From Measuring and American Academy of Orthopaedic
scapula as abduction
is
Skeletal Mcch.
•»
a
W mutw If'
w * »» S**tL,caEH
IP
at
"
.
!'"'
^^
K^afA! .
53
Pill _
IiKa" jrJ*
_J«i."H_
r^ f iirr
tcSM «»
g
-l
*LrkS jfciV.i. a^M? -'AIM
Bar
Vav
90
E>
'
!7JBP 1 IN Jlpr' 1
\vf
»*.* ai-a
"IE
J*» *Li
iSMI
:crajj
.»•»
BEt*' !
FIGURE
a
«Lii **&
iirr
:'i>
'v
FIGURE
4.5. Relation
between time,
= 128 8
ft/sec
velocities, length of drop,
and the acceleration due to
gravity.
53
UNDERSTANDING THE
54
SCIENTIFIC BASES OF
HUMAN MOVEMENT
ROTATIONAL MOVEMENT Rotation of a body about a fixed point or axis causes any portion of that body to travel in a circular path as it undergoes angular displacement. As this occurs when any body segment moves on another (rotatory motion), it behooves the kinesiologist to have some
mass about the axis of rotation. The average of the sum of the perpendicular distances (^ r) is also called the radius of gyration k, so that:
understanding of the laws governing such action.
The
Torque or
Moment
of Force
it is the size of the moment that increases or decreases the angular velocity of a body and so produces acceleration or deceleration of the
in a straight line:
its
moment
Eq. 4.9
is
defined as the distance
of inertia.
The moment
of inertia
is
the measure of the resist-
ance of a body at rest to rotatory motion or, if rotating, to change its state of rotation. As torque exerts a turning force on a body, it is analogous to the force in the equation F = ma. Therefore it can be stated that:
movement.
= Io
Angular Velocity and Acceleration
As a body rotates about a fixed axis, each and every particle of that body travels in an arc and moves through the same angular displacement 6 (the Greek letter theta) in the same amount of time. The body may rotate with a fixed speed or constant velocity, or the rotatory speed may increase or decrease. The same principles as those used in determining linear velocities
radius of gyration itself
2
from the axis of rotation of a point at which the total mass of a body might be concentrated without changing
In dealing with rotational movements or motion, the moment or torque (see Chapter 3 under "Torque") fulfills the same function that force performs for motion
rotational
mk
/ =
and accelerations
are applied in calculating the
Eq. 4.10
Torque is equal to the product of the moment of inertia and the angular acceleration and so is analogous to force F as / is analogous to mass m and a to acceleration a in linear motion.
Angular Motion Linear
momentum P equals the momentum A
velocity, so angular
moment
of inertia
product of mass and the product of the
is
and the angular velocity:
angular counterparts:
A
= Iw
Eq. 4.11
Angular
Linear s
Eq. 4.6 I
IF THE SYSTEM IS CLOSED AND THERE IS NO EXTERNAL TORQUE ACTING ON THE SYSTEM, THE TOTAL ANGULAR MOMENTUM REMAINS UNCHANGED, EVEN THOUGH THE MOMENT OF INERTIA MAY BE ALTERED This is the law of conservation of angular momentum. Note that while the quantity of mass remains unchanged, r or k (and so r 2 or .
h
Angular velocity
uj
-
to
/i
(the
analog of linear velocity
a
(the
Greek
-
Eq. 4.7 to
Greek letter omega) is the u, and angular acceleration
letter alpha)
is
the analog of linear ac-
celeration a.
Moment
of Inertia
discussing Newton's First Law (see Chapter 6) it is mentioned that the terms mass and inertia could be used interchangeably. In rotational movement the moment of inertia / is the analog of mass in linear motion. If a body is divided into a large number of very small parts, and a typical particle has a mass which is at a perpendicular distance r from the axis of rotation, then its contribution to the moment of inertia / is mr 2 Under these conditions the moment of inertia will be equal to the sum of all such contributions from all portions of the body, and: In
m
.
k 2 ) can be changed. A man stands on a frictionless turntable holding a 15-pound barbell in each hand; his arms, with extended elbows, are abducted 90° as in Figure 4.6. He is started spinning at a rate of one rps (revolution per second, 360°/sec). While he is spinning at this rate he pulls the barbells into his shoulders so that they are only 6 inches from his axis of rotation. At the start of the experiment the barbells were held at 3 feet from the rotational axis. Under the circumstances any change in the moment of inertia of his body will be so extremely small it can be ignored. Therefore as / =
at
1
mr 2
(from Eq.
4.8)
rps /
=
15 1b
X
3
ft
2
9 I
The distance
=
X mr2
Eq. 4.8
135 lb/ft
any particular portion is constant only for one given axis. As a body or body segment can rotate about different axes, r will change with each change of
A =
Thus the moment of inertia is not a fixed constant body but is dependent on the distribution of the
A =
axis. for a
r for
(from Eq. 4.11)
Im 135 lb/ft
X
1 rpsi
Motion
FIGURE
When
4.6.
Subject on frictionless turntable.
the hands draw the weights close to the body, is unchanged but r has shrunk to 0.5 foot.
TABLE
Analogies Between Linear and Rotational Motion
4.1.
mass
their
6i>
Linear motion
Angular motion
Then Distance
A =
15 1b
X
0.5 ft 2
X
Acceleration a
9
as
A
is
unchanged 135 lb/ft
rps,
=
=
3.75 lb/ft
135 lb/ft
X
The
greater the
mass
=
X
mass
drawn
Moment
of inertia /
Force
F
Moment
or torque of a couple
mentum
at a greater distance
man
will rotate.
closer to the axis, r or k
is
2
When
the
with time
mv
from the axis
,
—
in a
closed system in-
'
Work done
tB
Torque
rate
=
angular
mv
- t of conservation of momen-
momentum A
Kinetic energy
*
Law
r
lai
2
= Iu
2
of change
momentum ijOJi
t,
Law tum
= la
t
Angular
Fs Force = rate of change of mo-
decreased so that the moment of inertia becomes smaller and, as the angular momentum remains unchanged, the increase in the angular velocity must balance the equation. is
m
Work done
36
of rotation, the slower the
Mass
F = ma Momentum P = mv Kinetic energy Vi mv
rp< :
3.75 lb/ft rps,
Angle 6 Angular velocity w Angular acceleration a
s
Velocity v
rps,
—
I
—
*
of
with time
t*J
1
of conservation of angular
momentum
in
a closed sys-
volving no resultant or out-
tem with no external torque
side forces
acting on the system
UNDERSTANDING THE
56
SCIENTIFIC BASES OF
of these principles forms the basis of control in from figure skating to tumbling to rebound tumbling to more elaborate competitive dives. In the air the diver's (or tumbler's) body rotates about its cen-
Use
many
skills,
and the performer can regulate the speed of his rotation by the posture or postures he assumes. If his position is a tuck, the radius of gyration mentioned earlier will be quite short, making the moment of inertia comparatively small, and he will spin rapidly about a transverse axis in the frontal plane. Thus a good diver can complete one and a half somersaults from the low (1 meter/3-foot) diving board. If the performer feels that ter of gravity
spinning too fast, he can decrease his angular velocity by opening his tuck slightly, increasing the radius and thus his moment of inertia. On the other hand, if he feels that, at his present speed of rotation he will not complete the number of somersaults that he planned,
he
is
HUMAN MOVEMENT he can increase his rate of spin by tightening up his tuck (or pike). In the twisting dives or leaps or the skating spins, the about an axis running lengthwise of
performer rotates his body, and he hence his angular the position of his
controls his
moment
of inertia,
and by
velocity, during the twist or spin
just as the man did on the fricthese techniques, many a diver has "saved" a dive that started to go wrong.
arms
tionless turntable.
By
Analogies between Linear and Rotational Motion
Throughout the preceding section the analogies occurring between rotational and linear motion have been indicated. Table 4.1 summarizes these analogies and serves as a reminder to the reader of the many important concepts and laws that have been presented.
CIRCULAR MOTION This discussion is concerned with a body moving in a circular path, whether it is a ball on a string or a space capsule in orbit. It can also be applied to the movement of a distal end of a body kinematic chain moving in an arc about an axis through a proximal joint. Velocity
it
the body
is
= rad/sec x
1
rad
= =
moving at uniform speed,
r
Eq. 4.15
As 27rrads = 360°,
and Distance
in a given time an arc a which subtends an angle 6 whose sides are formed by the radii rand r' (Fig. 4.7). The linear distance s that the body (or distal end of a body segment) travels during the time t is determined by equating two ratios: (1) that of d to 360° (the number If
t,
LV
360°
57.2957°
Then
travels through
of degrees in a circle)
and
(2)
that of the arc s to the
circumference of the circle of which
it is
an
arc:
s 27T7-
360°
360°
and the
linear velocity of the
LV
3(i0°
X
2wr
body
X
Eq.4.12
will be:
2nr
LV
degrees/sec
Xr
Angular Acceleration Newton's First Law of inertia states that "a body will continue motion at a constant velocity in a straight line unless acted on by an outside force." As the body under discussion is moving in a circle at a constant velocity, there must be a. force of some sort that keeps it in the circular path. But a force F acting on a body implies an acceleration: F = ma. Velocity is a vector quantity and so has magnitude and direction in a straight line. The velocity at any one point on the circular path is in a straight line tangent to that path and perpendicular to the radius at that point (Fig. 4.8). As the body continues to travel in a
Eq. 4-13
The
solution of such problems can be simplified by converting 6 to degrees per second (0/t) and dividing the result by 360° to arrive at revolutions per second (rps). Using LV for linear velocity, the equation then first
becomes LV
= rps x
2tt r
Eq. 4.14
On the other hand, even more arithmetic can be avoided by converting degrees per second to radians per second (rad/sec) and then multiplying by the radius of the arc so that
Eq. 4.16
57.2957
FIGURE
4.7.
Movement
in a circle.
57
Motion
FIGURE
4.8.
acceleration
circle,
ing
A
to C. graphic
See
method
for deriving
the direction of the velocity
and each new vector
is
constantly chang-
also perpendicular to the
is
radius at each new point (Fig. 4.8. A). If velocity vectors drawn in the same directions as i n Figure 4.8.A with a common origin X. with vector as v and vector as (.•'. vector YZ is the change in velocity. Ac. during are
XY
XT.
(Fig. 4.S.C).
This demonstrates that the change in
velocity, or the acceleration that keeps the
body
in the
toward the center of Figure 4.8.D. This radial or
circular path, travels along a radius
the circle as illustrated in centripetal acceleration a R
the factor that keeps the
is
body moving in its circular path. When a body is moving in a circular path at a constant speed v and with a constant angular velocity ta, it has an acceleration which always points toward the center of the circle and whose magnitude is: aR =
where angular velocity
where velocity
is
a;
2
physics text
Eq. 4.17
r
in radians per second, or
*
=
2™ V
is
any college
interested.)
When motion vectors
velocity
in a circular will
have
path
is
not constant, the
different
lengths,
as
in
Figure 4.9.A. If the vectors of u, and c 2 are drawn as before (Fig. 4.9.B) with the same angle 6 between them, as in Figure 4.8. the vector Ac represents the resultant change in velocity. In Figure 4.9. C this change of velocity has been resolved into two components, the change in radial velocity au r which results from the change in direction, and the change in tangential velocity Ac T which results from the change in the magnitude of the velocity. The tangential acceleration aT
is:
Qt =
Sir Eq. 4.20 At
where tangential acceleration is equal to the change in tangential velocity divided by the change in time, and it will be in the direction of the changing velocity (Fig.
As a R and a T form two sides of a right triangle, the actual acceleration is:
Eq 418
U^r
-
in degrees per second,
aR
and
=-
man Eq. 4.19
Tangential acceleration as centrifugal
layman terminology forced to
is
the student
Tangential Acceleration*
*
where v*
if
4.9.D). is
/ a
D. direction of the
(Sv).
tions of these equations are available in
XZ
the time that point P has moved to P' (Fig. 4.8. B). If we extend the tangent line for c' backward until it intersects the^ tangent for c at point X'. and then d raw vecXZ'. and YZ' similar to XY, XZ. and YZ. tors the direction of Y Z' or Ac will be parallel to the line
OX'
instantaneous acceleration
text for discussion
linear velocity.) (The
mathematical deriva-
move
ton's First
may be more
acceleration. results
6.
recognizable to the lay-
the "centrifugal force" of
from the inertia of the body which
in a circular path.
Law. Chapter
N.B.:
See the definition of
inertia.
is
New-
UNDERSTANDING THE
58
SCIENTIFIC BASES OF
HUMAN MOVEMENT
B
A
FIGURE C and D
4.9.
Graphic method for deriving instantaneous acceleration. a« and a r
illustrate the directions of
a = y/a T 2
A and
B. tangential acceleration;
.
also
+ aH 2
when
aR
=
Eq. 4.23
M
Avt
Aar
Eq.4.21 At
and
Thus when a a« =
Eq. 4.22
situation is one of varying speed, a R will change from one point to another, and a T will also vary from one instance to another.
BIBLIOGRAPHY Atkins, K. R., 1966. Physics.
M.
Broer,
W.
R.,
New
York: John Wiley
1966. Efficiency of
Saunders Company. Cooper, J. M., and Glassow, R.
&
Resnick, R., and Halliday, D., 1960. Physics— for Students of Science
Sons, Inc.
Human Movement.
Philadelphia:
B.
C. V.
B., 1968. Kinesiology. St. Louis:
The
Mosby Company.
Dyson, G. H.
London
G., 1964.
Mechanics of Athletics. London: University of
Northwestern University. Amer.
J.
Phys. Med. 46:334.
H., and Frederick, D., 1964. Engineering Mechanics, and Dynamics. New York: The Ronald Press. Rasch, P. J., and Burke, R. K., 1967. Kinesiology and Applied Ana-
D.
Statics
tomy. Philadelphia: Lea
I.
New York: John Wiley & Sons, Inc. Human Motion. New York: Appleton-
G., 1963. Analysis of
Century-Crofts.
C Thomas,
Charles
Timoshenko
Press, Ltd.
ceedings of Exploratory and Analytical Survey of Therapeutic Ex-
Pletta,
M.
Steindler, A. 1964. Kinesiology of the
O'Connell, A. L. 1966. Ingredients of coordinate movement. In Proercise at
and Engineering, Part Scott,
&
Febiger.
Ed.
New
4.
S.,
Wells,
and Young, D.
and
Tricker, B.
New York: American
K.
Body. Springfield,
111.:
H..
1956.
Engineering Mechanics,
York: McGraw-Hill Book Company.
Tricker, R. A. R.,
ments.
Human
Publisher.
F.,
1966.
J. K.,
1967.
The Science of MoveCompany, Inc.
Elsevier Publishing
Kinesiology.
Philadelphia:
W.
B.
Saunders
Company. Williams, M., and Lissner, H. R., 1962. Biomechanics of
Motion. Philadelphia: W. B. Saunders Company.
Human
SECTION ONE
CHAPTER
KINEMATICS
Kinematics of
Human Movement movements that were executed by the performer, but such generic terminology is insufficient for the kinesiologist, who should use those words or phrases most widely understood and applicable. Kinematics, as stated above, is a descriptive art.
Kinematics is concerned with the geometry and temporal qualities of motion. It is descriptive and is thus concerned with displacements, velocities, and accelerations of a body or body parts. There is no concern for the forces involved with the production of any of these phenomena other than that of their identi-
Adjectives are needed in order to describe anything, and the adjectives and verbs used in kinematics of
fication.
The
movement analysis movements and/or
ex-football player or football fan will follow the
sequence of events after the ball has been snapped and. as the action unfolds, he will know almost immediately what play is being made long before it is completed. If asked, he could diagram the play, indicating the line shifts and moves of each player in technical football-ese such that any coach could present the play to his squad and they could reproduce it. But this onlooker cannot do the same for a single skill, such as a punt or a tackle, in technical anatomical terms such that the kinesiologist ignorant of football could reconstruct the exact movements occurring at each of the performer's joints and the forces that produced them. Being able to describe a skilled performance, even an unskilled one. requires a precise vocabulary as well as a complete understanding of the skill. To say that the ballet dancer performed an entrechat, a fencer made a riposte in tierce, or that a gymnast performed a dislocate on the rings would have instant meaning only
to
the
initiate
of the
5
discipline.
would immediatelv visualize the entire
The
are terms used to describe joint resulting
body
positions. Probably
the most widely accepted terminology is that used in anatomy and medicine. The American Academy of Orthopaedic Surgeons has published a booklet which they hope will lead to a standardized terminology in the area (see Chapter 1 under "Joint Movements"). Kinesiologists and other students of human movement are often dissatisfied with these standard anatomical terms inasmuch as the latter lack precision. This is particularly true of the engineers designing space suits who have built their own vocabulary of descriptive terms (Fig. 5.1). This latter terminology, combined with suitable angular measures, is as precise as the angles and directions measured.
Anatomists and kinesiologists may in time come to adopt this or a similar system of notation. However, in the
meantime
it
is
still
possible, using the
more
familiar anatomical terminology (see Chapter 1 under "Joint Movements"), to give an adequate description
initiate
of
any sequence of movements.
series of bodilv
MOVEMENT ANALYSIS Any kinematic
analysis
scription of the bodily
should
with a
de-
5.
movements which take place
6.
during the performance of the the following data:
skill
start
if
any: gravity or eccentric
muscular contraction (muscle being lengthened while exerting tension).
and should include
Where
7.
this force
is
applied.*
Many
students have been taught to think of the skeleton as a system of levers acted on by muscles,
1. The name of the movement and the time or frame number at which the movement starts and finishes. 2. The joint at which the movement occurs. 3. The lever, i.e.. the segment or segments making up the kinematic chain being moved as a result of the joint action. 4. The force producing the movement, muscular shortening (i.e.,
isotonic or concentric contraction), gravity, or
Where this force is applied.* The force resisting the movement,
*
Muscular tension, either while
a
muscle
is
shortening (isotonic
or concentric contraction) or being lengthened by an outside force (eccentric
or
lengthening
contraction),
is
being applied to the moving part or segment,
some other imposed
is
force.
considered
as
to the lever. Gravity
always considered as being applied at the center of gravity of the
lever.
59
always i.e.,
60
UNDERSTANDING THE
SCIENTIFIC BASES OF
HUMAN MOVEMENT
UPWARD
Si\
V^
(-1)
s=o° F=0°
LEFT
SIDEWARD
(-Y)
S= 1 F=
270°
T= 270°
-PBa BBBB-4 BBB
BBBI IBBBB' BBBBI IBB BBI IBBBI IBBBI IBB iJBBI IBBBI iBBBBi
BBBBbTI
BBBr JBBB vmw * aaaa |£pbb iai
r
BBaaapaaa BBP**' BBP
rill jbbB .-a*
r'^ IBBBB ^aaa in
! MM
iiiibi
•'< IHI^-.
*bb| «uiH Bar* BBBf BBBBH .
IBBr^iflB
MM
•"--
m^n-m .BBBB
--BB
r.4 JBfl
-* IBB
BBBBI BBBr
'
nn'.burc bod) rotation in film enalysis
American Association and Recreation, undated
at research section of the ication,
bouse,
I
E.,
and Cooper, J
M.
tor
Paper presented
of
Health, Physical
I
I960. Kinesiology
Selected
Iniversitj of
Reuschlein,
C
V
Moabj
A.
1958
1.
Electromyographic
movements
muscles during
of the tree
ti>ot
stud)
of
certain
IV
I...
L962,
ai
Body
An
the forward SOmerSOUlt
prepared 0*Connell,
Symmetrical Michigan on
the University
Human Movement Actions.
1969. Ixibomton.
Manual
ami during standing.
for Kinesiology.
Boston
Roebuck, -enied
).
ai
A..
Jr.,
L966.
"i
Wisconsin.
Kinesiology
in
engineering.
the Kinesiology Council, Convention
nhoef, S
C
.
1962.
An
Analysis of the Kinematics and Kinetics
Paper pre
American and Recreation, March of
the
1966
Roebuck.
I'niversiiy Bookstore. ;
>!
leg
Association tor Health. Physical Education, 1...
Doctoral
analysis of die speed of rotation for (he trampoline. Unpublished paper
I
onell, A.
75
-I.
A..
Jr..
bility evaluations.
19(iS.
Hum.
A system Factors
10.
l
nutation for space suit
mo
SECTION TWO KINETICS
The Laws
CHAPTKK
of
6
Motion and Energy NEWTON'S LAWS OF MOTION
The bases for the modern study of motion were laid by Sir Isaac Newton in the 17th century when he formulated his three laws of motion. The early translation from the original Latin is in language which is, to us,
AT REST, OR IN A STATE OF UNIFORM MOTION IN A STRAIGHT LINE UNLESS ACTED ON BY AN APPLIED FORCE Today this has a far more explicit meaning to the average individual than it did a few years ago before the space program. Apollo moon rockets remained at rest on their launching pads at Cape Kennedy until ignition of their rocket fuel. They continued to accelerate as long as the "burn" lasted arid, when the rocket motors cut off, they had reached escape velocity. The command capsule continued in the same straight line until (1) it was acted on by a short burst of rocket fire for a course cor.
archaic:
rather
Law. "Every body persists in its state of rest uniform motion in a straight line unless it is compelled to change that state by forces impressed on it." Second Law. "The change of motion is proportional to the motive power impressed, and is made in the direction of the right (straight) line in which the force is impressed." Third Law. "To even action there is always opposed an equal reaction: or, the mutual actions of two bodies upon each other are always equal, and directed to contrary parts" Resnick and Halliday). These original statements read by modern eyes seem First
or of
rection,
-
esoteric
and the meaning
difficult to grasp.
During the years since Newton's lifetime, these statements have been worked over and reworded to make their meaning clear to each generation of students. The third law above is very simply expressed today as follows: TO ENTRY ACTION THERE IS AN EQUAL AND OPPOSITE reaction Thus forces work in pairs. When a man's foot presses on the ground as he walks, the ground pushes back with an equal but opposite force. The ground is acted upon as the foot strikes it, it reacts with an equal force in the opposite direction, and the
change in its state of movement or of rest, i.e., inertia, as it had on earth. It will take the same amount of force to put it in motion (accelerate it), to stop it moving, or to change its direction as it did on earth. The weightlessness of space does not change this, nor does the one-sixth gravity of the moon. The only difference is the absence of or the decrease in the force pulling an object toward the center of a planet or
.
individual
moves
in that
direction (Fig. 6.1).
into the pull of the gravitational
This law is also described as the law of inertia because it describes the quality of needing a force to change the state of rest or of motion of a body, and it implies as a consequence a resistance to such a change. The concept of inertia is sometimes applied interchangeably with that of mass. A body in space or on the moon will have the same mass or resistance to
I
somewhat
and (2) it came moon.
force of the
As the
satellite, gravity.
running long jumper takes off. his take-off foot thrusts against the board, the board pushes back at him, and he is propelled through the air by a force equal to the thrust of his take-off foot.
One of the problems met with in the space program was this same law of action and reaction. When there is no large mass such as the earth or moon to react against the thrust of a foot or a hand, the body itself responds by turning or moving in the opposite direction. This can be illustrated in the laboratory by someone standing on a freely movable turntable with one arm abducted 90°. Regardless of whether he swings the arm to the left or right in horizontal flexion or extension, the
table reacts
The
first
by turning him law
is
FIGURE
in the opposite direction.
cited today as follows: a
6.1.
Action and reaction. The foot lands and exerts pres-
sure on the ground: the ground reacts with an equal but opposite
body remains
force
77
UNDERSTANDING THE
78
SCIENTIFIC BASES OF
HUMAN MOVEMENT
The first law leads into the second, which is concerned with force, mass, and acceleration. Actually, this law as Newton stated it uses the term motion as we use momentum today: as the product of mass and velocity, mv (Resnik and Halliday; Tricker and Tricker) and refers to the change in momentum. Taking this law as Newton stated it, the equation is: mi', -
—
0'i
F =
h vi
— -
—
more familiar one:
t'o)
Eq. 6.2 to
vo
Eq. 6.3
h-k But
- v
(u,
)/(t
,
-
t
celeration (Eq. 4.2).
mv.
)
is the formula Hence:
for
determining ac-
Eq. 6.1
M
F
m
is the velocity at time zero, u, is the mass, l» the velocity at time!, At is the elapsed time between t and ti, and F is the (vector) sum of all of the forces acting on the body. This equation can be treated alge-
where
braically as follows to achieve the
is
and thereby
=
ma
Eq. 6.4
achieved the more modern statement of a body of mass, m. has an acceleration. a, THE FORCE ACTING ON IT IS DEFINED AS THE PRODUCT OF ITS MASS AND ACCELERATION. the law that:
is
if
MOMENTUM Momentum
the product of the mass of a body and as such it is a vector quantity, a quantity of motion possessed by a body: P = mv. If mass is in pounds and velocity in feet per second, momentum P is expressed as pound feet per second; similarly if mass is in kilograms and velocity in meters per second, P is expressed as kilogram meters per secits
velocity,
is
and
ond.
Application of Force and Changes in
an interval as possible. The resulting tangential
and
radial accelerations* are responsible for the strained ligaments, damaged bursae. and possibly torn muscles that pitchers occasionally suffer. It should also be remembered that a small force applied for a long enough period of time can achieve results comparable to a far larger force applied for a brief interval only. As a consequence some authors write the equation:
F
Momentum
The equation of Newton's original statement of his second law: mv
brief
,
Eq
6 5
and speak of F x in
Eq. 6.6
as the impulse that causes the change
momentum.
Receiving a Force
At
involving the time rate of change of momentum can be used for determining the force involved in striking a ball if the necessary data are available: the duration of the contact of the implement with the ball, the velocities of the ball before and after it was struck, and the mass of the ball. It is only in recent years, since ultra-high speed photography has made the acquisition of such data possible, that the use of this formula has become practicable in sports analysis. Unfortunately, as the speed of the struck ball also includes that contributed by the elastic qualities of the ball and possibly those of the striking implement as well, the estimate of the force involved will not be entirely accurate. However, in looking at the above equation, it becomes obvious that the smaller the amount of time through which the force is applied, the greater will be the change in momentum. Conversely, if the same force is applied over a longer period of time, there must be a decrease in the change of momentum per unit of time. In projectile skills, then, when force may be applied over a relatively long period of time as in throwing, greater force is needed to achieve a high velocity. This explains why baseball pitchers may hurt their arms when they attempt to achieve maximal velocity of the ball by applying a maximal amount of force over as
t
x At
When
considering Equations 6.5 and 6.6 from the op-
posite viewpoint, that of catching a fast ball or landing
from a high jump, the greater the increase of time
consumed
in the
in catching the ball or for
amount
completing
the landing, the less will be the force felt by the catcher jumper at any one instant while his body is receiving the force and the less will be the damage to body tissues. In catching a fast ball, even with a catching mitt, the hands are stretched forward to meet the ball and are drawn toward the body as the ball contacts the glove. All of this increases the time during which the momentum of the ball is absorbed by the catcher. Landing pits for long and high jumps were originally filled with sand, then with sawdust, wood shavings, or tanbark. Today most of them are filled with chunks or sheets of foam rubber. The jumper, if he lands on his feet (this is chiefly in the case of the long jump), dorsiflexes at the ankles, flexes the knees, hips, and spine, and may go into a roll. The high jumper or pole vaulter may land on his shoulders and back or with a roll or both. In any case the force generated by his momentum is spread over as large an area of his body as possible so that any one area is impacted by a comparatively small amount of force. This type of landing also increases the duraor
*
See section on "Circular Motion." Chapter
4.
I
which in turn decreases the per unit of time so thai there is less force for the body to absorb. The landing medium absorbs some of the momentum, as the particles sand, shavings, tanbark, or foam rubber fly in all actions when some of the jumper's momentum is transferred to the landing medium. The ultimate retion of the landing process,
change of
momentum
by the jumper at any one instant any one area of bis body is deereased to the point where there is little it' any damage to the tissues. The
sult is that the force felt
of
'20
per second.
feel
79
Motion and Entrg)
is
The quarterback
sidestep
at
as a single unit after the tackle
react
resulting
momentum
the
of
is
made
so
tackle quarterback
I
he
sys
determined as follows. 1. Determine and X and Y momenta com ponents (Xmv and Ymv) of the two bodies: tern
is
Problem
^Xmu
m .r,
cos 0°
200 lb
x
i
m,D, cos 60°
20 ft/sec
x
1
]£
Ymv
=
6400
=
m,i',sin0 o +
as sin 0° =
160
i
1000 lb ft/sec + 2400 lb
".
The above
made
of
an angle of 60°. The quarter back is still moving at 30 feel per second and weighs 160 pounds as against the 200 pounds of the tackle (Kig. 6.2). As the tackle grabs the quarterback they that the tackle
boxer rolls with the punch tor the same purpose: to decrease the force with which he is hit by increasing the time of contact, which in turn decreases the change in momentum per unit of time. It is the abrupt change in momentum from a large quantity to little or none that is harmful to the body (e.g., an automobile collision). All of this information is implicit in Newton's First Law, and in the equation F \ f = mr, - mv n-ation of
jws
II)
30 ft/sec
•
0.5
ft /sec
lb ft/sec
m
2
u 2 sin60°
0,
Momentum
illustrations all
have spoken of
X Ymv
momentum
time as is conveniently possible, or that some of the momentum has been transferred under each of the circumstances. This slow deceleration, as has been pointed out, is accomplished so that the amount of force applied to the body at any given instant is as small as it can be made while the momentum is being altered. These facts imply that momentum is not lost or destroyed,
=
160 lb x 30 ft/sec x 0.8660
= 4156.8 lb ft/sec
as being "absorbed"' over as long a period of
and
it is
.
where ing
RMV
Hi,l/,
- iR|0| -
^ RMV
momenta
is
m
3
u3
.
.
.
(before) =
^ RMV
the magnitude of the
sum
after the interaction. This
2
Y.Xmv
2
+
X Ymu
!
6400 2 + 4156.8 2
RMV
not.
If one observes the interaction of two or more bodies with m.i',. m 2 v 2 m 3 v 3 ...etc in a closed system in which there are no resultant or outside forces involved and records the sum of the various momenta both before and after the interaction, he will find that:
£
Problem 2. The resulting momentum (RMV) can be obtained by use of trigonometric functions or the Pythagorean theorem.
The
resulting or final velocity, v f
,
of the system can
by dividing the resultant by the resultant mass RM.
easily be obtained
RMV
7631.4 lb ft/sec
momentum
(after)
of the result-
is
the
law of
conservation of momentum. At the same time it must not be forgotten that the law of conservation of mass also applies to the above interaction so that:
z
.
(before) =
X RM
Whatever happens, the momentum lost by one obbody is gained by another. The chunks of rubber in the landing pit fly around as the jumper lands, and
ject or
momentum is not transferred to the rubber eventually absorbed by the earth, whose mass is so enormous that we cannot measure any change that is caused. Similarly, when the outfielder catches a line drive, the momentum of the ball (whose mass is extremely small) is transferred to his body and then, as with the jumper, to the earth. However, consider the problem of the football quarterback earning the ball being tackled by a lineman. The tackle is approaching the quarterback with a velocity whatever is
FIGURE
Schematic of a collision on the football field. T. 200 pounds and traveling at 20 feet per second: quarterback carrying the ball weighs 160 pounds and travels 30 feet per second See text. 6.2.
tackle weighing Q. at
RM
+
=
m.}
=
200 lb
HUMAN MOVEMENT
SCIENTIFIC BASES OF
UNDERSTANDING THE
80
By
im
+
substitution
160 lb t
=
0.167 ft 10.6 ft/sec
= Vf
360
=
lb.
=
RMV
F =
0.0157 or 0.016 sec
—
mv\
mva
t
_ 360
360
=
_ -7632.0
deter-
360 lb
X
21.2 ft/sec
53
arctangent
y"l
ft/sec
lb.
0.016 sec
^ Ymv
=
-
ft
21.2 ft/sec
= -47.7
side o of a right triangle.*
6
X
0.016 sec
The direction in which the system moves is mined trigonometrically as J^ Xmv ~ side a and
~
lb
X
104 lb
ft
Assuming that the hockey players hit the boards at an angle of 60° with their slide, the impact force would
Ymv Xmv
be halved. For example, taking the line of slide as the x axis the Y component would be and
4156.8
arctangent 6400.0
Fx
=
arctangent 0.64937
=
33°
=
F
cos 60°
= 47.7 x 10' x 0.5 0'
= 23.85 x 10 4 lb
and quarterback would move onward with a velocity of 21.2 feet per second and at an angle of 33° with the direction in which the tackle was travel-
The
ft
tackle
were no other forces acting on them. However, gravity and friction with the ground acting on the tackle's body combine to pull the quarterback down and they both come to a halt very shortly. If it is assumed that such a collision occurred on ice and between hockey players, and if the two men slid as one mass almost without friction, they would travel at 21.2 feet per second until they slammed into the side wall, where their combined velocity would become zero feet per second. If as they hit their bodies were compressed approximately 2 inches (0.167 foot) by the force of impact, we can determine the force with which they hit the boards if the angle at which they hit is known. If it is assumed that this angle is 90°, the resulting force will be maximal for the circumstances. In order to determine the amount of this force, the impulse equation (Equation 6.6) is used: Ft = mv - mv The length of time of the impact is also unknown but can be determined from the available data. The amount of compression (0.167 foot) is the distance that the bodies travel during the impact. As their velocity changes from 21.2 to feet per second during this time, the average velocity v a is used in the final determination by substitution in the formula v = s/t or t = s/v. ing, if there
,
Vf
—
.
of the slide with the sides of the
The smaller the angle
rink, the less will be the force with
which the players
hit.
The effect of increasing the time of impact can be graphically illustrated if a comparison is made of the force generated when a 100-pound boy drops 3 feet from a high bar and lands (1) "hard" with little or no give in his joints so that the total give of his body (shoes, approximately 1 inch; and (2) when he lands softly on the balls of his feet and his joints all give so that the total drop of his center of gravity after his feet touch the floor is approximately 10 inches. Both of these problems can be attacked in the same manner as the previous ones. The time for a 3-foot drop is 0.43 second (see Table B.l, Appendix B) so that his velocity at the end of the drop is 13.8 feet per second (v = u + gt). The average velocity during impact from feet per second is 6.9 feet per second. The 13.8 to distance during impact is 1 inch or 0.083 foot. Then
feet, spine, etc.) is
t
=
0.083
ft
6.9 ft/sec 0.
012 sec
and as mv\
—
mva
Vi t
0-21.2
ft
/sec
Eq.6.7
=
100 lb
X
-
100 lb
X
13.8 ft/sec
0.012 sec
=
11.5
X
10 4 lb
ft
10.6 ft/sect *
The symbol ~
t
This velocity
than acceleration.
is
is
to be read "equivalent to."
negative as
it is
the velocity of deceleration rather
In the second instance, the soft landing, the time of drop, and the velocities are the same, but the distance has increased 10 times, so
Laws -
I
0.
ft
of
Motion and Energy
81
the time lapse from toe touch to deepest bend W8I
second; then
/sec
1
13801b sec
and 1623.5 lb
y
This
0.12 sec 11.5 \
On
the other hand,
10* lb
the hoy uses a greater
it'
amount
eccentric, lengthening contraction sufficient to slow
time would be increased on his feet would be desed. Suppose that the boy was photographed and
his joint actions further, the
beyond
this point
and the
force
is considerably less force than in either of the two previous examples; i.e., 1.4% of that of the hard landing and only 14% of that of the first soft landing. These exercises serve to illustrate some of the typical forces to which the human body can be subjected without sustaining serious injury, and they provide objective evidence for using controlled "give" when one is landing
from a height.
ENERGY mentioned earlier, and is often described as the capacity to do work. The breakdown of gasoline provides the energy to drive the internal combustion engine: the splitting of the high energy phosphate bond (~ (?)) of adenosine Energy per
triphosphate
se
is
iAT-r
a scalar quantity, as
~
~ ®)
(f
energy of any given mass depends solely on its velocity, while the potential energy of that mass depends solely
upon
muscular contraction. These are samples of chemical energy. Mechanical energy, which is our concern at the moment, involves both potential and kinetic energy.
position.
Conservation of Energy
provides the energy
for
its
The law that,
of conservation of mechanical energy states
in a closed
forces present, the
potential energy
equal to a constant for that system:
PE + KE
Potential Energy Potential energy (PE) is also spoken of as gravitational energy or energy of position. A 20-pound boulder balanced on the edge of a 70-foot cliff has a potential energy of 1400 foot pounds. It could do considerable
highway at the foot of the cliff. A gymnast hanging from the stationary rings (Fig. 6. 3. A) has a certain amount of potential energy. If he weighs 140 pounds and his center of gravity has been raised 0.5 feet when
damage
is
system where there are no outside sum of the kinetic energy and the
to a
he leaped upward to grasp the rings, he increased his potential energy to 210 foot pounds in relation to the floor.
= a constant
no change in the total amount of energy Thus there is no change in the sum of the potential and kinetic energies for that system at
so that there
is
in the system.
any one instant in any given situation. Suppose the gymnast in Figure 6.3 is on the flying rings and swings through an arc of 63° as in Figure 6.4. At each high point of his swing he has only potential energy, and at the lowest point he has only kinetic energy. As PE + KE at the high point will equal a constant and as PE + KE at the low point will equal the
same constant: PE
= weight
=
height
(or.
as wt. =
mass x
PE + KE
ace. of g:)
mgh
=
PE + KE
Eq. 6.8 (at the
top of the swing)
mgh
the gymnast above changes his position to the front uprise (Fig. 6.3.B) his center of gravity will rise approxIf
imately another 4 feet and his potential energy will increase further to some 650 foot pounds (4 x 140 lb) in relation to the floor.
(at
the low point of the swing)
+0
=
0+
mgh
=
4 mv
top of swing
';
mt
!
2
bottom
of swing
the gymnast's center of gravity rises 5 feet during the swing and he weighs 140 pounds, the constant is most easily calculated at the top of the swing: If
Kinetic Energy
Kinetic energy (KE) as of motion.
body
is
The amount
its
name
implies,
is
the energy
of kinetic energy in a
KE
(mg =
moving
determined by: Eq. 6.9
(Kinetic energy equals one-half the mass times the square of the velocity.) Thus the quantity of kinetic
PE
= 140 lb x 5
ft
= 700 lb
ft
KE is at the top of the swing, 700 pound feet is the constant energy for the system. As PE + KE will always equal 700 pound feet, it is a very simple matter to determine the kinetic energy for a drop of any given disAs
=
weight)
tance.
82
UNDERSTANDING THE
SCIENTIFIC BASES OF
HUMAN MOVEMENT
B FIGURE
6.3.
Gymnast on the
\ \ \ \ \ \ \ \ \
still
rings. A. hanging; B. front uprise. X. location ot center of gravity
If
\
will
there has been a drop of be found as follows:
140 lb x
1
foot the kinetic energy
PE + KE
= 700 lb
ft
KE
= 700 lb
ft
KE
= 700 lb
ft
= 560 lb
ft
1 ft
+
- 140 lb
ft
And
if one then wishes to calculate the velocity of the swing at that point:
U
1401b
560 lb
ft
560 lb
ft
560 lb
ft
=
560 lb
ft
=
8
w
2 \32.2 ft/sec 2 /
70 1b 32.2 ft/sec 2
r
2
X
32.2 lb
ft
/sec 2
70 1b
FIGURE
6.4.
Gymnast on
flying rings.
See
text
ft
X
32.2
ft
/sec 2
/
6
\
ft
stv
257l$Ti
:
MKS'
the v
•
s\stcm
ws of
Motion and Energy
a force of
V new
tons
bj.
moves
meters, or in the English system, a force of
/'
ma\ move a bodj feet. However, in the MKS amount ot work accomplished is expressed as \
uvo r
the
not.
Thus
in
any system or
flight
path where friction
is
negligible, the potential energj
at the highest poinl oi' the path will provide the constant tor any other point in
and
the path,
this potential
energy will be equal to the
mal kinetic energy of the system.
as
the
exercise
physiologist
blithely
a
bod>
pound system joules,
states,
in
"kilogram- meters."
MKS:
meter does joule newton moving a body work; similarly 1 dyne moving a body 1 centimeter does 1 erg of work, while in the English system a force foot does 1 foot pound of of 1 pound moving a body work. Power is defined as the time rate of performing work: e.g., so many joules per second or so many foot pounds per second. One horsepower is 550 foot pounds of work per second. 1
I
1
oi
1
IV rk
and Pou
When
er
F
applied so that a body is moved a work has been accomplished: work Fx. Work makes use of the same units as energy; in I
d
a force
distance
is
.v.
BIBLIOGRAPHY Atkins. K. R.. 1966. Physics.
Dyson, G. of
H
London
G..
1964.
New
York: John Wiley
Mechanics
of Athletics.
&
Sons. Inc.
London: University
Press. Ltd.
and Frederick. D.. 1964. Engineering Mechanics. s and Dynamics. New York: The Ronald Press. Resnick. R.. and Halliday. D.. 1960. Physics— for Students of :nd Engineering. Part I. New York: John Wiley & Sons. 5 Plena.
Inc.
D.
H..
Rogers.
E.
M..
1960.
Physics for the Inquiring Mind.
Princeton:
Princeton University Press.
Timoshenko, S., and Young, D. H.. 1956. Engineering Mechanics; Ed. 4. New York: McGraw-Hill Book Company. Tncker. R. A. R.. and Tricker, B. J. K., 1967. The Science of Movement. New York: American Elsevier Publishing Company. Inc. *
Meter, kilogram, second system of notation.
SECTION TWO KINETICS
CHAP IKK
7
Forces number only and is not to be confused with g, which is the downward acceleration arising from the gravita-
The one universal force, that of gravitation, was first defined by Sir Thomas Newton in the 17th century. This Law of Universal Gravitation states that: \NY rWO BODIES IN THE UNIVERSE HAVE A GRAVITATIONAL ATTRACTION FOR ONE ANOTHER IF THEIR MASSES ARE W. AND m, AND THEIR DISTANCE APART, T, IS LARGE COMPARED WITH THE SIZE OF EITHER. THEN THE FORCE ON EITHER BODY POINTS DIRECTLY TOWARD THE OTHER BODY
moon. As the mass of humanity comparison to that of a planet, it can be omitted when calculating the gravitational attraction of a planet to any body or object on or tional pull of a planet or
and
.
,
its artifacts is
near
its
so small in
surface: g =
AND HAS THE MAGNITUDE
where
F
=
G
in,
mjr
G
G mjr*
m
the gravitational constant, p is the planeand r is the distance to the center of the planet at that point. As this gravitational force is acting between the center of the planetary mass and the object or objects that it is attracting on or near its surface, the direction of this force is always vertically downward and produces a constant acceleration on these objects.
2
is
tary mass,
where F is the gravitational force, m and m 2 the respective masses of the two bodies, r the distance between them, and G is a gravitational constant having the same value for all bodies. It should be noted here that G is a ,
MASS, WEIGHT, AND GRAVITY Mass per
matter and as measure of the quantity of matter to which inertia is ascribed. Mathematically mass is defined by the following formulae: m = F/a (from Newton's Second Law (Chapter 6)) and m = Vp, where m is mass, F is force, a is acceleration. V is volume; and p (the lower case Greek letter rho) is the density of the mass. Weight, on the other hand, is defined as a force with which a body is attracted toward the earth (or planese is defined as a quantity of
If
tary or lunar type of mass). Therefore weight
The
If
mass
dynes,
W
in
is
grams and g
If
mass
weight
,
10
is
grams x 980.6 cm/sec 2 = 98.06 dynes
in kilograms
is
and g
in
meters per second 2 weight ,
is
mass
is
in
in
10 kg / 9.806 m/sec 2 = 98.06 newtons
pounds and g
in feet per
second 2 weight ,
is in
is
in
pounds,
last
= 10 slugs x 32.17 ft/sec 2 = 321.7 pounds
two items above illustrate the confusion American and English systems of nomen-
poundals,
e.g.
W=
,
As the amount of gravitational attraction is inversely proportional to the square of the planet's radius (see above), the shape of the planet affects the amount of force exerted at any given point on its surface. For example, on earth this gravitational force causes an object to be accelerated 980.6 cm/sec 2 (CGS* system) or 32.17 ft/sec 2 (English system) when it is falling at 45° latitude, i.e., halfway between the equator and either pole. However, because the earth is flattened at its poles, making the distance to its center slightly less at these two
e.g.:
W= If
centimeters per second
in
second 2 weight
wise.
e.g.:
W= newtons.
is
in feet per
This confusion extends somewhat to the metric system also, as common practice habitually uses the terms gram and kilogram as well as pound to define both mass and weight. However, although the difference between mass and weight has been noted above, this text follows the common practice and uses the terms grams, kilograms, and pounds as units of both mass and weight until such time as it is deemed advisable to do other-
physicist:
in
and g
clature.
which draws people or objects on or near the surface of a planet toward its center. Mathematically the formula defining this = mg, where force is is weight, m is mass, and g is the acceleration of gravity. According to the
2
in slugs
existing in the
of the gravitational attraction
W
is
W
a result
is
mass
e.g.:
a
10 lb (mass) / 32.17 ft/sec 2 = 321.7 poundals
*
85
Centimeter, gram, second system of notation.
UNDERSTANDING THE SCIENTIFIC BASES OF HUMAN MOVEMENT
86
TABLE
7.1.
Variation of
Altitude
ft
a'
TABLE
with altitude at 45° latitude
#
Altitude
ft/sec'
m
g m/sec*
Equator
9.806
32.174
Variation of
7.2.
A'
with latitude at sea level
Feet /sec*
Latitud(
Meters/sec"
0°
32.0878
9.78039
10°
32.0929
9.78195
1,000
32.170
1,000
9.803
20°
32.1076
9.78641
4,000
32.161
4,000
9.794
30°
32.1302
16,000
32.124
8,000
9.782
40°
32.1578
9.79329 9.80171
60,000
31.988
16,000
9.757
50°
32.1873
9.81071
100,000
31.865
32,000
60°
32.2151
500,000
30.631
100,000
9.708 9.598
70°
32.2377
9.81918 9.82608
80°
32.2525
9.83059
90°
32.2577
9.83217
Doints. a falling obiect
Pole
wol ild be accelerated 983.2 cm/
2 in the polar regions. When falling sec 2 or 32.257 ft/sec at the equator, where the distance to the center is greatest, the same object falling at sea level would undergo 2 2 In less acceleration; i.e., 978 cm/sec or 32.08 ft/sec other words, the object would be heaviest when weighed ,
,
.
at either pole, lighter
when weighed at 45° latitude, and lightest of all on a
lighter still at equator sea level,
mountain peak along the equator,
i.e.,
in Bolivia,
Kenya,
Sumatra; see Tables
or
day).
As
7.1
and
7.2
this gravitational force
is
(Resnick and Halliacting between the
center of the planetary mass and the objects which it is attracting on or near its surface, this force is always
acting vertically
downward and produces
a constant
acceleration, g. Thus g may or may not be one of more forces which interact in or on a body.
two or
FORCE RELATIONS parallel forces: the weight of the
Linear Forces on the basis of the relationship between their action lines. This is the All interacting forces are defined
the same straight line (Fig. 7.1). As an example, in a given situation forces of 10, 3, and 5 pounds are pushing a body to the right, while at the same time forces of 2 and 4 pounds are pushing the same body to the left. These forces have direction and magnitude and so are vector forces which can be graphically illustrated by arrows whose length is scaled to represent the amount of force (Fig. 7.2). Vectors pointing to the right or upward are by convention considered as positive, while those pointing in the opposite directions are considered negative. Adding graphically in Figure 7.2.B, we end up with a positive vector 12 units long which is equivalent to 12 pounds.
simplest combination, as
all forces
must
lie in
Mathematically:
R
where
R
is
=ZF
the resultant and
F
Eq. 7.1 is
the force or forces in-
volved:
R
=
+10-4
+ 5 +
3-2= 18-6 =
+12
lb
Parallel Forces
10-pound shot held the weight of the forearm and hand acting at the center of gravity of the two segments, and the unknown upward pull of the biceps, th supporting the forearm hand and weight. b ,* These forces acting at various measurable distances from the axis form a third class lever system with the axis A in the elbow joint, the unknown force of the biceps as the supporting effort, and the combined weights as the resistance to be balanced. (For the soluin the
W
hand,
W
s
,
,
TMF
tion of this
problem see below under Problem
Force Couples
A special case of parallel forces occurs when there are two forces of equal magnitude acting at a distance from each other and in opposite directions. Under these circumstances they produce a turning action as in Figure 7.4, in which two boys cooperate to turn the boat end for end. As long as the force exerted by boy A is equal and opposite to that exerted by boy B, the boat will not go anywhere; there will be no linear displacement or acceleration, and the resultant of the two forces will be zero. But the boat is turned. The forces acting in this situation are known as a couple and the moment or torque is the product of one of the equal and opposite forces multiplied by the distance be-
tween them:
In this case the action lines of the forces under consideration are parallel to one another as in the examples of the lever classes presented earlier (see Chapter 3 under "Classification of Levers"). As these forces are applied at some distance from each other, a slightly different approach is necessary to determine the mag-
nitude of one unknown (force or moment arm) when the remainder of the forces and moment arms are known. Given the system in Figure 7.3, we have three
9.
Fd
Eq.
where the subscript c refers to the couple. In the above illustration each boy is exerting a 30-
pound force and they are 7 feet apart. Boy A is exerting a clockwise force, thus the resultant of the two forces *
The abbreviation
of
TMF
for total
out this text to refer to the total exerting at the instant under study.
muscle force
amount of
is
used through-
force that a muscle
is
87
Forces
FIGURE
7.1. Linear force
system; two pairs of forces. A. force exerted by the arms; F the force exerted by the floor
the rope; X. the force exerted by the feet;
FIGURE
7.2.
representing
R. the force exerted by
,
Vector diagram of forces described in text. A. vectors each of the different forces (see text); B. vectors
added graphically.
will
be zero:
FIGURE in
total
R but the
moment
=
- 30 - 30
Parallel force system.
W
fh
,
W
s
,
the weight of the shot held
the weight of the forearm and hand;
TMF b
,
the
muscle force exerted by the biceps to support the system.
=
Concurrent Forces
or torque: t c = 30 lb x 7
= 210 lb
7.3.
the hand:
ft
ft
Forces whose action lines meet at a point are concurSuch forces may be applied to a body from two or more different angles so that projections of their rent.
UNDERSTANDING THE
88
HUMAN MOVEMENT
SCIENTIFIC BASES OF
FIGURE
7.5.
Concurrent forces.
A, lines of force intersect inside
the body; B. lines of force intersect outside the body
that gravity has a clockwise action on the body and only the counterclockwise tension in the calf muscle maintains erect posture (Fig. 7.6). With all of these concepts as a basis, it is possible to proceed to solving problems that arise in the study of human movement, in particular those involving kinetics.
FIGURE 7.4. Example of a force couple in which equal and opposite forces are applied to each end of the boat. The torque or moment of this couple r b is the product of one force and the (
distance between
)
them
action lines will cross. This intersection need not be inside the body. Figure 7.5A presents a simple situation where the action lines intersect within the body, while B illustrates an intersection outside the body. Another example occurs in normal quiet standing where the line of gravity falls slightly anterior to the ankle joint so
Kinetics itself is concerned with the forces that either produce or change the state of rest or motion of a mass, living or inert. When studying the kinetics of the human body we must be aware of two kinds of forces which act on it, internal and external. Internal force is exerted by muscular tension, either while shortening or being lengthened by an outside force. The major external force
TYPICAL PROBLEMS MET In the study of various aspects of movement and posture, two general types of situations arise in a force analysis. of Finding the Resultant of Two or Forces. This involves what is known as the composition of forces and is the process of reducing any number of forces acting on a body to a single force, known as the resultant, whose action will be the same as that of the combined original forces. This entails deter1.
The Problem
More
mining both the magnitude and the direction of the
re-
sultant. 2.
The Problem
Necessary
of Finding the Equilibrium Force (or
Moment Arm)
in
is,
of course, gravity.
As
gravitational force pulls
bodies toward the center of the earth, its action line is always vertically downward. Other external forces include those of impact as in catching or striking, falling or contact in sports, water resistance when swimming, the force exerted by a fiberglass pole in vaulting, etc. The action line of these external forces other than gravity depends upon the situation being analyzed. As all of these forces, both internal and external, have direction and magnitude they are vector quantities and subject to vector analysis. all
IN
FORCE ANALYSIS
Simple problems of this type have been presented Chapter 3. A more complex problem is illustrated
in in
Starting with known factors such as the magnitude of the two weights involved (forearm and hand plus the weight held) and their moment arms, as well as the point of attachment and the action line of the biceps muscle, the total muscle force that the biceps is exerting (TMF) can be calculated. In other words, when a body is in equilibrium and certain factors are known,
Figure
the the
7.3.
unknown factors can be determined because both sum of the moments and/or the sum of the forces
must be equal
to zero.
an Equilibrium Situation.
COMPOSITION AND RESOLUTION OF FORCES Many
times when a number of forces are acting on
as the composition of forces. This problem of finding a
desirable to find a single force or resultant that will have the same effect on the body as that of the
resultant of two or more forces has as its concomitant the problem of resolving a single force into two or more cor ponents such that the combined action of the two
a
body
it is
combined
forces that
it
replaces. This process
is
known
Forces
new
forces will
be equivalent
to that
The most common situation human movement will encounter force.
resolve a single force into
of the original
that the Btudent of is
the necessity
to
two components.
more combe the same as that
single force can he replaced by two or
ponents whose combined action
will
The simplest situation of resolving two components involves the construction
of the original force. rce into
of a parallelogram of forces
forms the diagonal
such that the original force each of the above cases
(Fig. 7.7). In
components of the force F are indiand Q. P and Q and P' and Q\ These
the pairs of force
ed by
P
unison on a body, will produce the same
as the single force F. However, it is more dethe direction that each of the two
sirable to specify
replacements must take, and the most frequent procedure is to resolve the force F into two components at right angles to each other. These directions are normally horizontal and vertical, forming an X component on the horizontal or x axis, and a Y component along the vertical or y axis (Fig. 7.8). Thejbrce F is at 45° with the horizontal, and the vector AB represents the force. The x and y axes are drawn through point A. the origin of the force. Perpendiculars from point B to the two axes define the two components, vectors
AC
is
a
(TMF)
forces to dislocating decnm pressing forces as the angle of pull of a muscle increases beyond 90°. The rotatory component, on the other hand, has constant direction in that it is always perpendicular to the long axis of the bone or segment that it moves, while the secondary component always follows the long axis of that bone either toward or away from
the
moving
muscle
joint,
depending on the angle
at
which the
pulling.
is
.
forces, acting in effect
technique used in resoh in^ the total muse Ito\ a given muscle into its rotatory and secondary components. Secondary components arc frequently much larger than rotators components but are so called because they may change in direction from
This
force
stabilizing compressing
^hical Resolution of Forces
Any
8'.
(the
X
component) and
AD
(the
Y compo-
nent).
Figure 7.9 illustrates the resolution of the biceps into these two components. The action line of the rotatory component originates at point A, the intersection of the biceps action line with the long axis of the forearm, x-x, and is perpendicular to this axis. The action line of the secondary component is coincident with the long axis, and its direction can easily be determined by constructing the parallelogram of forces around a given of the biceps. To illustrate this, let us assume a of 100 pounds. Vector AB is drawn along the biceps action line and is 100 units long. In A of Figure 7.9 the forearm is extended and the action line of the biceps makes an angle of approximately 8° with the long axis of the forearm. With a of 100 pounds the rotatory component, vector
TMF TMF
TMF
FIGURE 7.7. Resolution of force F P and Q' and P" and Q" by 1
.
into
two components: P and
constructing
Q.
parallelograms of
force around force F.
FIGURE
7.6.
muscle force gravity
The concurrent force system f
.
of gravity g and soleus maintaining the upright posture. CG. center of
FIGURE
7.8.
Resolution of force F into vertical and horizontal
components. See
text.
90
UNDERSTANDING THE
SCIENTIFIC BASES OF
HUMAN MOVEMENT
est*
FIGURE 7.9. Resolution of total muscle AB '^TMF b is maintained at 100 pounds
force of biceps
component Note the change in direction beyond 90° as in D and E See text
of the
(TMFb
)
into rotatory
and secondary components. component: AD. secondary
x-x. long axis of forearm; AC. rotatory
secondary component when the angle
of pull
6 increases
AC,
bow
net
secondary component increases. But its direction is now away from the joint; the secondary force has become one of dislocation-decompression. In D the muscle is pulling the for earm away from the joint with a 92-pound force (vector AD), and the rotatory force is 41 pounds (vector AC). Note that the sum of the two components is always
is only 15 pounds, while^ the stabilizing comporepresented by vector AD is 98 pounds. As the elbow is flexed the angle of pull of the biceps action line increases, as does the rotatory component. Maximal rotatory force is achieved at C when the action line of the biceps is at 90° with the forearm axis and all of the 100 pounds of contractile force are available for supporting or moving the forearm. With continuing el-
flexion the rotatory
component decreases
as the
91
Forces greater than the IMF of 100 pounds. The two com ponent force vectors form the two legs of a right angle triangle, with the biceps TMF as the hypotenuse, bo the Pythagorean theorem is applicable: "The square oi the hypotenuse is equal to the sum of the squares of the two sides.'" Consequently,
AH
>AC«
AD'
Frequently in calculating muscle forces the problem is simplified by resolving the TMF into horizontal and vertical components rather than into stabilizing or dislocating forces. An example of this treatment is given under Problem 10 below.
Graphical Composition of Forces
A number of forces acting on a single body can be reduced to a single force whose action will be the equivalent of the
When
is
assumed
combined action of all of the
the reverse of resolving a force into 7.7 and 7.8. The pair of concurrent forces becomes the sides of a parallelogram, and the single resultant force R is the diagonal of the parallelogram which originates from the junction of the is
two components as in Figures
forces.
two forces. P of 10 pounds, and pounds, are acting on a single body.
In Figure 7.10 7.5
Q
of
Problem 1. Find the magnitude and the direction of the resultant (the single force that can replace P and
Q) Solution.
by drawing
Construction
a
paralle logr am
line BD__p>arallel to vector
parallel to vector
AB.
D
is
A
of
AC, and
forces
line
CD"
the point of intersection of
Tensor
the point of
the paralleloint
On
fascia lata
1
Cluteus minimus
2
Gluteus medius
4
and knowing the directions of the action the proportional resultant force can be determined. Figure 7.13 indicates the action lines from the trochanter A. That of the tensor fascia lata, AB, is shown as attaching where it does as this point is so close to its junction with the iliotibial band. The action of the gluteus medius is represented by^ AC and of the gluteus minimus by line AD. a, b, and c are the respective vectors. The resultant of these three muscles may be determined graphically in two different ways: (a) by the parallelogram methods illustrated above, and (b) by constructing a polygon of forces. Problem 2. Find the resultant of the combined force of the three abductors. a. Solution by parallelograms. With three forces it is necessary^ to^ construct two parallelograms. The three vectors a, b, and c are drawn from a common this basis
lines,
POUNDS
FIGURE
is
original forces.
can be treated by both methods. A graphical solution of a linear force problem is presented above under "Linear Forces." Finding the resultant of a pair of con-
two
equilateral.
If we consider the three abductors, gluteus medius, gluteus minimus, and tensor fascia lata, we face a different problem. Each of these three muscles has a different shape and mass and a slightly different angle of pull, although they all attach on or near the greater trochanter of the femur. Inman determined their action line on the pelvis and also postulated that their contribution to abduction was proportional to their mass. He found the following proportions:
is
current forces
Under such circumstances
erse ction of the action line of each muscle part. AB and AC are the vectors of the two parts and AD is the resultant force of the muscle.
desirable to manipulate forces in this manner there are two general approaches, graphical and mathematical. Parallel forces can best be composed mathematically, while linear and concurrent forces it
that each part contributes equally to the re
sultant force.
grams are
AH
AC
AB«
BD' and CD". The vector AD is the resultant of forces /'and (I The graphical solutions of muscular forces are illustrated in Figures 7.11 and 7.12. For these muscles it
7.10. Graphical composition of forces
P and
Q. See text
UNDERSTANDING THE
92
FIGURE
7.
two heads
origin
11.
Graphical composition of the forces exerted by the gastrocnemius.
of the
A
(Fig.
In this case, for reasons of clarity th£
first
and
7.13.B).
SCIENTIFIC BASES OF
at the
same angles
as in Figure
7. 13.
HUMAN MOVEMENT
FIGURE 7.12. Graphical composition heads of the pectoralis major.
of the sternal
and clavicular
parallelogram is drawn between vectors a and c with a resultant vector R'._JThe second parallelogram is drawn between vectors R' and b to find the final resultant vector R (Fig. 7. 13.B). b. Solution by a polygon of forces. The first vector, a, is drawn at the same angle with the horizontal as in the drawing of Figure 7. 13. A. The second vector, b, ^s added to the open end of the first, and the third, c, similarly added to the second. The vector that closes the polvgon is the resultant R of the three forces (Fig. 7.13.C).
Mathematical Composition of Parallel Forces
The composition of parallel forces requires the use moments: THE MOMENT OF THE RESULTANT (R X MA R OF A PARALLEL FORCE SYSTEM ABOUT ANY GIVEN POINT MUST BE EQUAL TO THE SUM OF THE MOMENTS OF THE INDIVIDUAL
of the principle of
)
forces about the same point This .
R
MA H
is
expressed by:
=Y. M
is
^M
Abductor forces acting at the hip joint. A. pelvis with abductor action lines (redrawn after Inman): B.
7.13. joint
graphical solution of Problem 2. a by parallelograms: solution of Problem
2b
MA
C.
graphical
by a polygon of forces.
downward
as in Figure 7.14. Reading 1. 2. and 4 pounds. There is a distance of 2 feet between the 3- and the 1-pound weight and between the 2- and the 4-pound weight, with
acting vertically Eq. 7.3
R is the resultant (the sum of the forces), R the moment arm of the resultant, and is the algebraic sum of the moments of the parallel forces. As an illustration, assume that four parallel forces are where
FIGURE and hip
from
1
left
foot
to right they are
between the
1-
3,
and the 2-pound weights
(Fig.
7.14A).
Problem
3.
Find the resultant of the four forces (the
Forces B
A
C
93 D
4
FIGURE
7.14.
Problem
diagram of
A.
3.
parallel force
system;
B.
diagram of Solution
diagram of
C,
a;
Solution b
whose direction and magnitude would have
single force
the
same
effect as the four original forces).
^
MA
Solution A. R \ M. Let the origin of the R = A. be the given point around which the moments of the various forces will be determined. The moment for force A will then be zero. Forces B, C, and D will tend to rotate the body in a clockwise direction and so will be positive: first force.
R = 31b +
llb
+ 21b +
41b
= 10 1b
£M
MA B
(B x
x
= (lib
= 2ftlb
10 lb \
)
2ft)
+ (C x
ft
lb
MA K
= 28
ft
lb
.\/.4 R
= 2.8
)
+ (2 lb x 3ft) +
+ 6ftlb +
= 28
MA C +(Dx MA D 20
A (Fig.
x5ft)
lb
ft
The 10-pound downward resultant of
ft
(4 lb
)
is
2.8 feet to the right
R
>
be considered positive; those to the
MA R MA H
=
£ Af
= (41b = 8
ft
= - 2
MA
B
is
the
(+
D
2ft)
-
=
x
x
ft
MA D
(3 lb
lb - 9 ft lb
= - 0.2
The 10-pound C. This
£M
=
left
would
-
I
- (A x
x 3ft) 1 ft
MA A
(1 lb
x
)
- (B x
MA B
W
XM
=
W, x MA, +
= 2.8 lb x 4.3 = 12.04 in. lb
= 24.28
in. lb
3.7 lb x
MA R
= 24.28
in. lb.
MA R
= -
lb
24.28
lb
W
in.
+
f
equal forearm, and
MA h
h
x
+
0.9 lb x 13.5 in.
12.24 in. lb
in. lb
3.7 1b
ft
6.6 in.
resultant
same
0.9 lb
equal weight, the subscript the subscript h equal hand; then:
Let
)
1 ft)
+
= 2.8 lb
= 3.7 lb
venience, positive forces precede the negative ones in the equation:
10 lb
MA R R
tend to rotate the body in a counterclockwise direction and so are considered negative. For the sake of con-
R
x
7.14.B).
Solution B. Let the origin of the third force, C, be the given point; then the moment of C will be zero. R will equal 10 pounds as in A. Forces to the right of C will tend to rotate the body in a clockwise direction and so will
7.14.C). The student is invited to try solutions using any other point to further illustrate this principle. The use of the principle of moments in the study of human kinetics is frequently applied to locating the center, or just the line, of gravity of two or more body segments as illustrated in the following problem. Problem 4. The hand of a 150-pound man weighs 0.9 pound and his forearm weighs 2.8 pounds. The center of gravity of the hand is 13.5 inches from the elbow axis (50.6% of the length of the hand from the wrist plus the length of the forearm, Table B.3, Appendix B), the center of gravity of the forearm is 4.3 inches from the same axis (43% of the length of the forearm from the elbow axis), Figure 7.15. Locate the center of gravity of the combined forearm and hand. Solution. Since this is a problem concerned with determining the location of a common center of gravity for two adjacent segments, the length of the horizontal moment arm of this common center will solve the problem, and the principle of moments is used: (Fig.
is 0.2 of a foot to the left of force location as found in solution A above
The center lies 6.6
of gravity of the combined forearm and hand inches distal to the axis through the elbow.
UNDERSTANDING THE
94
SCIENTIFIC BASES OF
HUMAN MOVEMENT (Values for these functions for any angle up to 90° are
found
in
Appendix
C).
The
relationship of the two sides of the triangle to the hypotenuse is illustrated in Figure 7.17. In these triangles the length of the hypotenuse is always the
radius of the circle and, as the angles change, it is easy to see the changes in the length of the side adjacent and the side opposite.
0-9 2*8
FIGURE
Drawing
7.15.
lbs
lbs of situation.
Problem
4.
Trigonometric Functions Needed for Solution of Force Problems* In the mathematical composition of concurrent forces, rectangular components as described above under "Graphical Resolution of Forces" are always used. In order to determine the magnitude and direction of the resultant of concurrent forces, it is necessary to make use of cetain trigonometric functions known as sines and cosines and tangents and cotangents. These are terms identifying certain constant relationships between the sides and the hypotenuse of a right angle triangle as follows.
Given the
SIDE
ABC
right triangle
FIGURE
7.16.
ft
ft
Let:
BAC be known as (the Greek letter theta) side AC be known as side a or the side adjacent to 6 side BC be known as side o or the side opposite side AB be known as h or the hypotenuse of the right angle
A
Right triangle, ABC. angle BAC; AC. the side adjacent (side a) to BC. the side opposite (side o) to 8 AB. the hypotenuse (side h) of the triangle
(Fig. 7.16):
.
:
:
ft
triangle (Fig.
7.16)
There are certain constant relationships
for these three
sides, regardless of the size of the triangle,
dependent solely on the
size of the angle
6.
which are These re-
lationships are expressed as: side opposite
or
sine 6
sin 8
o = -
hypotenuse
h
side adjacent
cosine 6
or
cos
a = —
hypotenuse
h
side opposite
tangent
or tan
8
=
side adjacent
or
8
-
a
side adjacent
cotangent
o
cot
=
a -
side opposite
FIGURE *
Students who are familiar with trigonometry and the use of
trigonometric functions
may
skip this section.
7.17.
Hypotenuse
of the right triangles
changed. Note changes in the relationships and side opposite as y changes.
of the
remains unside adjacent
Forces
\ematical Composition and Resolution Concurrent Forces
When
of
Referring back to Figure 7.9B, the action line of the biceps brachii tonus an angle of 50° with the long axis of the forearm. It it is assumed, as in the graphic solution, that the biceps is exerting 100 pounds of tension, the magnitude of the rotatory and compression forces can he determined by use of sines and eosines. Problem 5. To determine the magnitude of the rota tory and compressive components o( the hiceps brachii, given a contraction force of 100 pounds and an action line at 50° with the long axis of the forearm (Fig. 7.18). Solution. The long axis oi the forearm forms the side adjacent to the angle 6 of the right triangle ABD so side a is equivalent to the compression force. If this long axis is considered the x axis of a pair of x and y coordinates, then the compression force becomes the component of the force F. The rotatory component, then, lies on the y axis and is the Y component of the force F. Side BD forms side o of the right triangle ABD and is
X
equal to the
Y component -
the bicep8
is
exerting LOO pounds of tension
9.o pounds and the compression force is 64.3 pounds (compare with the graphical solution accompanying Fig. 7.9, above).
However, unless one is working with similar problems involving rotatory and stabilizing forces acting on long bones, it is more satisfactory to resolve the forces being studied into horizontal or X components and vertical or Y components. Unless the angles that each force makes with the horizontal are known, a force diagram is drawn, reproducing the action lines of the forces in question, and a horizontal x axis is added, intersecting the action lines. (The y axis is not always needed but can be drawn in if desired.) Figure 7.19 is a force diagram of Problem 1, above. Both the x and y axes have been added at the origin of the two forces. The action line of force P lies in the first quadrant of the x-y system, so both the and Y components are positive. On the
X
of the force F. Hence:
therefore
X
=
F
therefore
Y
=
F
Eq. 7.4
cos 6
F
and sin 8 =
—
Eq. 7.5
;
F
X
Y
= 100 cos 50°
= 100 sin 50°
= 100 \ 0.64279
= 100 x 0.76604
= 64.3
= 76.6
FIGURE
7.18.
FIGURE
Problem
5. A,
sion force exerted by biceps;
between
TMFb
and Cfb
vertical y
drawing;
TMF b
.
1
with horizontal x and
diagram. Rfb rotatory force exerted by biceps; Cfb compresmuscle force exerted by biceps [TMF b = 100 lb); e. the angle
B. force
total
Force diagram from Problem axes added. See text.
7.19.
.
.
SCIENTIFIC BASES OF
UNDERSTANDING THE
96
other hand, the action line of force Q lies in the fourth component is positive, the quadrant and, while the Y component is downward and therefore negative. By measuring the angles on the diagram, force P is at 35°
X
with the x axis and force Q forms a downward angle of 25° with the same axis. The X component of the resultant force will equal the sum of the X components of the forces involved, and similarly the Y component of the resultant will equal the sum of the Y components of the forces involved:
Z *\x
R„
=
Rx
-E*.
F 2X
-
Problem
The resultant equals 15.2 pounds, but the direction has yet to be located: i.e., the angle that the resultant makes with the
horizontal:
y~o
£F.Y- F Y
Rv =
£*\
-
8 = arcsin 2.5/15.2
= arcsin 0.16453
Solution B. The magnitude and direction can also be determined as follows:
FY 3
2
Tangent =
o/a; o
~ Y component, and
-35°
-25°
Sine
0.57358
0.42262
Cosine
0.81915
0.90631
= 10
Q
lb
= arctan
= 7.5 lb
= 9°
Q
cos 25°
= (10 lb x 0.81915)
+
+ 6.7973
or a/cos
horizontal
28'
6.
(7.5 lb x 0.90631)
h -
R
= o/sin 6
lb
= 2.5/0.16447
6.8 lb
= 15.2 lb
= 15.0 lb
The
Y/X
This gives the direction of the resultant but not its magnitude; which is equivalent to the hypotenuse of the right triangle. Cos 6 = a/h and sin 6 = o/h: so either can be used to find h, the hypotenuse, as h = o/sin
Solution.
+
com-
= arctan 1.66666
Angle with horizontal
= 8.2 lb
X
= arctan 2.5/15.0
P
= 8.195 lb
~
7.19).
Table of known data
cos 35° +
a
ponent; then:
P and Q (Fig.
P
divided by R.
= 9° 28'
Ry =
=
Y
is
Y/R
6 = arcsin
3
Force
Rx
sine = 0/h*
This angle is the angle whose sine This is expressed as:
Find the resultant (magnitude and direc-
6.
r?~hand
and
FX
and:
tion) of forces
HUMAN MOVEMENT
is 15.2 pounds upward at an angle of 9° found by the Pythagorean theorem.) The problem presented in Chapter 4 under "Time Related to Motion Velocity" can be solved in the same manner as the above problem, but there is a negative X displacement of 5 miles northwest and a zero Y displacement of 2 miles due east;
The
component
of forces
P
and Q
is
15
pounds.
resultant
28' (cf. results
—
R^
=
Psin 35° - Q
sin 25°
= (101b x 0.57358) - (7.51b x 42262)
= 5.7358
1b -
3.16965 lb
Displacement Angle* Sine Cosine
= 5.7 lb - 3.2 lb = 2.5 lb
The vertical component of forces P and Q is 2.5 pounds. The resultant being sought is the hypotenuse of the whose two sides are represented respectively by vectors 15.0 and 2.5 units long. Solution A. By using the Pythagorean theorem the magnitude of the resultant can be determined:
*
5 miles
NW
135°
2 miles 0°
+0.70711 -0.70711
+1
E
NE
3.3 miles 45°
+0.70711 +0.70711
Angles are measured with east as 0° on the
X
axis.
right triangle
R2
= 15 2
Problem 7. To find the resultant of the distance direction traveled.
= 225 + 6.25
= 231.25
R
=
/? x
=
D, cos 135° +
D
2
cos 0°
+
D
/?v
=
D
D
2
sin 0°
+
D
Rx
= 5 cos 135°
2.5-
4
t
sin 135°
+
+
2 cos 0°
= (5 x -0.70711)
+
(2
x
*
The symbol ~
is
3
cos 45° sin 45°
+
3.3 cos 45°
1)
+
(3.3
V231.25
= 15.2 lb
3
to be read "equivalent
to."
x 0.70711)
and
97
Forces
•
0.79 mile
>i
striated
Peachej
i"
"i
Peachey,
H
\.
.
K. and Hanson,
J., I960 The molecular basis of con tree tnctkm of Muscle Vol. I. edited b) G. II New York: Academic Pros. p. 183. EL. 1965 rhe mechanism of muscular contraction. Sci.
In v
y.
H
D.,
H
ite,
in
EL,
1969
Hie mechanism
A. A.. Klaupiks. D.,
of
and Davies, R
muscular contraction, EL,
1964
ATP
muscle doing negative work. Science 144: 1577. kuhl, D., 1966. Local factors in muscle performance. ITier
s
changes
Amer.
J.
Us. 46: 473.
1968. Effect of direct tetanixation
on twitch tension
and
C. and
Porter. K.
intrafibrillar
R...
restoring
1966. force
Muscle relaxation: evidence in
vertebrate striated
for
muscle.
7 14.
Perry. S. V.. 1960. Introduction to the contractile processes in striated
muscle. In 77ic Contractile Process: Proceedings of a
sponsored by the
New York
Brown and Company,
p. 63.
Heart
Assocation.
Porter,
cells
/*//
R,
K,
Science
reticulum and 26
ti
n
!09
1959. Intracellular
impulse COD
129: 721.
and Fran/mi Armstrong, Amer. 212(3): 72.
.
14
('.,
1965.
The sarcoplasmic
Sci
M
1).
New
19(17.
.
ihe Neurophysiology of Postural Mecha
York: Plenum Press.
.
Muscle as
1962,
a Tissue.
New
York:
Sechenov, I.. 1935, Selected Works. Moscow and Leningrad: Stale Publishing House 1863 quote). (
of forearm flexors
symposium
Boston:
and extensors.
M.. and Padykula, H.
J.
Appl. Physiol.
A., 1962.
of individual muscle fibers of the rat.
Szent Gyorgyi,
Muscle.
New
A.,
1953.
21:
1435.
Histochemical classification Amer. J. Anat. 110(2): 103.
Chemical Physiology of Body and Heart
York: Academic Press.
Szent Gyorgyi, A. G., 1960. Proteins of the myofibril. In Structure in
developing cat leg muscles. Acfa Physiol. Scand. 74: 319. Parsons.
and
k and Horvath, S. M„ McGraw-Hill Book Company.
.Stein, J.
M
B..
rhe urcoplasmic
Muscle
Singh, M., and Karpovich, P. V., 1966. Isotonic and isometric forces
ind, L.. and Molnar, J., 1962. Biochemical control of relaxation in muscle systems. In Muscle as a Tissue, edited by K. Rodahl and Horvath. New York: McGraw-Hill Book Company, p. 97. S
Nystrom,
R
of Skeletal
sartorius, J. Cell
muscle
K.
rusms.
-
m
reticulum Roberts, T.
Rodahl.
213(6): 18.
Huxley,
Porter.
L965
frog
L
duction
tion.
D
I
tubules
126
rhe contraction of muscle. Sci. Amir,
1958
EL,
K
Physiol. (London) 111:
J.
and Chemistry
Little,
and Function of Muscle. Vol. II, edited by G. H. Bourne. New York: Academic Press, p. 1. Walker. S. M.. and Schrodt, G. R., 1967. Contraction of skeletal muscle. Amer. J. Phys. Med. 46: 151. Walls. E. W., 1960. The microanatomy of muscle. In Structure and Function of Muscle. Vol.
Academic Wells,
J.
B..
slow and
I,
edited by G. H. Bourne.
New
York:
Press, p. 21. 1965.
fast
Comparison of mechanical properties betweeen
mammalian
muscles. J. Physiol. (London) 178: 252.
SECTION ONE
CHAPTKK
PHYSIOLOGY OF SKELETAL MUSCLE
Factors
Which
Affect the
Magnitude
11
of
Contractile Tension THE MAGNITUDE OF CONTRACTILE TENSION When a single adequate pulse is applied to a whole muscle, the muscle will respond with a quick contraction, followed immediately by relaxation. Such a response is called a twitch. Its magnitude will vary with the number of muscle fibers which respond to the stimulus and this will vary directly with the intensity of the pulse up to a finite maximal intensity. The twitch is an indication of force development by the muscle. After a short latent period tension becomes evident and rises in a hyperbolic manner to a peak (the contraction period). It then declines over a slightly longer time course to zero (the relaxation period) (Fig.
The tension developed by a contracting muscle is influenced by a number of factors such as the characteristics of the stimulus, the length of the muscle both at the time of stimulation and during the contraction, and the speed at which the muscle is required to contract.
The Stimulus Most oi what has been learned about muscle has been derived from studies using stimulation by electrical pulses. Although it is an artificial stimulus, electricity has distinct advantages for experimental purposes because it can be precisely controlled. The intensity, form (time course of rise to and duration of peak intensity), and frequency of pulses can be arbitrarily selected and varied as desired. Measurable responses of the muscle can be correlated with the quantitated stimulus char-
11. LA)
The time
course of the development of overt tension is influenced by the interaction of the contractile components of the fibrils with the elastic components of the muscle. Figure ll.l.B illustrates the sequence of events and their influence on the shape of in the twitch
acteristics.
A
curarized muscle
may be
stimulated directly by
pulses applied to the muscle tissue or indirectly
the twitch curve. 1. The active state is evident even before tension appears. It reaches full intensity abruptly, is maintained for about half of the contraction period, and then progressively declines during the rest of the contraction
by
pulses applied to its motor nerve fibers. The response of the whole muscle, of a single motor unit, or of one
muscle fiber
may be
studied under controlled con-
ditions.
period. 2. The contractile components begin to undergo activation during the latter half of the latent period. As they shorten, the elastic components of the muscle are
The Single Pulse
Response of Muscle to a Single Pulse. If a single pulse of adequate intensity is applied directly to a muscle fiber, the fiber will respond in an all-or-none fashion. Increasing the intensity of the pulse will not increase the magnitude of the fiber's response. It is important to mention here that the all-or-none response of the muscle fiber is determined by the all-or-none
stretched and begin to exert passive elastic tension. Elastic tension is low at first. During this time the contractile elements are able to shorten rapidly. 3. When the active state is at full intensity, about halfway through the contractile period, the elastic tension is rising rapidly. 4. As the active state begins to decline in the latter half of the contractile period, its intensity is still sufficient to continue to stretch the elastic components, and tension continues to mount but at a decreasing rate. The twitch curve begins to round off. 5. At the peak of the twitch curve, tension in the contractile and elastic elements is in equilibrium. 6. Beyond the peak, as the active state continues its decay, developed tension falls below elastic tension and
character of its excitation and not by any all-or-none limitations inherent in the contractile mechanism itself. The production of local graded contractions by applying small electric currents through microelectrodes to specific selected areas of the sarcomere was mentioned earlier. These contractions are not propagated along the fiber but are restricted to the region stimulated. They are not all-or-none but vary directly with the intensitv of the stimulus.
147
SCIENTIFIC BASES OF
UNDERSTANDING THE
148
HUMAN MOVEMENT fiber is stimulated to contract isometrically until its full active state has been developed. Then it is suddenly released to a slightly shorter length. Tension falls immediately but is quickly re-developed, at a rate exceeding that in a normal twitch. The peak level, however, is lower. By varying the time of release and plotting
A FIGURE stimulus;
B
11.1.
A, Tension development
latent
/.
period;
2.
in
contraction
a
muscle twitch.
period;
3.
S.
relaxation
and tension development. superimposed on the twitch tension
period. B. Relationship of active state
Active state (broken
line)
curve (solid
peak of active
line).
7.
is
state;
2.
elastic
components
begin to exert tension; 3. tension rises rapidly; 4. as active state
begins to decline, tension continues to 5. at the
are
in
rise
but at a decreasing rate;
peak of the twitch curve, contractile and
elastic tensions
equilibrium; 6, as the active state continues to decay, recoil
of the elastic
and tension
components stretches out the
falls;
7.
active state
has returned to zero See text
decay
is
contractile elements complete before tension
for further discussion.
the elastic components recoil, stretching out the contractile components. Overall tension falls. 7. Decay of the active state is completed before tension returns to zero. The fact that tension outlasts the active state is partially explained on the assumption that the breaking of cross bridges requires more time than their formation. Therefore the recoil of the elastic components lengthens the contractile material less rapidly than the rate of decay of the active state (Hanson and Lowy: Walker and Schrodt*). The time course and intensity of the active state are studied by the techniques of quick stretch and quick release. Because of the elastic components and the viscosity of muscle tissue, the externally measured force exerted in a twitch is less than the full capability of the contractile material: that is, less than the intensity of the active state. The viscoelastic effect may be counteracted and the full tension characteristics of the contractile elements registered by employing quick stretch or quick release. If, coincident with stimulation, the muscle is given a short, quick stretch which pulls out the elastic elements just slightly beyond what their effective excursion would be, the muscle is relieved of the necessity of stretching out the elastic components and its full tension is revealed. By this means the onset, rise time and duration of the peak intensity of the active state can be determined.
The time course of the decay of the active state is studied by the method of quick release, in which the
of
* For references appearing Chapter 10.
re-developed tension against time, a curve reflecting the decline of the active state is obtained (Fig. ll.l.B). Characteristics of the Single Pulse and Their Influence on the Muscle Twitch. An adequate stimulus may be defined as any environmental change, external or internal, which arouses in the contractile material an active state of sufficient magnitude to produce measurable tension. Whether natural or artificial the environmental change must meet certain minimal requirements in regard to its basic characteristics: the magnitude or intensity of the change, its abruptness or rate of rise, and the duration of its application. Within physiological limits, increase above minimum in any of these will induce an increased response in the muscle. f
in this chapter, see
Bibliography
at
end
A
must have a certain minimal minimum is an inverse measure of the irritability of the tissue: the smaller the minimal intensity, the greater the irritability. The minimal effective intensity is designated the threshold or liminal stimulus. These terms refer to the weakest stimulus which will evoke a barely perceptible response. Subthreshold and subliminal refer to a stimulus of inadequate intensity. As the intensity of the single pulse is increased above 1.
Intensity.
single electrical pulse
intensity to be effective.
The
minimal, contractile tension
level of the
in the
muscle increases progressively as
more and more muscle fibers. Finally an intensity is reached which evokes the maximal response of which the muscle is capable. Presumably all fibers are then active. Further increase in intensity will not be accompanied by further increase in contraction. The weakest stimulus intensity which will evoke maximal
a result of the activation of
contraction of a muscle
is
called the
maximal stimulus.
Abruptness or Rate of Rise. A weak but adequate pulse with a rapid rate of rise from zero to its pre-set intensity will evoke a stronger contraction than will a pulse of the same intensity with a slower rise. A minimal rate is required even for an intense stimulus. If intensity rises too gradually, there will be no response at all; the stimulus is then ineffectual. For any stimulus of adequate intensity, the more abruptly it is applied the greater will be the response it evokes, within 2.
the limits of the muscle's capacity. rapidly
it
need
A common
rise to
The
produce a given
greater the intensity the less
level of response.
experience illustrates the principle.
If
the hand
is
plunged abruptly into hot water of about 110°F. the response (sensation of heatl resulting from the abruptness of the change in skin temperature from about 93° to near 110°F will be greater than if the change is made gradually by first immersing the hand in water at skin
temperature and then slowly raising the temperature to 110°. If the rate of temperature change is too slow, the change will be imperceptible. 3.
Duration. For a stimulus of adequate intensity and
the duration of
Within
its
peak intensity
will
influence
its
limits, the longer its duration the greater will
rise rate,
effectiveness.
be the muscle's
response. Exclusive limits are found at both extremes: the duration
can be so short that no response will occur in spite of the fact that the same intensity and abruptness would be sufficient with longer duation, or the duration can be so long that the response decreases
t In a single fiber, only
produce an increase in
its
an increase
in the
frequency of stimuli will
all-or-none response.
Magnitude together.
until
laboratory
uls
when
the latter
direct current
is
is
.1
common
experience
in
the
used to stimulate tissue The muscle
\
the closing of the circuit but ceases to respond .b current
st
!*
of Contractile Tension
flow continues at the constant (peak) level.
The duration
of the peak
intensity has exceeded the response capabilities of the tissue
The
and duration of direct production o( a barely perceptible contraction is presented in the intensity-duration curve shown in Figure 11.2. Note that both the upper and lower ends oi the curve become straight lines, one vertical and the other horizontal, neither meeting the coordinate. The upper end indicates that even a very strong stimulus must be applied tor at least a minimal duration to be effective. The lower end shows that below a certain minimal intensity a stimulus will not induce a response regardless of its duration. Between these limits, the greater the intensity, the less duration is required to produce a response. For a stimulus of constant intensity and rate of rise, the longer its duration the greater will be the response up to a finite limit, beyond which effectiveness diminishes progressively to zero (Fig. 11. 3. A). The duration required for a given stimulus to evoke a perceptible response is its excitation time and is. within the limits discussed above, inversely related to the intensity. If a stimulus of constant intensity and duration is applied at various rates of rise, effectiveness will be directly related to the rate. The more abruptly the stimulus is applied the greater will be the muscle's response. As the rate decreases, the response will diminish until ultimately, regardless of intensity, the stimulus becomes ineffectual (Fig. 11.3.B). The decreased effectiveness of a constant stimulus intensity at long duration and/or low rate of rise is designated adaptation or accommodation. Many relationship of intensity
current
in
the
A
FIGURE rise
and
shown
in
11.3.
B
Comparison
duration
peak
of
of single pulses in regard to rate of intensity
Hypothetical
responses are
(Note: the time scale of the pulses
circle insets
greatly
is
exaggerated as compared with that of the responses A, duration of pulse. Four pulses of identical intensity and rate of rise but with )
shown: /, duration too moderate duration: probably the most
effectiveness
different durations are
long:
low.
effective;
2,
duration: of rise. different
less effective; 4,
duration too short:
ineffectual
3.
short
B, rate
Three pulses of identical intensity and duration but with rise
times are shown;
effective stimulus; 2,
/.
the most rapid
less rapid rise:
least effective (response
much reduced
rise:
less effective; 3,
the
least
most rapid:
or absent).
adapt to a gradual or persistent stimulus. The physiological changes which are induced by the stimulus are apparently reversed at a rate which is faster than their development under the existing conditions. In the case of muscle tissue, excitatory processes may be inadequate to activate the tissue or, if activated, the magnitude or persistence of the active state may be insufficient to stretch out the elastic components enough to produce overt tension. The rate of rise and duration of electric pulses may be varied as required for the principle under study. For most studies of concern to us, a pulse of rapid rise and short duration is used, with variations in its intensity appropriate to experimental objectives. tissues besides muscle
Repetitive Stimulation
DURATION FIGURE
11.2.
(msec)
Intensity-duration curve. The upper limb of the
curve indicates that even a very strong stimulus must be applied for at least a
shows
minimal duration
that
below
a
in
certain
order to be effective The lower limb minimal intensity a stimulus will not
induce a response regardless of intensity
its
duration
and duration are inversely related
Between these
limits
Response to Repetitive Pulses. If an adequate stimulus is applied to a muscle fiber repeatedly at a rate rapid enough so that each succeeding stimulus reactivates the contractile elements before the previous tension has completely subsided, successive responses summate, each building upon the previous until a maximal level is achieved. If stimulation is continued, the contraction peak is maintained at this level. Such a response is known as tetanus or tetanic contraction. Ultimately, fatigue will cause the peak level to decline progressively. When stimulation ceases, contraction terminates and the fiber relaxes, tension subsiding quickly to zero. If, however, the repetitive stimulation
UNDERSTANDING THE
150
SCIENTIFIC BASES OF
too prolonged, contracture will result and relaxation be very much slowed as compared with normal. Unlike rigor, contracture is reversible. is
will
Effect of Frequency of Pulses upon Response. The frequency of stimulation, usually expressed as cycles per second (some investigators employ the recently adopted physical unit, hertz), determines both the shape and the magnitude of a tetanic contraction traced on a myograph by an excised muscle. When pulses are delivered with a period which places successive stimuli during the relaxation phase of the preceding response, the contraction approaches a tremor and a scalloped tracing results. This is incomplete tetanus. With a period which is short enough to restimulate during the contraction phase, the tracing is smooth. This is complete tetanus (Fig. 11.4). Within physiological limits, the shorter the period (i.e., the greater the frequency) the smoother the curve and the greater the tension development will be. If, however, the period is shortened beyond a certain point, the refractory period will be encountered. The absolute refractory period is a short space of time immediately following stimulation during which the muscle cannot be reexcited regardless of stimulus intensity. This is followed by a longer period, the relative refractory period, during which irritability is gradually regained and the tissue will respond to a stimulus which is appropriately greater than threshold. The earlier the pulse falls in the relative refractory period the greater its intensity must be to be effective. Although both portions of the refractory period last for a finite time, in muscle both have been completed before tension begins. Stimulation of skeletal muscle in the living animal is normally accomplished by a train of impulses transmitted to the muscle fibers over their motor neurons. The magnitude and duration of the impulses in any neuron are essentially constant but frequencies vary, sometimes over a wide range. Therefore the latter is the characteristic which influences the response of muscle fibers and is of concern to us in studying human
movement.
The frequency of impulses in human motor neurons generally ranges from 20 to 40 per second. At such stimulation rates, the normal response of the muscle an incomplete tetanus. Muscle contractions, appear smooth because excitation by the various motor neurons is not synchronous and hence
fiber
is
however,
HUMAN MOVEMENT motor units respond out of phase. The relaxation in one motor unit is offset by contraction in another. Any oscillations of tension which might occur are further smoothed out by the transmission of tension to the lever through a common tendon. The tension developed by the muscle depends upon the number of motor units activated and the frequency of activiation of the muscle fibers composing each unit. During maximal exertion the frequency of motor impulses may be great enough to produce complete tetanic contractions. If so, synchrony of responses in motor units develops and tremor results, a common experience in all-out effort. Tetanus-Twitch Ratio. The tension developed in response to repetitive pulses is greater than that evoked by a single pulse of the same magnitude. The tetanustwitch ratio varies with different muscles and may be as great as 5 (rat gastrocnemius). To explain the greater tension developed in a tetanic contraction, it has been postulated that in a twitch the short duration of the active state allows too few bridge movements to permit
the contractile material to shorten enough to fully stretch out the elastic components before the active state begins to subside. Hence the full capacity for tension production cannot be realized. Repetitive stimulation, however, by maintaining the active state, permits continuation of bridge activity. The stretching of the elastic components is developed.
is
completed and
full
tension
Post-tetanic Potentiation in Muscle. In many muscles, especially when curarized, if twitch responses to single pulses are recorded before and immediately after a period of tetanic stimulation, the post-tetanic twitch shows an increase in magnitude and a steeper rise of tension than the pre-tetanic control. This phenomenon is known as post-tetanic potentiation (PTP). The effect occurs whether the muscle is stimulated directly or indirectly by its motor nerve. Potentiation is maximal shortly after the repetitive stimulation and then decays exponentially at a rate which is dependent on both the frequency of pulses and the number delivered in the train. Short trains produce potentiation without any alteration of the twitch duration, but longer trains result in lengthening of the contraction time and of the half-relaxation time (the time required for tension to drop to 50% of its peak value).
has been suggested (Close and Hoh), the of PTP is located within the muscle fibers, it may involve prolongation of the active state with a resulting increase in the number of fully activated myofibrils in the fiber. Or it may be due to an increased + liberation of some activator substance, perhaps Ca ", which induces an increase in the number of bridges formed between actin and myosin and in the rate of If,
as
mechanism
their cycling.
FIGURE
11.4.
Response
to
repetitive
stimulation.
single twitch in response to a single stimulus: curve 2.
response to low frequency repetition of the stimulus; complete tetanus in response to higher frequency repetition the stimulus Same stimulus used in all three
tetanus curve of
Curve 1. incomplete
3.
Conclusion
in
To be adequate, stimulation must consist of an appropriate combination of intensity, rate of rise.
Magnitude duration and frequency to excite muscle fibers and to activate their contractile material sufficiently to pro duce measurable tension. Within the limits discussed, the adequacy of the stimulus is determined by the interaction of these mutually interdependent charec teristies. In the living body an adequate environmental change results in the generation and conduction of a
shorten.
active
of Contractile Tension
Their shortening,
as
161
discussed above under
by
stretching of the elastic components. By current usage, an isometric contraction is one in which the external length of the muscle remains unchanged. (Isometric contraction is sometimes called static contraction.) state,
offset
is
Isotonic Contraction. If the internal force produced the muscle exceeds the external force of the resistance and the muscle shortens, producing movement, the contraction is isotonic. (This is sometimes called a concentric or a shortening contraction.) Energy utilization is greater than that required to produce tension which will balance the load, and the extra energy is used to shorten the muscle. During isotonic contraction work is done on the load by the muscle. This is
action potentials in motor neurons which becomes responsible tor excitation of the muscle fibers. The frequency of impulses reflects the effectiveness of the stimulation and determines the magnitude of the muscle tension developed. Because the magnitude and form of the nerve impulses are constant for any given set of body conditions, the frequency of these impulses is the most significant characteristic in determining the
by
muscle's response.
positive work. Work is the product of the load and the distance that the load is lifted.
train
of
Muscle Length
W
The most obvious property
of muscle
to develop tension against resistance.
capacity length of the
is its
The
the time of activation markedly affects its ability to develop tension and to perform external work. Muscle tension may be measured in terms of the greatest load which can just be lifted or as the maximal tension read-out on a strain gauge or tensiometer. When a muscle contracts, the contractile material itself shortens, but whether the whole muscle shortens or not depends on the relation of the internal force developed by the muscle to the external force exerted by the resistance or load. The terms "force" and "tension" are often used erroneously as synonyms. Tension is a scalar quantity having magnitude only, while force is a vector quantity having both magnitude
muscle
and
at
direction.
The term tension
is
used
in
this
discussion to refer to the magnitude of the pull of the muscle as it would be registered on a strain gauge arranged in line with the muscle axis. Internal force is used to refer to the moment of the tension magnitude acting in the direction of the action line of the muscle under given conditions, and external force refers to the moment of the resistance opposing the muscle.
Types of Muscle Contraction 1945 Fenn identified three types of muscle contraction according to the length change, if any, induced by the relationship of internal and external forces. The three types are here designated isometric, isotonic, and eccentric contraction. Isometric Contraction. If the internal force generated by the contractile components does not exceed the external force of the resistance and if no change of muscle length occurs during the contraction, the contraction is isometric. The available energy* expended by the muscle and the tension produced against the resistance may be considered to be in equilibrium. No contraction in the body is purely isometric because at the fibril level the contractile components do In
*
Available energy
is
that portion of the released energy which
available to the muscle for production of tension and/or work.
is
where
W
is
work
pounds, and d
=
F
x d
Eq. 11.1
pounds, F is force of the load in the distance in feet that the load is
in foot
is
lifted.
A
muscle can develop greater tension in isometric in isotonic contraction because none of the available energy is expended in shortening. In isotonic contraction the greatest load that the muscle can lift is about 80% of its maximal isometric tension. Eccentric Contraction. If to an already shortened muscle an external force greater than the internal force is added and the muscle is allowed to lengthen while continuing to maintain tension, the contraction is called eccentric. (The term lengthening contraction is sometimes used.) The energy expended by the muscle is less than the tension exerted on the load, but the muscle acts as a brake controlling the movement of the load. In eccentric contraction a muscle can sustain greater tension than it can develop in isometric contraction at any given equivalent static length. During an eccentric contraction negative work is done by the load on the muscle. Negative work is meas= F x d, the ured in the same units as positive work, only difference being that d is the distance that the load is lowered. The amount of negative work performed is than
W
the
same
lifting the
as the amount of positive work involved in same load the same distance. While chemical
energy is expended by the muscle in both instances, the energy cost of the negative work is considerably less than for the positive work. The difference is indicated by a lower oxygen uptake during the negative work, being about one-tenth as much in human subjects. Other estimates have placed the cost at one-third to onethirteenth of that required for the equivalent amount of positive work. Eccentric contractions are very common. Every
movement
is controlled by an contraction. Examples include sitting, squatting or lying down, bending forward or sideward, going down stairs, stooping, placing any object down onto a surface, etc. In eccentric contractions the active muscles are those which are the antagonists of the same
eccentric
in the direction of gravity
152
UNDERSTANDING THE
movement when
it
is
made
SCIENTIFIC BASES OF
HUMAN MOVEMENT eccentric force was lowest of the three at the start (shortened position, elbow at 140°), it had exceeded isotonic force when the angle reached 120°, and by 100° it had surpassed isometric force as well (Fig. 11.5.B). Daily activities involve a continual shifting from one to another type of contraction and of combinations of the three types, as required. During movements the changing lengths of lever arms and of angles of pull, for both muscle and load, introduce complexities which require complicated processes of neuromuscular integration to properly adjust the number and actitivy of motor units to the task.
against gravity. Sitting or
controlled by leg extensors, not flexors; lying down, by hip flexors, not extensors; lowering a load, by shoulder flexors, not extensors, etc. Electromyograms show not only that anatomically antagonistic
squatting
is
muscles are actively controlling the eccentric movement but also that the electrical activity in these muscles is less than when the same muscles are contracting isotonically to do the same amount of positive work with the same load over the same distance and at the same speed.
Some textbooks still state that a muscle develops its greatest tension during isometric contraction. The work of Singh and Karpovich demonstrates that the force
Relationship of Muscle Tension to Length
developed by elbow flexor and extensor muscles in eccentric contraction exceeds that in both isotonic and isometric contraction at most muscle lengths. Using an instrument designed by Singh, they measured muscle force through the entire range of motion at the elbow joint, simultaneously recording the angle through which the forearm was moving. With the elbow flexors,
The initial length of a muscle, i.e., its length at the time of stimulation, influences the magnitude of its
A stretched contracts more forcefully than when it is unstretched at the time of activation. This is true whether the contraction is isometric, isotonic, or eccentric. Within physiological limits, the greater the initial length, the greater will be the muscle's tension capability. Parallel-fibered muscles exert maximal total contractile response to a given stimulus.
muscle
eccentric force was consistently the greatest of the three over the entire range of motion and isotonic was least (Fig. 11. 5. A). With the elbow extensors, although
60r
50
40
30
Eccentric Force
20
Isometric Force
.
-Concentric Force * Starting
10
50°
60°
_L
_L
_L
70°
80°
Elbow Angle
FIGURE
Angle
90° in
100°
110°
120°
130° 140°
Degrees
Concentric, isometric, and eccentric tension curves. A. curves of maximal concentric, isometric, and eccentric tension of forearm flexor muscles. B. curves of maximal concentric, isometric, and eccentric tension of forearm extensor muscles. (From Singh. M.. and Karpovich. P. V. 1966 Isotonic and 11.5.
isometric forces of forearm flexors and extensors. J.
Appl
Physiol. 21
:
1435
)
1o
Magnitude of Contractile Tension
50
40
30
:c
to
-
-
Eccentric Force Isometric Force
^•—•-Concentric
J
50°
60°
70° Elbow
*
flex.
The stretch response should not be confused with the stretch reThe latter is a response mediated by the nervous system, while
the former
is
a property of
muscle tissue independent of nerve.
I
90°
Angle
FIGURE
tension at lengths only slightly greater than rest length. Muscles with other fiber arrangements have maxima at somewhat greater relative stretch. In general, optimal length is close to the muscle's maximal body length, i.e.. the greatest length that the muscle can attain in the normal living body. This is about 1.2 to 1.3 times the muscle's rest length. Tension capability is less at shorter and longer lengths. Therefore a muscle can exert the greatest tension or sustain the heaviest load when the body position is such as to bring it to its optimal length. In isotonic contractions the increased tension and longer length permit greater shortening, hence more work can be done or. alternatively, the same work can be done at lower energy cost. The diminished energy cost of eccentric contraction is in part due to this stretch response," but other factors are also involved, as evidenced by the capacity to produce greater tension than with either isometric or isotonic contractions at most equivalent lengths. The relationship of tension to muscle length may be presented graphically in the form of a tension-length curve in which tensions in an isolated muscle are plotted against a series of muscle lengths from less than to greater than the resting length (Fig. 11.6). Both the passive elastic tension (curve 1) exerted by the elastic components in the passively stretched muscle and the total tension (curve 2) exerted bv the activelv con-
I
80°
in
Force
Angle
* Starting
I
I
I
100° 110° 120° 130° 140°
Degrees
11.5. B.
muscle are plotted. Since total tension represents the sum of elastic tension plus the developed tension of the contractile elements, the latter may be found by subtraction and is represented by the area between the curves for total and elastic tensions. Values for developed tension are shown as curve 3. Note the following facts regarding developed tension. tracting
a.
At less than SO^r of
rest
length the muscle cannot develop
contractile tension. b.
At normal
(intact) rest length the
muscle
is
already in slight
passive elastic tension. At this length the muscle produces
developed tension c.
When
(total tension
contraction
although total tension
is
is
minus passive
its
greatest
elastic tension).
initiated at a length longer than rest length,
greater than at rest length, developed tension
has already diminished and declines progressively at
all
greater
lengths. d. At extreme lengths (far right end of the curves) total tension would ultimately become equal to elastic tension, developed tension
being zero.
Maximal
tension is assumed to be lengths are such that maximal single overlap of actin and myosin filaments exists. At greater lengths the number of cross links diminishes as overlap decreases, and at shorter lengths double overlap results in reduced tension as a result of the antagonistic action of bridges. Gordon and colleagues investigated the tension-length relationship in frog skeletal muscle fibers at various sarcomere lengths. Their results are plotted in Figure 11.7. In these fibers the mean sarcomere length was 2.5 n and the mean
developed
contractile
when
sarcomere
UNDERSTANDING THE
154
HUMAN MOVEMENT
SCIENTIFIC BASES OF
filament lengths were 1.5 n for myosin and 1.0 ^ for Maximal tension was developed at sarcomere lengths of 2.0 to 2.25 m- At greater lengths tension decreased linearly, becoming zero at about 3.65 n. At shorter lengths tension declined gradually with decreasing length until about 1.7 m and then dropped abruptly
process most probably associated with significant lengths on the tension-length curve presented above. Figure 11.8, A through D, presents four of these stages, as follows.
actin.
to zero at about 1.27
A. Sarcomere length 2.5
\i.
the myosin filaments of the
pi.
A
Actin filaments only partially overlap bands. Therefore not
attach. Tension capability at this length
Drawing upon these data and the electron microscope evidence of filament relationships in contracted muscle, we may postulate the stages of the sliding filament
B. Sarcomere length 2.25
drawn
into the
potentially
all
A band
fi.
Ends
is
all
about 85% of
bridges can
maximum.
of the actin filaments have been
to the edge of the
pseudo-H zone. Here,
bridges can attach and maximal single overlap occurs.
Tension capability at this length is maximal. C. Sarcomere length 2.0 n. Ends of the actin filaments have reached the center of the sarcomere. Maximal overlap still exists and tension capability is still maximal. D. Sarcomere length 1.5 p. Z discs have collided with the ends of the myosin filaments. Ends of the actin filaments have passed beyond the pseudo-H zone limits and entered the antagonistic bridge areas on the opposite sides of the sarcomere. Tension capability is reduced to about 45% of maximal.
The work
of Gordon and colleagues thus provides further evidence favoring the sliding filament theory and
supporting the concept of a quantitative relationship between tension and the number of bridges linking actin
and myosin filaments.
Speed of Contraction 100
% FIGURE 1.
Most isolated nonloaded muscles normally shorten by about 50% or less of their rest length. The absolute amount by which any muscle can shorten depends upon the length and arrangement of its fibers, the greatest shortening occurring in the long parallel-fibered muscles such as the biceps and sartorius. In intact muscle, shortening is further limited by the structure of joints,
of rest length
Tension-length curves for isolated muscle. Curve tension in a muscle passively stretched to lengths, curve 2, total tension exerted by muscle
11.6.
passive
increasing
elastic
contracting actively from increasingly greater
initial
lengths; curve 3.
developed tension calculated by subtracting elastic tension values
on curve
1
from
total tension
values at equivalent lengths on curve 2.
SARCOMERE LENGTH
FIGURE
11.7. Tension-length curve for frog
muscle
(^1
sacomere lengths. The
letters on the Note that tension is zero both at the shortened length of 1.27^ and at the extended length of about 3.7// is maximal over lengths 2 00^ and 2 25 n and declines rapidly below 1.67/j and above 2.25 M (After Gordon. A. M. Huxley. A. F., and Julian. F. J 1966 Variation in isometric tension with sarcomere length in vertebrate muscle fibers.
at various
tension curve and the broken vertical lines relate tension to significant sarcomere lengths
.
.
.
J.
Physiol
fibrils at
(London) 184: Fig
some
of the lengths.
12. p
185.) See Fig
1
1.8 for
diagrams of probable filament relations
in
myo-
Magnitude
of Contractile Tension z
z
B
"
C
_
,,
,
J
FIGURE 11.8. Schematic drawings of filament relationships at various stages of the sliding filament process associated with significant lengths on the tension-length curve presented in Fig 117 M. myosin. A. actin: Z. Z disc A, sarcomere length 2.5 m Actin filaments are partially overlapping the myosin filaments in the A band B. sarcomere length 2.25 ft. Actin filaments are in maximal single overlap with the bridgecontaining regions of the myosin filaments C, sarcomere length 2.0 m Actin filaments have reached the center of the A band D. sarcomere length 1.5 m Z discs have collided with the ends of the myosin filaments Ends of the actin filaments have passed into the bridge area of the opposite half of the sarcomere .
the
resistance
of
antagonists,
and any load which
opposes the muscle. Intrinsic
The
Speed of Shortening
speed of a muscle reflects the rate of shortening at the sarcomere level. It is limited by the rate at which bridges can attach, move, and detach and by the rates of the chemical reactions involved. With muscle attachments severed, shortening speed of the contractile material is maximal but no tension is developed. A muscle can produce tension only when shortening against resistance, and the amount of tension developed is equal to the load. When shortening against resistance, speed varies inversely with the load. Therefore in isotonic contraction the less the resistance the more nearly maximal is the rate of shortening. This may be explained as follows: the active state arises abruptly upon stimulation and persists for a relatively fixed period of time; the less resistance which is met by the contractile material the more readily the bridges function and the greater the distance of shortening accomplished during the persistence of the active state. When a muscle is required to shorten more rapidly against the same load, less tension is produced than when shortening more slowly. This may be due to the fact that fewer links are formed between actin and myosin in the shorter time available and that the bridges which do form are detached more quickly. Consequently at higher speeds fewer bridges will be intrinsic shortening
attached at any given moment and less tension is produced. Hill has pointed out that the load determines the rate of the chemical reactions associated with contraction and that the magnitude of the velocity depends on the difference between the actual load being lifted and the maximal magnitude of force of which the muscle is capable. Barany's work supports the correlation of ATPase activity and speed of contraction in 14 different muscles of mammals, lower vertebrates, and invertebrates.
In isometric contraction, different levels of tension are
achieved at the same rate. Since no shortening is involved beyond that needed to stretch out the elastic components, the rate of tension development is constant, determined by the active state. Hence the time to reach any given tension will be proportional to the tension: lower tensions will be achieved sooner than higher tensions.
Force-Velocity Relation a scalar quantity, lacking the component of while velocity is a vector quantity having both magnitude and direction. Therefore the term speed has been used in the discussion of the rate of intrinsic shortening of the contractile material and the rate of tension development within the muscle, for direction was not significant. The term velocity is used to discuss the rate of muscle shortening against external
Speed
is
direction,
UNDERSTANDING THE
156
SCIENTIFIC BASES OF
resistance, i.e., the rate of movement, for in such considerations direction is an influential factor. The velocity at which a muscle shortens is influenced by the force that it must produce to move the load. In isotonic contraction the relationship is evidenced by the decrease in velocity as the load is increased (Fig. 11.9, solid line curve). Shortening velocity is maximal with zero load and reflects the intrinsic shortening speed of the contractile material. Velocity reaches zero with a load just too great for the muscle to lift; contraction is then isometric and maximal force can be produced.* When more muscle fibers are activated than are needed to overcome the load, the excess force is converted into increasing velocity and therefore greater distance of movement. A commonly experienced example is the exaggerated movement which occurs when one lifts a light object anticipated to be much heavier. In eccentric contraction, values for shortening velocity become negative and the muscle's ability to sustain tension increases with increased speed of lengthening, but not to the extent which might be expected from extrapolation of the shortening curve (see broken line in Fig. 11.9 extending the curve from the hyperbola of the force-velocity curve below the abscissa into the area of lengthening velocity). In isotonic contractions the length and tension of the elastic components do not change once they are sufficiently stretched to permit the load to be raised. Therefore isotonic twitch myograms reflect the velocity as well as the extent of shortening. When an excised frog gastrocnemius muscle records twitch responses with different loads, the lighter the load the higher is the twitch curve and the steeper its rising slope (Fig. 11.10). In other words, the lighter the load the greater the amount of shortening per unit of time. With a light load (Fig. 11. 10. A) the muscle's maximal velocity as measured over the steepest part of the contraction is 17 in 0.01 second or 1.7 meters per second. With a moderate load (Fig. 11.10.B) velocity is 12 in 0.01 second or 1.2 meters per second, and with a heavy load (Fig. 11.10.C) 5 in 0.01 second or 0.5 meter per second.
HUMAN MOVEMENT optimum are uneconomical because must be maintained over a longer time, hence more energy is expended to achieve the same amount of shortening. Velocities above optimum waste energy because of the need to employ a greater number of muscle fibers to achieve the same force. A plausible Velocities below
force
explanation is as follows: (1) the tension developed will be proportional to the number of bridges attached at any moment; (2) chemical reaction rates dictate that a finite and constant time is required for a bridge to attach; (3) the greater the speed at which the active sites on the actin filament move past the myosin bridges, the fewer the bridges that can attach and the less will be the tension; (4) as a result, more muscle
LOAD
FIGURE
Relationship of velocity of shortening to tension
11.9.
isotonic contraction (solid
in
(g)
line curve).
As the
load
increased,
Is
velocity of shortening decreases, reaching zero with a load just too
great
for
velocities
the
muscle to
eccentric
In
lift
become negative and
speed of lengthening (broken
contraction,
shortening
increases with increased
tension
line).
mm
mm
mm
Optimal Velocity
The force-velocity relationship may also be stated conversely in terms of the influence of velocity upon force: a rapidly contracting muscle generates less force than does one contracting more slowly. From the standpoint of efficiency, however, energy expenditure is least
when work
is
done
at
moderate
velocity.
With any
given load, if the velocity of shortening is gradually increased, the work output of the muscle rises at first, reaches a peak, and then declines. Therefore, for any load the optimal velocity lies somewhere intermediate to the slowest and fastest shortening rates. Furthermore, the greater the load the lower is the optimal velocity with which it can be moved.
FIGURE 11.10. Shortening velocity of excised frog gastrocnemius with three different loads. Stimulus (s): a. 001 second taken at steepest part of contraction; b. amount shortening
of
light
load,
steepest *
As previously
stated, greater forces can be sustained in eccentric
1.7
m
part
per
contraction than can be produced in either isometric or isotonic con-
per 0.01
traction.
is
5
mm
in
of
sec.
sec or
during
millimeters
maximal the B.
1.2
of
rate
contraction)
with
m
per 0.01 sec or
a
17
is
moderate
per sec. 5
that
m
time
shortening
C.
(as
mm
load,
unit
A.
with
over
taken per
01
velocity
is
sec
12
a
the or
mm
with a heavy load, velocity
per sec.
Magnitude l
\IU F
il.
l.
Compajrisoa of
fust
ami >lo« muscle
TiIhts: Histological, physiological,
of Contractile Tension
and biochemical
K.1M
Slow
Histological differences
and color
S
Fibers smaller ami redder because
Fibers large ami pale
"i
greater
myo
globin content
plasm
Granular sarcoplasm
Agranular sarcoplasm
Many
Fibrils
Fewer
fibrils
mitochondria but few Narrow / discs l-ir^e
Z discs
T
d
system
End
plates
Blood supply
)
A-I junctions
SR
sparse and rudimentary;
is
Single innervation bj Large somatic motor neurons with fast
fibrils
Numerous small mitochondria Wider / discs (about 2
number
Sarcoplasmic reticulum abundant and well developed;
T tubules (and triads) at Innervation
m
found
at
system, when present,
'1'
the / lines
Innervation by small, slow -conducting somatic motor neurons; multiple innervation
conduction rates
Discrete (en plaque) end plates with
many
sarcolem-
mal folds Few capillaries except those shared with adjacent
in
some
species.
Some
autonomic neurons Diffuse (en grappe) end plates with few or no junctional folds
slow-
fibers
Dense capillary supply, located angles between fibers
at
the interstitial
Physiological differences
Contraction cycle
Slower cycle (2-3 x); graded contraction
Rapid contraction-relaxation cycle
in
some
muscles Vetanus Potentials
Rapid onset of tetanic fusion but only at high frequencies and short-lasting Higher resting potential Larger end plate and action potentials
Slower onset of fusion but at lower frequencies and of longer duration
Lower
resting potential
Smaller end plate and action potentials, latter often
graded Active state
Endurance Tension capacity Elasticity
Rapid initial decay of active state Rapid fatigue Higher tension which develops rapidly Lower coefficient of elasticity
Slower
initial
decay
Greater endurance
Lower tension and slower development Greater elasticity
Biochemical differences
Metabolism Myoglobin content Glycogen Na and K"
Metabolism primarily
ATPase Low
glycolytic (as indicated
by high
High
Large glycogen storage
Variable glycogen storage
Less Na" and more K~; rapid loss of
K
+
during stim-
acids
More Na" and
Differences in concentration of various
fibers must be recruited to achieve the necessary force. Optimal speed probably reflects the greatest speed which will still allow a sufficient number of bridges to
attach to provide the required tension. Most individuals will unconsciously perform at optimal velocity if allowed to do so. Optima vary for the same individual with different loads and in different types of activity and among individuals for the same load or activity. In athletic performance efficiency is often sacrificed for other objectives, and rates above optimum are deliberately adopted. There is evidence that strength increase in a trained muscle is due to an increase in the number of fibrils per fiber. This would mean that there would be more bridges within the fiber which could attach per unit of time, and the force capability at any given velocity would be correspondingly greater. A trained muscle should be able to develop a given force more rapidly. In other words training should be expected to improve both force and optimal velocity of contraction. In isolated vertebrate muscle the Q of velocity* is 10 refers to the extent to
KT
;
rate of
K+
depletion dimin-
amino acids
Although studies have not been made directly in man, empiric evidence suggests that the velocity of muscle shortening is improved by "warming up." Experiments on the velocity effects of local warming or increased core temperature might indicate that artificial prewarming of athletes to a safe degree would improve their performance records. 2.5.
Slow and Fast Muscle Fibers Although
the
previous
which the rate of a chemical reaction
discussion
striated muscle in general, there
has
considered
abundant evidence
is
there are two types of skeletal muscle, distinguishable by speed of contraction and endurance. Almost 100 years ago Ranvier observed that some muscles of the rabbit were redder in color and that those muscles contracted in a slower and more sustained manner than did the paler muscles of the same animal. Since then the designations of red and that
is
increased by a 10°C. rise in temperature.
within the range 15 to 35°C.
Q
less
ishes with continued stimulation
ulation
Amino
Oxidative metabolism (as indicated by high succinic
dehydrogenase activity)
activity)
A Q 10
It
is
usually measured
of 2 indicates that the rate
doubled. For most biochemical reactions Q,„
lies
between
2.5
and
is
3.0.
UNDERSTANDING THE
158
SCIENTIFIC BASES OF
white muscles have become synonymous with slow and fast contraction. In addition to a slower contractionrelaxation cycle, red muscles have lower thresholds, tetanize at lower frequencies, fatigue less rapidly, and are more sensitive to stretch than the faster white
muscles. expected, individual muscle fibers behavior. contractile in differences these Investigations by a number of workers both here and abroad have revealed histological and biochemical differences which distinguish the two types of muscle fibers and which correlate with the physiological differences between fast (white) and slow (red) muscles.
As
might be
reflect
These are listed in Table 11.1. Examination of the table suggests obvious relationships between the several categories which are consistent with differences in speed and endurance. The
FIGURE activity
muscle
11.11.
HUMAN MOVEMENT larger size, greater density of fibrils, and lower viscosity of the white fibers should contribute to greater
speed. Their abundant sarcoplasmic reticulum and T tubules located at the A-I junctions should, by providing for the transport of glycolytic enzymes and for large scale release of Ca ++ ions in the vicinity of the cross bridges, also favor fast response. Conversely, in the red fibers reduction in the sarcoplasmic reticulum and sparsity of T tubules are appropriate to slower response. The discrete end plates and multiple folds in the subneural sarcolemma of the fast fibers may be expected to provide for increased activation. Where multiple innervation exists in slow fibers, it is consistent with the small graded action potentials which distinguish them from the fast fibers with their rapidly rising, larger potentials.
The
large glycogen stores
and high ATPase
Fast and slow muscle fibers. Rat muscle fibers stained to show succinic dehydrogenase (x230) of the medial head of the gastrocnemius muscle showing three types of
A. cross section fibers:
A, fast fibers
(light);
B.
intermediate fibers (slow); C. slowest fibers (dark)
(x125) from the soleus muscle shows only fibers are
indicated by arrows. (From Stein.
of individual
muscle
fibers of the rat.
fiber J.
types B and C M..
Amer.J.Anat
1
Two
and Padykula, 10(2); Fig 5. p
H.
B.
cross section
type C (darker) and one type B (lighter) A.,
1962. Histochemical classification
121 and
Fig. 12. p.
123.)
activity
Magnitude in the white fibers will favor speed of response but quicker fatigue is to be expected because of their lesser blood supply ami predominantly glycolytic metabolism. rhe increased endurance of the red fibers is consistent with their rich blood supply and abundance of mitochondria which support an essentially oxidative their small Furthermore, diameters metabolism.
provide a greater surface for exchange of gases, ions, provided by an equivalent is Rapid K depletion fibers. progressively alters the ionic gradients and ultimately limits the ability of the last fibers to perform work. In the slow fibers presumably a steady state is reached in which K gain resulting from recovery processes is in equilibrium with the loss incurred during contraction. As a result, endurance is enhanced. The greater elasticity and slower initial decay of the active state which is characteristic of the red fibers can account for their mechanical fusion at lower frequencies and for their prolonged twitch times. Most of man's striated muscles contain both types of fibers but in differing proportions which determine the color of each muscle. Some show a characteristic arrangement or zonation of the fiber types within the in others the two types are randomly muscle; distributed. In such muscles as the gastrocnemius,
and metabolites than mass of larger white
of Contractus Tension
161
and flexor digitorum longus, last fiber predominate, although slow fibers may also be present In many mammals the soleus muscle appears to consist entirely of slow libers. The preponderantly slow fibercd muscles arc the antigravity muscles, adapted for continuous body support. Their sensitivity to stretch results in a continuous mild (tonic) activity even at rest. The predominantly last-fibered muscles are phasic muscles which produce quick postural changes and fine skilled movements. At rest they are electrically tibialis anterior,
silent.
Recent studies indicate that in mammals the slow red should be further subdivided on the basis of differences in enzymatic activity, especially succinic dehydrogenase and ATPase activity, into two subcategories. As a result, muscle fibers may be classified into three types, which have been designated as A, B fibers
and
C.
Type A
fibers represent the classic fast, pale
B and C represent two types of slow red fibers. Stein and Padykula found all three types present in the rat gastrocnemius, with type A predominant (Fig. 11. 11. A). In the soleus, A fibers were absent but the muscle contained both types B and C whereas types
fibers,
(Fig.
ll.ll.B).
The muscle
significance of slow and fast characteristics of fibers is discussed further in Chapter 13.
SUMMARY Important aspects of Chapters 10 and 11
summarized as follows. The study of muscle from many by
many
may be
different animals
and
different investigators has revealed that the
following contractile features are
common to all (Hanson
and Lowyi. 1. Muscles cardiac
of every type — striated, smooth, and — contain actomyosin. and actomyosins prepared
from different muscles react with ATPase in the same manner. Furthermore, no differences have been found in the ATPase from different muscles or species. 2. In all types of muscle the molecules of the contractile proteins are grouped into filaments which are thick enough to be seen in electron micrographs. 3. For striated muscle there is as yet no convincing evidence that the filaments themselves shorten, but there is abundant evidence which is compatible with the sliding filament theory. 4.
Tropomyosin
is
a constituent of the contractile
systems of all muscles. Of the two kinds of tropomyosin which have been recognized, one, tropomyosin B, is
common
to all muscles. (Tropomyosin A, or paramyosin. is found in molluscan muscle and appears to be associated with its "catch" mechanism by which tension is maintained to hold bivalve shells closed for long periods of time without evidence of fatigue and with very small expenditure of energy.) 5. The tension exerted by active muscle is a function of its length and is maximal at about the greatest length
that the muscle can assume in the living animal. Tension decreases nearly linearly above and below this length. The shape of the tension-length curve for isometric contraction is similar for all muscles tested. 6. A muscle which is being lengthened while it is contracting can maintain greater tension than it can develop at any given equivalent static length. Therefore, tensions greater than the isometric maximal can be recorded in eccentric contraction. 7. Velocity of shortening of the contractile material decreases with increasing load in a hyperbolic manner. When velocity is expressed as a percentage of maximal velocity at zero force and force is expressed as a percentage of maximal force at zero velocity, the forcevelocity curve is essentially the same for all muscles. 8. Quick release produces the same effects in all muscles: tension falls immediately and then re-develops to a value characteristic of the shorter length. 9. The rate of the development of tension depends on the intrinsic shortening velocity of the contractile material, compliance of the elastic components, and the rate of decay of the active state. The existence of such extensive similarities among muscles provides a measure of confidence in assuming that information on the properties of muscle derived
from animal studies may also apply to man. However, reasonable caution and good judgment must be exercised
when
direct confirmation
is
lacking.
SECTION TWO
THAPTKK
NEUROPHYSIOLOGY
12
Basic Neurophysiology when, how
Skeletal muscles are under the control of the nervous system which determines which muscles shall contract.
in force
fast, to
and
what extent, and with what changes
velocity from
moment
to
moment.
THE NEURON: STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION Morphology of the Neuron
sisted
from the days before techniques
for identification
of myelin were as refined as they are today. Larger
The nervous system is composed of two types of cells: neurons and neuroglia. We are concerned only with the first oi these. Neurons are usually greatly elongated cells with diameters ranging from 0.5 n in small unmyelinated fibers to 22 n in the largest myelinated fibers. Some exceed 1 meter in length. They are specialized to receive, conduct, and transmit excitation. A generalized neural cell or neuron consists of four morphologically and physiologically distinct portions: a receiving pole, a terminal transmitting pole, an intervening conducting segment, and a cell body or soma. Each is specialized for its particular role in the cell's function. Most neurons possess two types of protoplasmic processes extending outward from the nucleated soma: dendrites and axons. The processes vary in length and in the amount and extent of their branching. Dendrites are usually multiple, short, and highly branched. The space occupied by their three dimen-
axons are enclosed in increasingly more numerous sheathing layers formed by more and more windings of sheath cell processes. As the folds become tightly packed together, most of the cytoplasm is squeezed out so that the sheath is ultimately composed of concentric
layers
of
lipid-rich
cellular
membrane. The
myelin sheath of the larger axons is segmented rather than continuous, and each segment is contributed by a single sheath cell. The length of the segments and the thickness of the myelin are fairly constant for neurons of a given caliber, larger axons having longer segments and thicker sheaths. The segments are separated by short, unmyelinated gaps, the nodes of Ranvier. Collateral branches, when present, arise at nodal gaps and leave the parent axon at approximately right angles (Fig. 12.1).
The
area of axon outgrowth from the nucleated poris known as the axon hillock. Nerve impulses are generated in the initial segment of the axon which, even in myelinated fibers, is unmyelinated. Axon ends usually divide distally into a spray of terminals, the telodendria, which lose the myelin sheath and end tion of the cell
is often extensive. They constitute the receiving pole of the cell. Axons are usually single, long and, although one or more collateral branches may occur,
sional spread
they are relatively unbranched except at their ends. The axon is responsible for both conduction of excitation and its transmission to other cells.
in
naked
The
tips.
body or soma of the neuron is the metabolic center of the cell where, under control of its single nucleus, proteins and other metabolically important substances (enzymes, transmitter substances, neurohormones, etc.) are elaborated. The fact that materials are moved from the cell body into and along the neuronal processes has been well established in the last decade. The channel for transport is probably provided by the endoplasmic reticular system of the cell body which connects with microtubules in the cytoplasm of the neural processes. When severed from the nucleated portion of the cell, a nerve process will soon degenerate because it is no longer supplied with essential materials, p.nd a new process will grow out from the cut stump which is still attached to the cell body. Location of the soma is the major difference among
An axon
generates action potentials (nerve impulses) and conducts them from the receiving portion of the cell to the transmitting region. It is a delicate cylinder of neural cytoplasm with a limiting membrane, the axolemma. It varies in length and in diameter in different types of neurons. Axons are enclosed in a cellular sheath of lipid material, the myelin sheath, which serves to separate individual axons from one another and from adjacent neural components. The myelin sheath is formed by concentric wrappings of membranous processes from sheath cells, called oligodendrocytes within the central nervous system and Schwann cells in the peripheral nervous system. Small axons which are invested by only a single layer of sheath cell process are called "unmyelinated" fibers, a term which has per-
161
cell
162
UNDERSTANDING THE
SCIENTIFIC BASES OF
nerve cells. In vertebrates the nucleated portion of most neurons, including motor neurons and interneurons, is a part of the receiving region of the cell. The somata of sensory neurons from the skin, however, have been displaced centripetally along the course of the axon where they are better protected from injury than if situated peripherally with the receiving structures (Fig. 12.2). In these cells the dendrites communicate directly with the axon, and the cell body does not participate in the reception of excitation. In other words, the part of the fiber, often myelinated, which conducts toward the cell body and the portion leading from the cell body are both parts of the axon. Only the peripheral terminals are dendrites, while the central terminals are telodendria.
Mitochondria are present in axons, especially at the nodal areas, and are numerous in the cell body and in both the receiving and transmitting portions of the neuron, being abundant in the latter. Ribosomes are mostly restricted to the cell body. Minute and unique neurofilaments, whose function is as yet unknown, are distributed throughout the cytoplasm. Normally, excitation is conducted only from the re-
HUMAN MOVEMENT ceiving to the transmitting pole of the cell. This polarity derives from the fact that nerve cells in the body are stimulated only at the receiving end, because it can be shown experimentally that an axon which is stimulated at a point along its length is capable of conduction in
both directions.
Neurons may be classified as either receptor neurons or synaptic neurons on the basis of the type of input which they receive. Receptor neurons are those which
and transduce environmental energy such as sound, heat, or chemical or electrical energy. They are specialized to be excited by specific types of stimuli, and their dendritic portions are appropriately modified in structure (Fig. 12. 2. B). Synaptic neurons (Fig. 12. 2. C) receive information from other neurons by means of synaptic transmission. Their dendritic geometry may be extensive and complex, providing a wide field for reception of a great number and variety of inputs, all of which are already encoded in the manner characteristic of nervous system communication. receive
light,
Physiology of the Neuron: Excitation and Conduction
Membrane Theory
of
Irritability is a characteristic property of all protoplasm, but types of cells differ widely in the extent to which they display the property. It is most highly developed in nerve and skeletal muscle cells. Excitation is induced in a cell by appropriate stimulation and is associated with chemical and electrical changes which spread over the cell membrane. In many types of cells the change is graded and spreads decrementally from the point of stimulation. In nerve axons and muscle cells, however, if the stimulus is adequate, the change is conducted without decrement as an all-or-none action potential. Adequate spread of excitation evokes the characteristic response of the cell. In a muscle cell the response is contraction; in a gland cell, secretion. The essential function of a nerve cell is to transmit excitation to other cells, and it responds by releasing a chemical transmitter substance at its synaptic terminals. Although neurons may be artificially excited by a number of different kinds of stimuli, with a few exceptions their normal stimulus is the action upon their membranes of the chemical transmitters released by other neurons. Exceptions include the stimulation of receptor neurons by pressure, vibration, heat, etc., and in a few instances, rare among the vertebrates, direct
electrotonic excitation of one neuron bv another.
Resting
FIGURE
12.1. Multipolar neuron. A. dendrites of the receiving axon or conducting segment C. telodendria and terminal arborizations of the transmitting pole 7. nucleus: 2, cell body or soma (/ and 2 compose the metabolic center of the cell): 3. axon hillock: 4. initial segment of axon; 5. myelin sheath segment: 6. node of Ranvier (naked membrane exposed); 7. collateral branch of the axon pole.
B.
Membrane
Potential
Action potential generation and conduction in the neuron axolemma and the muscle sarcolemma are essentially identical. The present discussion describes these events as they occur in the neuron. The axon membrane in the unexcited or resting state is polarized as a result of a differential distribution of ions on the two sides of the membrane. The cations potassium (K + ) and sodium (Na + ), the anion chloride
Basic Neurophysiology
163
DENDK
AV\ (
ORIGIN
impulse tniti.»'
AX.N tail
ZONE
C
or
none
cono.
TELOOENDRIA tchemical trans'"
-
OUTPUT
A FIGURE
12.2.
C
B Types
of neurons. A,
diagrammatic representation of the three functional portions of the
neuron, showing the dendritic or receiving pole where excitation causes graded electrogenesis; the axonic or conducting
segment which conducts the all-or-none impulses originating in the initial segment; and the where excitation is transmitted by chemical means from the tips of the telo-
synaptic or transmitting pole
B and C: representative types of neurons B, receptor neurons. /, special sensory neuron; 2. cutaneous neuron Note that the nucleated portion is situated along the course of the axon These cell bodies
dendria
are located
in
motor neuron; cleated portion
the dorsal root ganglia or 2. is
interneuron located
Cold Spring Harbor
in
in
homologue
a
These are the most
types
the receptor pole of the neuron
Symp Quant
Biol.
30:
393
in
C,
synaptic neurons.
1
the nervous system
(After Dowling, J
E
.
Note that the nuand Boycott. B B 1965 .,
)
I. and certain organic anions are the ions most importantly concerned. The differences in ion concentrations reflect the selective permeability of the membrane. While K~ and CI" pass readily through the membrane, Na~ passes only with difficulty and then is promptly ejected by an active transport mechanism which, although little understood, is called the sodium pump. Sodium accumulates in the intercellular fluid outside the cell in a concentration which is about 10 times greater than that inside the cell. Potassium is about 30 times more concentrated inside the cell than outside, and the chloride concentration is about 14 times greater outside than inside. When there is an unequal distribution of an ion on two sides of a permeable membrane, two types of forces act upon that ion. First, the chemical gradient results in a diffusion force whereby ions may be drawn through the membrane away from the area of their own greater concentration into the area of their own lesser concentration. Consequently, in the resting nerve cell the chemical gradients tend to drive sodium into and potassium out of the cell. The second force is electrostatic attraction whereby an electrically charged area attracts ions of opposite charge and oppositely charged ions attract each other. The driving voltage for a particular ion is the difference between the value of the membrane
'CI
of a dorsal root ganglion
common
potential
and the equilibrium potential*
for that ion.
In the resting condition the ionic currents balance each other exactly and the membrane potential remains
constant. In the resting cell
Na +
kept out by the action of the and holds a considerable amount of Cl~. Although CI", being in higher concentration in the intercellular fluid, tends to diffuse into the cell, its inward diffusion force is balanced by the electrical attraction of the positively charged Na + and the chloride ions remain in equilibrium. Inside the cell, large, negatively charged protein molecules, which were formed within the cell and are too large to pass through the membrane, exert an electrical attraction on cations. Therefore, since Na + cannot remain within the cell, K + is drawn into the cell and to a significant extent held there, accounting for the high concentration of potassium on the inside. The inward attraction ex-
sodium
pump,
,
attracts
,
*
The equilibrium potential is the electrical difference which must membrane to maintain the ionic concentration gradi-
exist across the
ent. Its
magnitude
for a particular ion
is
concentrations of the ion. equation.
and efflux and external value may be calculated from the Nernst
just sufficient to equalize the influx
and depends on the Its
The equilibrium
potential for Cl~
perimentally measured resting cle cells.
ratio of internal
membrane
is
identical with the ex-
potential of nerve
and mus-
164
UNDERSTANDING THE N
SCIENTIFIC BASES OF
HUMAN MOVEMENT
SIDE
+ + ,
\v''-''.
, .
.'.'-''. ; ', ».-iTJ
+ + + + +
!^r4.
+
+
-t-
-4-
+
•+-
-*-
+
+•
-f
-I-
-t-
+ +
+ -f
OUT SIDE Resting membrane. A Because of permeability properties of the membrane. K^and CI pass + passes with difficulty and is promptly ejected by the sodium pump readily through the membrane. Na + mechanism As a result. K accmumulates inside the cell and Na+ outside Organic anions, each indicated
FIGURE
12.3.
t>VVv are t0 ° of the
'
ar 9 e t° leave the cell
membrane
is
See
text. B.
As
K + by the organic anions is opposed by the chemical gradient tending to drive it out. Because the two antagonistic forces are not in equilibrium, the outward-directed chemical force being stronger than the inward-directed electrical attraction, enough K + remains outside to produce a balance between the two erted on
12. 3. A). As a final result, there is a deficiency of positive ions inside the cell and the net charge on the inside of the membrane is negative, while the charge on the outside, where there is an excess of
forces (Fig.
positive ions,
The
is
positive (Fig. 12. 3. B).
is often called a potassium podue to the excess K + in the intercellular fluid. However, it is the active removal of Na + at a rate equal to the net rates of entry of K + and CI that is the means by which the cell maintains its normal concentration differences. Other ions distribute themselves in a Donnan equilibrium as indicated by their
resting potential
tential because
it
is
concentration ratios.
The electrical difference between the inside and the outside of the membrane of an unexcited cell is the membrane or resting potential* and ranges from 40 to 100 millivolts (mv) in nerve and muscle cells. Excitation: Generation of Action Potential
The
forces acting on
a result of the differential distribution of ions, the interior
negatively charged while the exterior
sodium and potassium across
membrane are importantly involved in cell excitation. Any change in conditions producing an alteration in membrane permeability will result in movement the resting
of these ions in response to their driving forces,
and the
resting equilibrium will be upset. The time course of change in permeability of the cell membrane to a particular ion is expressed as conductance for that ion. Any change in conductance for one ion will appreciably
is
positively charged.
and hence alter the membrane any change in membrane poten-
affect that of other ions
potential. Conversely, tial will
influence conductances. Stimulation of a nerve
axon appears to increase membrane permeability, and hence conductance, to Na + at the point of stimulation. Sodium, driven by both its chemical and electrical gradients, passes into the cell. Because sodium is a positively charged ion, its entry decreases the negativity
and at the same time and to a similar extent decreases the positivity outside. In other words the value of the resting potential is lowered toward zero; the membrane is being depolarized. A change of resting potential in the depolarizing direction constitutes a inside
local excitatory state of l.e.s. (Fig. 12.4,
All biological "potentials" are actually potential differences.
B).
net influx of sodium is slow at first, but the depolarization caused by its entry produces a self-regenerative increase in permeability so that the rate of Na + influx and the rate of depolarization increase exponentially. This is an example of positive feedback. If the resting potential drops to a sufficient extent, it will reach a critical level which is characteristic and constant for each cell. In mammalian nerve and muscle cells critical depolarization levels range between 10 and 20 mv below the resting potential. At the critical level something happens suddenly which seems to throw the sodium gates wide open. Sodium rushes in to such an extent that the membrane potential in the stimulated area passes beyond zero and the polarization is reversed: the membrane becomes negative outside and positive inside at the point of stimulation. This almost instantaneous change in potential, which appears on the oscilloscope as a spike (Fig. 12. 4. C), is known as the action potential. t The more intense the stimulus the t
The
action potential
is
a
sodium potential and leads
nation of the hypothesis as the *
A and
The
tion potential.
sodium theory
to the desig-
of the nature of the ac-
Basic Neurophysiology
sooner depolarization reaches the critical level ami the earlier the spike appears The rising phase of the spike (depolarization) is acSodium conductance counted for by the influx of Na rises rapidly, in 0.1 to 0.2 millisecond tins), and then tails rapidly to a low level. Potassium conductance does not change appreciably at first hut then becomes
A
B
.
is inactivated. An efresponsible for the falling phase of the spike (repolarization). The separation in time of these two conductance changes accounts for the change in the membrane potential which constitutes the action
marked
as
K
flux oi
sodium conductance is
potential.
The magnitude
of the action potential
is
the alge-
between the resting and the active (reversed) potential values as recorded from the inside difference
braic
of the
memhrane.
tential is
which
In Figure 12. 4. C the
membrane
po-
mv (inside) in the resting state mv upon adequate excitation. The
70
is
reversed to - 30 potential is
action
70
mv
therefore: -
(+30 mv)
100
mv
Eq. 12.1
No action potential occurs unless depolarization reaches the critical level. If the stimulus is inadequate and does not result in the entry of enough sodium to depolarize the membrane sufficiently, the local excitatory
state
soon
tive reactions,
dies
away
mainly
K-
(Fig. efflux,
12. 4. B).
Regenera-
restore the resting
The sodium pump gradually ejects the sodium, and eventually the resting ion distribution is regained. If. however, subsequent subthreshold stimuli are applied in such rapid succession that each succeeding stimulus evokes its l.e.s. before that of the preceding stimulus has dwindled away, the local excitatory states polarization.
summate. When the critical level action potential will be generated. This
will
designated
summation
is
reached, an
phenomenon
is
of inadequate stimuli (Fig.
12.4TJ).
TTT 1
FIGURE the
12.4.
membrane
2 3
1
Membrane potential
in
cate application of stimulus is
—70 mv
reach the
(inside)
2 3
changes with time. Ordinate: millivolts. Abscissa: time. Arrows indi-
potential
A, resting state:
membrane
Depolarization of at least 15
critical level of
-55 mv
mv
is
potential
required to
B, local excitatory state (l.e.s.)
Application of an inadequate stimulus (arrow) partially depolarizes
Recovery of Resting State
The action potential occupies a definite distance of the nerve fiber (5 to 6 cm in the largest mammalian neurons), lasts for a definite duration (about 0.4 ms), and then the membrane potential is rapidly returned to the resting state (Fig. 12.5). Because the action of the sodium pump is relatively slow, recovery of the resting polarization requires a faster mechanism. The outflow of K~, as its conductance increases, brings about the almost immediate recovery of positivity outside and negativity inside. Potassium is driven outward by its chemical gradient and also by the reversal of the electrical force as the cell interior becomes positively charged. Ion distributions will be eventually restored by the slower action of the sodium pump. It has been suggested that the same carrier which actively transports Na + out of the cell brings K~ back, exchanging the ions one for one. Although no metabolic energy is required for the electrical changes during activity, energy is required for the action of the sodium pump by means of which ion con-
the
membrane, producing
a
l.e.s.
Since
critical level is
not attained
dwindles away and the resting state is restored (2). C, action potential. An adequate stimulus (arrow) induces a l.e.s. (1) which quickly reaches the critical level and the membrane potential suddenly reverses to +30 mv (inside), producing an action potential of 100 mv (2) Restoration processes act promptly and start to return the membrane to its resting po(1),
no spike
is
generated. The
l.e.s.
The process slows down, producing the short negative afterwhich the membrane is still slightly depolarized and hence abnormally irritable. This is followed by a longer lasting positive afterpotential (4) which is an overshoot resulting in slight hyperpolarization The resting poand subnormal irritability tential (5) is gradually regained. D, summation of inadequate stimuli. The l.e.s. of three inadequate stimuli summate (1) to reach the critical level (2), and an action potential spike is generated, followed as in C by negative (3) and positive (4) afterpotentials. and ultimate recovery (5) tential.
potential (3), during
centration gradients are restored and maintained. Ion pumping goes on continuously, even during the generation of the action potential. A small increase in energy expenditure occurs during recovery and is related to
UNDERSTANDING THE
166
+
++ +
-H
+
SCIENTIFIC BASES OF
+++++-+++
HUMAN MOVEMENT
+ 4.
4.
^ #y. -s+
4.
4. 4:
+,
+
+'+
4.
^^
+/-y^
2
1
H-4--F-r--t-4--»-4-4--«-4-i-
^
FIGURE
12.6. Saltatory conduction in a myelinated fiber. 1. node of Ranvier; 2. inactive node of Ranvier; ms. myelin sheath segment Arrows indicate flow of action current. Direction active
-f 4- 4-
12
of impulse
4
3
from left to right In myelinated nerve from node to node without depolarization of internodal portions of the axon Only a section of the surconduction
is
fibers the action current skips
5
face
membrane
is
shown
is
profile,
with the outside of the fiber
above and the inside below
•
+•
— — — + + + + +
-»-
-f-
+
•f-
1-
+ + +
axon terminals. Conduction
12
4
3
+-(-+--(-+
-
5
+-
+ 4
4-4-4
12 ++ + +
+
FIGURE
12.5.
3
Electrical
conduction, and recovery
4
5
+ +
F
4-
4
changes associated with excitation, in an unmyelinated cell membrane,
Resting membrane is positively charged on and negatively charged on the inside (Charges are shown on only one surface of the profile Numbers indicate sequential areas of the membrane b, excitation. An adequate stimulus
a,
resting
the
membrane.
outside
)
(arrow)
results
reversal
in
stimulation (area
1)
An
of polarity
(negativity)
at
the point of
action current then flows from positively
charged (outside) inactive area 2 to negatively charged (outside)
and along the inside of the membrane, emergc to e conduction, c: Emergence of action current stimulates the membrane of inactive area 2. which then becomes depolarized The action current now flows from presently inactive area 3 to newly active area 2 d and e: the action potential is self-propagated along the fiber to areas 3 and 4 Recovery: in c. d, and e. the area behind the action potential gradactive area
1.
into
ing through the inactive area
ually
recovers
its
original
polarization
(positively
charged on the
outside).
is accomplished by selfpropagation of the disturbance away from the site of origin. Adjacent inactive areas on the outside of the membrane are still positively charged at the resting level. Since the extracellular fluid is electrolytic, a small current, the action current, flows from the positively charged inactive region to the negatively charged active area where it passes in through the membrane, through the cell fluids, and out again through the inactive region. Although small, the current is sufficiently strong memto constitute a stimulus capable of increasing brane permeability as it emerges. The same sequence of excitatory events is repeated here: sodium moves in, polarity is reversed at this point, and the action potential has progressed along the fiber. This is repeated again and again until the action potential reaches the end of the axon terminal (Fig. 12.5). The generation of an action potential involves relatively few ions, so few as to be chemically undetectable although the electrical changes are readily measurable. Therefore a neuron can continue to conduct for hours without any cessation of activity to provide for restoration of the original ionic
distributions.
In unmyelinated fibers such as the autonomic postganglionic neurons and the afferent fibers for dull pain, conduction is accomplished by progression of the action potential down the fiber as described above. In myelinated fibers, however, the action current skips from node to node without depolarizing the internodal portions of the axon (Fig. 12.6). This is saltatory conduction, and the velocity of conduction is considerably greater than in unmyelinated fibers. Because the same exchange of ions occurs less times for a given length of fiber, saltatory conduction involves fewer ions and hence requires less energy for recovery. This is an
advantage which permits myelinated fibers to continue transmitting for some time even in the absence of the redistribution of ions by increased activity of the
oxygen.
pumping mechanism.
Some Conduction of Action Potential
The action potential which is generated at the site of stimulation must be conducted along the fiber to the
Characteristics of
Nerve Conduction
Refractory Periods. As the action potential travels along the fiber surface, it consists of a wave of negativity followed by an area of gradually recovering positivity
16.
Basic Neurophysiology
rABLE
IS,
Comparison of classification systems and sensory nerve fibers
1.
for
motor
Stmoq Group
lVnmnittumt
Vrloolv
etrr
llr.'up
Ih.llml.'l
U
-
\ ,l.i,
•',
;
n\
Origin in',,
i
it.
\
19
GO 100
20 -
15 ;U>
1
i
B C
Muscle
90 TO
6 12
12
30
3
15
0.5-2
0.5-1 ling to
libers
II
Classified according to Lloyd.
-
IF. intrafusal fibers;
J
GTO,
Fig.
Blood vessels?)
ANS ANS
Spindle,
30 to
Spindle, skin,
12-30
Pain
joint joint
III
2-6
IV
0.5-1
preganglionic
postganglionic
0.5-2
Pain
ANS. autonomic nervous system.
While an area
is in
period.
Afterpotentials. During the relative refractory peamplitude and velocity of the spike are altered, reflecting changed conditions in the fiber. In some neurons the latter portion of the downward course of the spike is considerably less rapid than its rise, showing a marked concavity before reaching its initial level. This is the negative afterpotential because it indicates a delay in return to the resting potential and a prolongation of some slight depolarization (hence negativel. During this period of 12 to 80 ms, the membrane is hyperexcitable or supernormal and hence more easily restimulated. The recovery may continue into a hyperpolarized state, the positive afterpotential, which persists for a much longer time, up to 1 full second, during which the membrane is subnormal in excitability riod both the
(Fig.
GTO,
70 120
Golgi tendon organ.
L2.5). it
12
Erlanger and Gasser.
-
state,
(i
Spindle IKs i
is in its reversed (active) absolute refraction and cannot be restimulated. During recovery, the membrane is relatively retractor., a state which lasts many times longer than the absolute refractory period. Intense or sustained stimuli may restimulate the original site during repolarization. The refractory periods are almost entirely due to the conductance changes. Inactivation of sodium conductance decreases excitability because a greater depolarization would be required to produce further increase in Na~ conductance to a point where its net influx would exceed the efflux of K~. Elevation of K> conductance gradually restores resting polarization and hence excitability. Thus the inactivation of Na + conductance and the elevation of K^ conductance account for both the absolute refractory period and the relative refractory
i
12 22
1
\\.>ns to Bpindle IFs
12.4.
C and
D).
The
positive afterpotential
is
probably due to a delay in the restoration of K + conductance to its normal level. Frequency of Impulses. In general, natural stimuli are of sufficient duration to reactivate the membrane after the absolute refractory period. For this reason neurons normally carry trains of impulses. A single electric shock may produce a single action potential but only because its duration does not outlast the refractory period of the fiber. The stronger the stimulus the earlier
it will re-excite, the shorter will be the time span between impulses and the greater the frequency. Because each action potential is followed by an absolute refractory period, action potentials cannot summate* but remain separate and discrete and, because of
the characteristics of the relative refractory period, neurons do not conduct impulse frequencies as high as the absolute refractory period would suggest. A fiber with a spike duration of 0.4 ms might be expected to conduct impulses at a frequency of 2500 per second but its upper limit will actually be closer to 1000 per second. For reasons not well understood, frequencies rarely approximate their possible maxima. Motor neurons usually conduct at frequencies of 20 to 40, rarely as high as 50, impulses per second, and upper limit frequencies for sensory neurons normally lie between 100 and 200 impulses per second instead of between 800 and 1000. Velocity of Conduction. Velocity of conduction depends not only on myelination but, more importantly, on the diameter of the fiber. It can be fairly accurately predicted from the following equation. Velocity in m/sec = 6 x diameter in ^
Eq. 12.2
Hence the largest motor and sensory nerve fibers, with diameters near 20/i, have conduction velocities up to 120 meters per second. f In small unmyelinated fibers, velocities range from 0.7 to 2 meters per second. Large fibers not only conduct more rapidly than small fibers but characteristically have lower stimulus thresholds and larger spikes with shorter durations. Classification of Nerve Fibers. As a result of the classic experiments of Erlanger and Gasser in 1937, nerve fibers are classified into three major groups, A, B, and C, on the basis of conduction velocities. Group C contains the unmyelinated postganglionic fibers and group B the small myelinated preganglionic fibers of the autonomic nervous system. Group A includes the *
The
l.e.s.
displays no refractoriness and hence
summation
is
possible at subthreshold levels. t In 5
mm
mammalian per second.
skeletal
muscle
fibers,
conduction velocity
is
about
UNDERSTANDING THE
168
SCIENTIFIC BASES OF
large, rapidly conducting myelinated somatic fibers. It has been further divided into four subgroups: alpha (a), beta (0), gamma (7) and delta (5) on the basis of velocity and diameter. The fastest fibers are those with the largest diameters. Sensory nerve fibers have more recently been separately classified by Lloyd according to diameter into groups I, II, III, and IV, with corresponding velocities. These do not correspond exactly in size and velocity to the subgroupings of the Erlanger-Gasser class, but among afferents from the skin and muscles
HUMAN MOVEMENT group
and
approximates A„ and group
I
Ay
II
approximates
Aa
In order to avoid confusion, use of the alphabetical designations is restricted to efferent fibers and .
the numerical designations to afferent fibers. Table 12.1 provides a comparison of the two classifications as related to both motor and sensory fibers. As indicated by the table's columns for termination of motor fibers and origin of sensory fibers, it is obvious that specific structures tend to be innervated by fibers of quite specific
size
and conduction
characteristics.
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION OF THE SYNAPSE The
functional unit of the nervous system is not the sinneuron but consists of a chain of at least two and usually three or more neurons which connects receptor with effector. Each neuron in the chain remains a separate and discrete entity. Its axon terminal ends in close proximity to the receiving structures of other neurons but there is no protoplasmic continuity between neurons. Dendritic branches and axon telodendria interweave to form a complex feltwork known as the neuropil. The region of functional contact between neurons is the synapse, across which excitation must be transmitted. The synapse is probably the most important aspect of neural organization; in fact, its importance cannot be overemphasized. It is responsible for the physiological continuity of conduction through the neural chains and it is the site in the nervous system where occurs the modification of communication without which integrated response would be impossible. In the neuron itself, nerve impulses are transmitted in an all-or-none fashion in both magnitude and velocity, and these properties vary only with changes in the condition of the fiber. At the synapse, however, transmission is not all-or-none and may be amplified, reduced, or even completely blocked. As a result, the signal transmitted by a subsequent neuron in the chain may be quite different from the original input. Furthermore, blocking of some synapses and concurrent facilitation of transmission at others serve to determine the distribution of communication by directing it into spegle
cific
channels.
Morphology
of the
Synapse
arborizations which form nests, brushes, or baskets, and sometimes they are simply naked terminals which climb along a dendrite for some distance or cross it at right angles. Presynaptic terminals contain mitochondria, neurofilaments, and numerous minute vesicles. 200 to 1000 A in diameter, which are often clustered against the presynaptic membrane. Vesicles occur in a variety of
shapes and
sizes.
The synaptic
continuous with the intercellular ranges from 100 to 200 A. It is usually occupied by vague dense material which forms a thin dark plate between the apposed membranes and is sometimes thicker on the postsynaptic side. The contact area on the postsynaptic neuron may be called the subsynaptic membrane or the receptive site. While morphological specialization has not been clearly
space. In width
cleft is it
some electron microscope studies have shown what appear to be delicate hooklike fibrillar extensions which make contact with presynaptic fibrils in the synaptic cleft (Fernandez-Moran). Biochemical and physirevealed,
studies suggest the presence of ion-specific channels or pores and specific reactive chemical groups. Synaptic contacts occur on dendrites and, in neurons whose nucleated portion is located within the receiving pole of the cell, on the soma. Synapses formed by contact of axon terminals with postsynaptic dendrites are axodendritic synapses; those formed by contact with
ological
the cell body are axosomatic synapses. There are also synapses in which an axon terminal makes contact with another axon terminal or even with the initial segment of another neuron; these are axoaxonic svnapses (Fig. 12.8).
A
synapse
axon terminal of the transmitting or presynaptic neuron, separated by a fluid-filled space, the synaptic cleft, from the receiving membrane of the postsynaptic neuron. The axon ending and the postsynaptic membrane are closely contiguous. The two apposing membranes are stongly adherent and there is evidence that they may be held together by a special synaptic cement. Each telodendron terminates in a specialized unmyelinated ending which may take one of several forms. (Fig. 12.7) consists of the specialized
Frequently endings are bulbous swellings known as or boutons, but sometimes they are diffuse
knobs
Each presynaptic neuron makes synaptic contact
many different postsynaptic neurons, often sending several telodendria to each. Each postsynaptic neuron receives multiple axon terminals from many different with
presynaptic neurons: a single motor neuron in the spinal cord may have more than 1000 synapses occupying 40^ of its receiving surfaces. The scope of a neuron's influence may be further extended by collateral branches of its axon which may have destinations quite different from that of the parent axon. In some cases a collateral may even turn back into the dendritic field of its own neuron as a recurrent collateral.
169
Basic Neurophysiology
and others have shown by tunc lapse photographJ
Physiology of the Synapse iptic
cinematography that nerve libers are living, squirmi moving streams through which a peristaltic How of chemical supplies is driven from (he cell body at rate oi' from to a few millimeters per day. These materials
Transmission
an active neuron, nerve impulses travel out into all many tiny terminal branches ami into as manj synapses. Abundant evidence indicates that synaptic transmission is accomplished in most instances by a chemical process. (Electrical transmission, which is known to occur in many invertebrates such as the :ish. squid, and annelid worm, has recently been In
of
i
its
l
may
include the neurosecretions, as well as materials nourish and replenish the neural processes and, in motor nerves, substances which significantly influence the fast-slow response characteristics of muscle fibers. The depolarization produced in the membrane of the presynaptic terminals by the arrival of an impulse is assumed to trigger an excitation-secretion coupling mechanism which causes the rupture of the synaptic vesicles. A quantal amount of transmitter substance is ejected into the synaptic cleft by the bursting of each vesicle. Impulses probably do not initiate transmitter release but simply accelerate a secretory process which goes on continually at a low rate. The amount released is proportional to the magnitude of the impulse, and it has been calculated that, for each 30 mv of action potential, transmitter release is increased 100-fold. An impulse probably causes all of the vesicles in immediate juxtaposition to the membrane to rupture and also mobilizes other vesicles for subsequent release by causing them to move into the strategic area. The transmitter substance, which diffuses across the intervening space in a few microseconds, reacts with the specific chemical groups at the receptor site of the postsynaptic membrane. It has been suggested (Eccles, 1964, 1965) that these sites are associated with fine channels or pores which are somehow opened by the chemical reaction to permit ions to flow through the to
.
some vertebrates but is as yet unknown mammals.! The nerve impulse itself does not cross the interneuronal gap but rather, upon its arrival at identified in
in
ends, it causes the secretion of a chemical transmitter substance. The minute vesicles revealed by electron microscope photographs of presynaptic terminals are presumed to contain storage units of the transmitter, which may have been manufactured in the vesicles or. more likelv. in the nerve cell bodv. Weiss
membrane
FIGURE
12.7.
Diagrammatic
nents of the synapse.
1.
representation
of
the
compo-
presynaptic telodendrion; 2. bouton; 3,
vesicles: 4. synaptic cleft: 5. postsynaptic neuron: 6. receptor site or subsynaptic
membrane
FIGURE
12.8.
A. B. and C.
neuron
/
are axodendritic
forms an axoaxonic synapse
(c)
on
a
at
result, a
and 2 make synaptic connections with interneurons (b) A collateral from the axon of terminal of neuron 2 just prior to its axodendritic synapse on C
Types of synapses. Afferent neurons
Some synapses
many
times their normal rates (Fig. 12.9). small change occurs in the resting potential of the postsynaptic membrane at the subsynaptic site. The potential difference between this and adjacent unstimulated areas of the membrane is the postsynaptic potential (PSP).
As a
(a),
Horizontal arrow indicates direction of conduction.
1
others are axosomatic
170
UNDERSTANDING THE
SCIENTIFIC BASES OF
VESICLE
HUMAN MOVEMENT
a*
PRESYNAPTIC
MEMBRANE
SYNAPTIC CLEFT
POSTSYNAPTIC
MEMBRANE
CELL INTERIOR
Hypothetical explanation of synaptic transmission. A synaptic vesicle is releasing exsubstance (stippled) which diffuses across the synaptic cleft 7. a specific group of atoms on the postsynaptic membrane (rectangle) is so oriented that it occludes the pore which passes through the postsynaptic membrane 2. the excitatory transmitter has already interacted with chemical groups at the receptor site, producing a change in molecular configuration which has "opened" the pore. This enables
FIGURE
12.9.
citatory transmitter
sodium to enter and.
later,
potassium to leave the cell. 3, a narrower channel is shown which requires a difpresumably an inhibitory one. (From Gardner, E. B.. 1967. The neurophysio-
ferent transmitter substance, logical basis of
motor learning
—
a
review
J.
Amer. Phys. Ther Ass 47: 1115)
The action of the transmitter upon the subsynaptic membrane does not directly induce an action potential. The membranes of dendrites and soma (with some exceptions among dendrites of certain brain cells) are and incapable of generating acpotential spikes. Therefore the PSP is a local, graded, nonpropagated change in the resting potential which spreads electrotonically from the point of origin. The potential change gradually diminishes (decrements) as it spreads. The initial segment of the electrically inexcitable
tion
axon, however, is electrically excitable and has the lowest threshold of any part of the cell membrane. If the PSP is an excitatory change (depolarization) and if its magnitude reaches the critical level of the axon membrane, an action potential will be generated in the initial segment and conducted nondecrementally over the axon. Except for the interposition of the electrically inexcitable receptor portion of the cell, the sequence of events in synaptic excitation appears to be similar to that described for direct stimulation of the axon. The chemical transmitter substances do not remain long in the synaptic cleft but are soon destroyed, each by a specific enzyme. Almost immediate destruction of transmitter is essential to neural regulation of activity because its persistence and accumulation would result in exaggerated and uncontrolled responses.
There are two types of transmitter substances, those which are excitatory and those which are inhibitory. A transmitter is excitatory if it exerts a depolarizing effect upon the postsynaptic membrane, thus bringing its resting potential toward the firing level. It is inhibitory if it decreases the possibility of firing either by hyperpolarizing the resting membrane or by stabilizing it, possibly by combining with the chemical groups of the receptor site in a way which prevents activation. A postsynaptic neuron has many synapses on its surface, some of which are excitatory and some inhibitory, and both types are often active at the same time. The constant interplay of excitatory and inhibitory activity results in a fluctuating membrane potential in the initial segment which, at any moment, is the algebraic sum of these depolarizing and hyperpolarizing influences. Unsuccessful attempts have been made to correlate morphological differences among synapses with excitatory and inhibitory action. Some evidence indicates that excitatory synapses may have wide clefts and broad, continuous postsynaptic plates and may be located on more distal portions of dendrites, while inhibitory synapses may have narrower clefts and thinner, discontinuous plates and may be located upon dendritic trunks and soma surfaces. The situation, however, is not a simple one. Many intermediate and exceptional
Basic Neurophysiology
tonus are found. In
fact
some
oi the larger terminals
show both synaptic types on the same postsynaptic dendrite. Attempts have also been made to correlate differences in the design of presynaptic endings (knobs, baskets,
trails, etc.) with excitation and inAt the present tune no hard and last eon
brushes,
habitation.
drawn linking tine structure and synap However, the spatial distribution of active terminals in relation to each other and to the axon hillock may be important. Because of the deeremental nature of conduction in the receptive membranes, synapses far out on dendrites should be expected to exert less influence than those closer to the cell body, and synapses on the soma near the axon hillock should be the most effective. The possibility exists, however, that large dendrites may have electrically excitable sections which could act as booster stations for their otherwise deeremental conduction. Another interesting thought elusions can be tie
is
function.
that strategically placed inhibitory terminals could
markedly alter the effectiveness of excitatory endings. The chemical identity oi the transmitters which act at neural junction outside the central nervous system is well known. At the neuromuscular junction release of acetylcholine (ACh) by motor neuron terminals excites the end plate membrane of the muscle fiber. Acetylcholine is released at all autonomic ganglia by the preganglionic neurons and is the transmitter at all parasympathetic and some sympathetic neuroeffector junctions. For the majority of sympathetic junctions, the transmitter is norepinephrine (nor-E). The transmitters which operate at synapses within the central nervous system have been identified in only one instance: ACh is known to be liberated by terminals of recurrent collaterals of motor neurons at their syn-
apses with certain cells
(Renshaw
cells) in the spinal
ACh and
nor-E may be widely involved in central nervous system transmission, and it seems equally likely that others are also concerned, especially in the brain. Candidates include gamma-aminobutyric acid (GABA). histamine, 5-hydroxytryptamine (serotonin), and dihydroxyphenylalanine (dopamine), all of which are present in significant amounts. There is growing evidence in the literature on synaptic transmission in the invertebrates of a direct excitatory role for L-glutamic acid and for cord.
It
GABA
seems certain that both
as an inhibitory transmitter. Variations in the shape and size of synaptic vesicles may be related to the transmitter contained. Clear, nongranular vesicles, 200 to 400 A in diameter, probably contain ACh. and dense, granulated vesicles, 800 to 900 A in diamter. each hold a dense spherical droplet which may be nor-E. Other vesicles differing from these may contain other transmitters. The action of ACh is fairly well understood. Its reaction with the postsynaptic membrane produces a permeability increase which results in a rapid, localized depolarization of short duration. It is then quickly destroyed by the enzyme acetylcholinesterase (ACh-ase), which hydrolyzes it to choline and acetic acid. Destruction of the transmitter is necessary to avoid per-
171
sistent and convulsive responses. Several chemical substances (e.g., eserme and neostigmine) inhibit ACh ase. preventing destruction of ACh, and much has been learned about this neural transmitter through the use oi these agents. They have also proven useful in the management of myasthenia gravis, a disease character ized by weakness and extreme muscular fatigue resulting from subnormal release of ACh by motor nerve terminals.
The classic concept of synaptic function is that each neuron releases the same kind of transmitter at all of its terminals (Dale-Feldberg law) and that the transmitter has either an excitatory or inhibitory effect on all of the postsynaptic neurons upon which it acts. The unitary nature of neuron secretion is universally accepted. There is, however, considerable evidence that the sign or -) of a transmitter's action may be determined ( + by properties of the postsynaptic cell. In the autonomic nervous system ACh is excitatory for some effectors (for example, smooth muscle of gut and bladder) and inhibitory for others (cardiac muscle). Norepinephrine exerts both effects but oppositely in the various tissues. Furthermore, instances are known in which the effect may be reversed by hormonal influences acting on the innervated tissue. For example, the smooth muscle of the pregnant uterus is excited while that of the nongravid organ is inhibited by ACh. Also, in some simple vertebrate nervous systems clear cut instances have been found in which the same presynaptic neuron excites some postsynaptic neurons and inhibits others, presumably by the same transmitter (Kandel and Wechtel).
Synapses control the normal impulse traffic through the nervous system, determining the amount and pattern of information input and the consequent behavior of each neuron and group of neurons. Synaptic integrative action is based upon the interplay of antagonistic influences: facilitation and inhibition. Synaptic Facilitation Excitation in a presynaptic neuron does not necessarin transmission at every synapse which its terminals encounter. A certain amount of resistance is inherent in each junction and reflects the critical level of depolarization which is required to fire the postsynaptic neuron. Synaptic resistance varies from synapse to synapse and at each synapse is subject to temporary or persistent modification. If the transmitter is excitatory, the PSP will be a reduction in membrane potential; i.e., a partial depolarization. Such a decrease in the electric charge across the postsynaptic membrane is the excitatory post synaptic potential or EPSP and represents a reduction of synaptic resistance toward the firing level (Fig. 12. 10. A). This is known as facilitation. The action of the excitatory transmitter upon the postsynaptic membrane is thought to result in a general increase in membrane permeability, an opening of all ionic pores. The most notable ion movement, however, is that of Na + because of its greater electrochemical driving force. ily result
UNDERSTANDING THE
172
SCIENTIFIC BASES OF
HUMAN MOVEMENT graphical distribution within a single modality; proprioceptive feedback of information concerning body position or movement; and supraspinal influences from brainstem, cerebellum, and cortex.
t
Synaptic Inhibition
EPSP 70
mV
75
mV
1
B
A
FIGURE
12.10.
Facilitation
and
resting potential of the postsynaptic critical
EPSP
level
is
of about
ther excitation facilitated
of about 5
in
membrane
is
neuron.
B,
inhibitory
mv (membrane
Excitatory transmitter equivalent to this inhibited
inhibition
synapses. The -70 mv and its
-55 mv A. excitatory transmitter has evoked an 7 mv (membrane potential is now -63 mv). Furequivalent to 8 mv will be required to fire this
postsynaptic
duced IPSP
Postsynaptic Inhibition. Although involving different transmitters, both excitatory and inhibitory synapses are presumed to have the same general manner of function. In both, quantal packets of transmitter are re-
transmitter
potential
20 mv
will
is
has
now -75
be required to
in-
mv). fire
postsynaptic neuron
When a number of excitatory volleys arrive simultaneously or in close succession at several synapses of a cell, each contributes its small amount to the postsynaptic depolarization. If summation of EPSPs reaches the neuron's critical level, a spike potential is generated in the initial segment and conducted along the fiber. The rise of the action potential wipes out the EPSP, probably by antidromic invasion of the soma. However, if the total excitatory effect is in excess of the threshold level or if the presynaptic bombardment is sustained, the initial segment will be repeatedly restimulated and the postsynaptic impulse frequency will rise accordingly. The frequency of impulses in the postsynaptic axon will therefore depend upon the amount of facilitatory transmitter substance released. The greater the amount the earlier in the relative refractory period will another spike be generated. Summation of excitatory effects occurring at a number of synapses on the same postsynaptic neuron and involving terminals of presynaptic neurons from a variety of sources is known as spatial summation. The partial depolarization of the postsynaptic membrane by concurrent subliminal inputs makes the neuron more ready to respond. As a result it may be fired by a subsequent input which alone would have been inadequate. Facilitation may also be accomplished by a high frequency of impulses arriving over a single presynaptic terminal. Such temporal summation is probably less effective, except perhaps at the synapses of receptor neurons. In both spatial and temporal summation, each quantum of transmitter contributes toward the possibility of ultimate firing. If a response is already ongoing, facilitatory inputs will cause amplification of the response by increasing the frequency of the postsynaptic impulse train.
Sources of synaptic facilitation include the following: multiple sensory inputs which provide summation as a result of differences in modalities and/or in topo-
leased and react at receptor sites on the subsynaptic membrane, producing a momentary increase in permeability. Eccles (1964, 1965) conjectured that the action of the inhibitory transmitter differs from that of excitatory transmitter in that it produces a selective rather than a general permeability increase by opening pores for penetration restricted to small ions. The flow of current through the membrane of an inhibitory synapse + or the inis probably due to either the outflow of flow of CI" or both, with a concomitant increase in internal negativity (Fig. 12.10.B). The resulting hyper-
K
is the inhibitory postsynaptic potential (IPSP), and it opposes the EPSP. Consequently a greater summation of excitatory transmitter is required to lower the resting polarization to firing level. This type of inhibition is known as postsynaptic inhibition. It is the basis of reciprocal inhibition of antagonistic muscles,
polarization
in coordinated motor activity. Excitatory input from afferent neurons is transformed into inhibition at appropriate points in the neural network by the interposition of inhibitory interneurons (Fig. 12.11). These are special short-axon neurons which release an inhibitory transmitter at their synapses, thus making it harder to fire the postsynaptic neuron. Therefore, all inhibitory pathways must contain at least three neurons and all pathways involving only an afferent and an efferent neuron (monosynaptic chains) must be excitatory. Conductive delays substantiate the inclusion of at least two synapses in even the most direct in-
an essential factor
hibitory pathways in
mammals.
There are two forms of postsynaptic inhibition which merit special mention: recurrent or "surround" inhibition and disinhibition. Recurrent or Surround Inhibition. A particular type of
B 12.11. A simple inhibitory circuit. A neuron (7) synapses with an efferent neuron (A) and on a short inhibitory interneuron (2). Both of these synapses are excitatory and both neurons are activated. However, since the interneuron (2) secretes inhibitory
FIGURE
[B) will be inhibited and will fire synapses (not shown) induce sufficient
transmitter, the efferent neuron
only
EPSP
if
other
excitatory
to reach the critical level.
Basic Neurophysiology
postsynaptic inhibition, in which active colls in sensory motor projection systems inhibit adjacenl neurons, has received considerable attention among neurophysiotogists. rhe pathway foi tins inhibition involves re current collaterals which leave motor axons before they •merge from the gray matter of the cord. They pass back or
into the cord and excite special short inhibitory inter neurons called Renshaw cells. A Renshaw cell responds to a single stimulus with a high frequency burst of impulses and the release of inhibitory transmitter, with a consequent reduction of excitability in the inciting and adjacent neurons upon which its terminals impinge (Fig. 12.12). More strongly stimulated cells exert a stronger inhibition on their neighbors than that which they receive and hence the excitatory difference between them is exaggerated. The exact function oi this recurrent or surround inhibition is not yet clear. In motor neurons it presumably plays a role in localizing activity within a muscle and so may be oi value in distributing motor unit activity for fine
movements (Wilson). A similar mechanism in senmay serve to sharpen contrast (Brooks).
sory pathways
173
Disinhibition. Not only d Renshaw cells inhibit ad motor neurons but they may also inhibit an al read] existing inhibition and thereby facilitate neurons jacenl
of the
motor
pool.
Motor neurons are
subject to a tonic
inhibitory influence by some as yet unidentified inter neurons, probably reticulospinal fibers. Through in hibitory synapses on these cells, the
Renshaw
cells
de
press their inhibitory action and thus release the motor
neurons from the inhibition. This then is a facilitation by disinhibition (Fig. 12.13). The fact that this is not a usual type of facilitation is supported by both electrophysiological and pharmacological evidence: membrane potential changes are /Vyperpolarizations, and the effect is blocked by strychnine and tetanus toxin, drugs which block postsynaptic inhibitory synapses but do not affect excitatory junctions.
Normally, both facilitation and inhibition are occurring simultaneously but to different extents at the multitude of synapses of a postsynaptic neuron. The postsynaptic cell will fire whenever the algebraic sum of the two antagonistic influences is sufficient to depolarize it to its critical level, and the greater the sum the greater will be the frequency of impulses generated.
Presynaptic Inhibition. Within the last decade physiological experimentation has established the existence of presynaptic inhibition. As the name im-
FIGURE
12.12.
collateral
from motor neuron
Recurrent or surround inhibition.
A
A
recurrent
re-enters the ventral gray matter
and synapses with a short inhibitory neuron, the Renshaw cell. C (cell body crosshatched) The Renshaw cell sends terminals to surrounding motor neurons, where its inhibitory transmitter diminishes their
irritability.
FIGURE by
way
inhibits in
is under inhibition from an unknown source from the motor axon activates a Renshaw cell (2) which the inhibitory neuron The more strongly the motor neuron is stimulated the greater is the reduction
12.13. Facilitation by disinhibition. The motor neuron
of an inhibitory interneuron
the incident inhibitory influence
sponse
plies, the effect is exerted upon the presynaptic neuron rather than upon the membrane of the postsynaptic cell. The pathway for presynaptic inhibition appears to involve neural circuits in which the inhibiting neuron synapses upon the axon of the presynaptic neuron close to its own termination (Fig. 12.14). The electron microscope has revealed the existence of small boutons making synaptic contact with telodendria near their large end knobs. These axoaxonic synapses are believed to be the morphological basis of presynaptic inhibition. Pharmacological evidence indicates that the transmitter substance is quite different from that of postsynaptic inhibition. First, the presynaptic inhibitory effect is not blocked by strychnine or tetanus toxin, both of which are powerful antagonists of postsynaptic inhibition, and second, it is sensitive to picrotoxin, a con-
(/).
A
collateral
Disinhibition
would thus contribute to enhancement
of the muscle's re-
UNDERSTANDING THE
174
SCIENTIFIC BASES OF
HUMAN MOVEMENT the central nervous system can control
12.14. Presynaptic inhibition. A hypothetical circuit mediating presynaptic inhibition. An afferent neuron from a muscle spindle (7) is shown making an excitatory connection with a motor
FIGURE
neuron
(2) to its
own
extensor muscle.
A
collateral
branch of the
neuron activates a short interneuron (3), whose terminals synapse with the axon of an afferent neuron {4) which is making an excitatory connection with an efferent neuron (5) to
afferent
the
antagonistic flexor
extensor afferent
(7) will
muscle.
As
a
result,
excitation
over the
diminish the excitatory influence upon the
antagonistic flexor motor neuron by presynaptic inhibition.
vulsant drug which has no action upon postsynaptic inhibition.
The
distinctive characteristic of presynaptic inhibi-
that EPSPs of the postsynaptic neuron are depressed without any measurable hyperpolarization of its membrane. There is good evidence that the depression is due to a partial depolarization of the presynaptic axon which reduces the magnitude of the action potential invading its terminals. For example, if a depolarization of 10 mv has been induced at the axoaxonic synapses, the spike of the presynaptic neuron will be reduced by 10 mv from its usual level. As mentioned earlier, transmitter release is proportional to the magnitude of the action potential. Consequently, when these smaller potentials reach the end knobs, less excitatory transmitter is released and the EPSP is proportionately lessened. The reduction in transmitter probably reflects a decrease in the number of ejecting vesicles, because there is no evidence that the size of individual quanta is affected. A lesser amount of transmitter results in a lower impulse frequency in the postsynaptic neuron and therefore a decreased response. When the giant axons of the squid were presynaptically depolarized by electric current, a 5% reduction in the magnitude of the presynaptic spike caused a 50% reduction in the postsynaptic response. The neurons which produce presynaptic inhibition often fire repetitively and the presynaptic spike depression may last as long as 100 ms. It is also possible that antidromic impulses traveling centrifugally in the dorsal roots may collide with the orthodromic incoming impulses and reduce their magnitude in that way. Presynaptic inhibition provides a mechanism whereby tion
is
its input by completely suppressing weak or extraneous sensory inflow and can adjust the effectiveness of signals from one part of the body in relation to conditions prevailing in another part. Most important, it can modulate or eliminate undesirable input from one specific source without altering the postsynaptic neuron's sensitivity to input from other sources. This is in sharp contrast to postsynaptic inhibition, in which the excitability of the postsynaptic neuron is depressed. In the central nervous system of vertebrates, presynaptic inhibition is widespread at all spinal cord levels, occurs commonly in the brain, and has been found in interactions between cord and brain. There is increasing evidence that all afferents entering the cord from the skin and other peripheral receptors may exert presynaptic influence upon adjacent neurons and upon themselves. Pyramidal tract cells are thought to reduce stretch reflex activity by imposing presynaptic inhibi-
upon spindle afferents (Fig. The existence of presynaptic
tion
12.14).
facilitation
through an
increase of transmitter release by the presynaptic neuis suspected though as yet unproven (Ganong). Both recurrent (Renshaw) postsynaptic inhibition and presynaptic inhibition are feed back inhibitions: an active neuron sends collaterals back to produce inhibition at an earlier point in the transmission pathway. In the cerebellum a feed forward inhibition has been demonstrated. Basket cells and Purkinje cells are both excited by the same input but the basket cells send terminals forward to inhibit the Purkinjes. Presumably the mechanism limits the duration of excitation produced by any
ron
given afferent volley. The total subsynaptic area, dendritic plus somatic. of a postsynaptic neuron is relatively enormous as compared with a single synapse and the number of presynaptic terminals impinging on a postsynaptic cell may be very large. Since both facilitatory and inhibitory synapses are represented, both effects may be exerted upon the cell simultaneously. The magnitude of the depolarizing current through the postsynaptic neuron's initial segment will be determined by the number of active synapses and the algebraic sum of the two antagonistic influences. As long as the excitatory influence exceeds the inhibitory influence by at least the critical
amount, the neuron
By
will fire.
selective facilitation of
some synapses and
inhibi-
may be
directed into proper outflow channels. Muscles which should contract do so. and those which would interfere with the movement are caused to relax by cessation of outflow to them. tion of others, excitation
Other Properties of Synapses
The
properties characteristic of synaptic transmission
compatible with the accepted chemical theory. They differ in several respects, however, from the electrochemical conduction of action potentials in the nerve fiber. Synaptic Delay. Transmission across the width are
j
Basic Neurophysiology
1
100 to 200 .V of the synaptic cleft requires
man and up
ms
0.
l
to 0.3
ms
to
l
in
teraction with the postsynaptic
membrane
are
other animals. As compared to conduction velocites of over 100 meters per second in e nerve fibers, synaptic transmission is nearly 2 mil hon times slower. Most of the delay is consumed by transmitter release, as both diffusion and chemical inin
& &
the cat. J. Neurophysiol. 28: 71.
and Boycott. B. B.. 1965. Neural connections of the retina. Cold Spring Harbor Symp. Quant. Biol. 30: 393. Doyle. A. N\. and Mayer. R. F.. 1969. Studies of the motor units in the cat. Bull. Sen. Med. Maryland 54: 11. Eccles. J. 1960. Neuron physiology, introduction. In Handbook of Physiology: Seurophysiology. Vol. I. edited by J. Field and H. W. Magoun. Baltimore: Waverly Press. Eccles. J. C. Magni. F.. and Willis. W. D.. 1962. Depolarisation of central terminals of Group I afferent fibers from muscle. J Physiol. Eccles.
Synaptic and ephaptic transmission, In Hand Neurophysiology, Vol. I. edited by J Field
significance of cell size in spinal motoneurons,
McPhedran. A.
Press.
principles of sensory receptor action. Physiol.
Rev. 41:
Dowling.
1969
..
II \\ Magoun, Baltimore: Waverly Press Henneman, E., Somjen, ') serving the effector {K). As a result, impulses arising in a number of receptor organs
tion. This is the pathway of the passive stretch reflex and includes only the afferent neuron from the muscle spindle stretch receptor and the efferenl (motor) neuron to the muscle fibers, the two neurons synapsing in the spinal cord without an intervening interneuron (set' Rg. 14.8, Chapter 14). Three or More Neuron Circuits. Except for the stretch reflex circuit, pathways in the spinal cord and
converge upon a single effector, signal to the muscle. Again the
brain contain
all
three types of neurons. Circuits of only
three neurons, one of each type, are the exception rather than the rule, however. Generally the central portions of
the
circuit,
the
intemeurons, are multiple,
forming
and networks. As a result, basically simple circuits are converted into complex pathways. There are essentially three basic circuit types: (a) divergent circuits, by which a single receptor may influence many effectors; ib) convergent circuits, by which a chains
number
of different receptors
effector; (c) repeating circuits, is
multiplied a
number
may
influence the
same
by which a single input
of times.
plified but serves to present the basic principle.
Repeating Circuits
Two basic types of repeating circuits are known, reverberating and parallel circuits, in both of which a single input results in repetitive firing of efferent neurons. Figure 13. 10. A illustrates a reverberating circuit. The afferent neuron (7) synapses with a chain of interneurons (2, 3, 4), with the fourth neuron transmitting the signal to the efferent neuron (5). Impulses traveling this circuit, however, reverberate through an axon collateral from one of the chain (3) to restimulate a neuron (2) situated earlier in the chain. Repetitive firing will continue to activate the effector (F) until terminated by fatigue or by inhibition imposed through another circuit.
The parallel linear chain of
Divergent Circuits
afferent
A shows
diagrammatically a simple divergent circuit. The axon of the afferent neuron (1) branches to synapse with two intemeurons (2) which also send collaterals, each synapsing with a different efferent neuron (3). As a result, impulses originating in the single afferent reach four different effectors. A, B, C. and D. The circuit pictured is overly simplified and geometric in form. The central components, namely the intemeurons. characteristically occur not singly but in chains of different lengths and with a variety of branching patterns so that a stimulus impinging upon a single receptor organ, e.g.. the eye. can evoke responses involving many parts of the body. Further illustrations include a noxious skin stimulus which evokes a mass withdrawal response, or a sudden loud sound which may produce a total body response. Figure
13.9.
Convergent Circuits Figure 13. 9. B presents a simple convergent pattern. Axons of several afferent neurons (1) synapse with two intemeurons (2) whose axons in turn synapse with a
thus amplifying the is over sim
diagram
(1)
circuit
shown
is
intemeurons
(2, 3,
in Figure 13.10.B.
and
with the efferent neuron
from these intemeurons
(2
and
4)
A
connects the
(5).
Collaterals
3) also project to
syn-
napses of the efferent neuron, however, so that in the case illustrated a single input will stimulate the efferent not once but successively (three times), with synaptic delay determining the order of their arrival. Complexity is readily introduced into the repeating circuits by collaterals supplying additional efferent pathways or interconnecting with other circuits of the same or different type. Interposition of inhibitory neurons assures suitable direction of excitatory flow.
Combination of Circuits
The
possibilities of combination are obviously limitConsider the relatively simple combinations suggested by the diagrams in Figure 13.11 and determine the response which will be induced in each effector. With further modification by appropriate facilitation and inhibition, these combinations of simple circuits provide a basis for the observed complexity of response less.
patterns.
SUMMARY The neurons of the nervous system are arranged in a complex but orderly manner. Afferent and efferent neurons are combined to form the peripheral nerves which connect receptors and effectors with the central nervous system. The interneural chains, which complete the circuits from receptor to effector, compose the spinal cord and brain. Cell bodies serving specific functions are aggregated into clusters (nuclei or centers)
from which axons travel in groups (tracts) to distant destinations. Collateral branches leave the longer tracts to provide interconnections with centers at various levels of brain
and
cord. Interconnections
modified influences, provide properly
movement
patterns.
by
facilitatory
the
framework
between circuits, and inhibitory for
coordinated
SECTION THREE
THE INTEGRATIVE ROLE OF THE PROPRIOCEPTIVE REFLEXES
CHAPTER
14
The Proprioceptors and Their Associated Reflexes* INTRODUCTION man. are born with genetically which are preprogrammed by modification of synaptic transmission to produce stereotyped response patterns useful to the species. These are not learned. They are present at birth or appear as the developing nervous system progresses to com-
and stabilizers. All of these must be precisely regulated in regard to their intensity, speed,
All animals, including
built-in neural
of synergists
circuits
duration, and sequential changes in activity from the beginning to the end of the movement. This requires a considerable amount of integrative function which is largely automatic and unconscious. Muscle-to-muscle integration is accomplished by
pletion. They represent the heritage of the species. Genetic material prescribes and ontogeny builds the components for the types of movement characteristic of human behavior. These components include not only the bones, joints, muscle attachments, and nerve supply, both afferent and efferent, but also appropriate interconnections and patterns of facilitation and inhibition. A child is born with a repertory of a few hundred movements which compose the raw material of motor learning. The modification and recombination of these in all possible ways results in the acquisition of additional motor patterns, some of which are very different from inherited patterns. These are learned motor
basic reflex reactions which are initiated by receptors strategically located to feed back information to the central nervous system. Information must be received
continuously regarding body position, muscle length tension, speed, range and angle of movement, acceleration of the body or its parts, and balance and equilibrium. This information must then be integrated by cord and lower brain centers and converted into a suitable modification of the impulse outflow to produce immediate adjustment of each muscle concerned. As the state of a muscle changes, the information input will also change, evoking re-modifications in neverending succession. Much of the information also becomes available to centers in the conscious areas of the brain where it may be sorted, analyzed, interpreted, and converted into an outflow of signals to appropriately modify voluntary body movements as occasion
and
skills.
Stereotyped responses in the form of simple human are well known, such as the stretch reflex, withdrawal (flexion) reflex; extensor thrust and the positive supporting (extension) reflexes; crossed extensor reflex; righting reflexes; placing reactions and others. Some of these appear to be very simple; others must be amazingly complex. Some are fully formed at birth, while others develop as natural expansions of these during the maturation of the neuromuscular system. Each of these patterns consists of a coordinated combination of several to many joint movements, and each joint movement further consists of a coordinated combination of muscle actions: contraction of prime movers, relaxation of antagonists, and supporting contractions reflexes
demands. Voluntary movement requires a foundation of automatic responses which assure a proper combination of mobility and stability of body parts. Since activity occurs in many muscles simultaneously or sequentially, precise regulation
*
Some
of the material
and
in Quest,
1969, pp. 1-25,
essential. Fortunately, neural con-
muscles,
and termination
of the
and direcmovement. Volition does
not normally include control of individual muscles, although the human capability of doing so and even of controlling single motor units has been amply demon-
several figures in this chapter have
Monograph XIL
of
initiation, regulation of speed, force, range, tion,
appeared previously
is
whether activity is unconscious or deliberate, is mostly involuntary: muscles are smoothly regulated by reflex mechanisms. The voluntary contribution to movement is almost entirely limited to
trol
and
are reproduced here with permission of the publishers.
193
194 strated.
UNDERSTANDING THE For example, reaching
SCIENTIFIC BASES OF
for
an object
tarily prescribed as to direction, speed,
is
volun-
and the object
sought; but the functional features of shoulder girdle fixation, elbow extension, wrist stabilization, and finger movement are regulated by subcortical mechanisms.
Two
contrasting neurophysiological hypotheses exist regarding the subconscious regulation of the many muscles concerned in the behavior subserved by neural circuits; the central control hypothesis and the periph-
The central control hypothan unspecific input, or even the central nervous system itself, triggers activity in a nerve net which has been genetically structured (in terms of mutual excitatory and inhibitory influences) eral control hypothesis.
esis postulates that
so that, once activated, the total pattern proceeds automatically. In invertebrates numerous instances are known in which specifically identifiable interneurons drive "follower" cells to produce relatively complex coordinated movements. Because in these cases the interneurons must be continually active for the response to proceed, it is obvious that they must be under the control of a preceding triggering stimulus.
The stimulus may be
a single brief event. Once initithe movement sequence proceeds without requiring further regulatory input. In vertebrates some instances are known in which stimulation of selected hypothalamic or cortical regions elicits complex motor acts or sensory experience, and the response often greatly outlasts the stimulus. However, nothing is known regarding the neurons or pathways involved (Willows and Hoyle).
ated,
The peripheral control hypothesis,
in contrast, at-
sequential activation of various component circuits of the nerve net to specific inputs from protributes
prioceptors, each of which triggers either excitatory or inhibitory output to appropriate muscle pathways. Most neurophysiologists have favored the latter hypothesis because proprioceptive loops have been so convincingly demonstrated. It seems highly probable that in man there is no movement pattern controlled purely by either one of these methods but rather that features of both are involved. While man's basic motor patterns are probably genetically coded in the species and laid down during development as specifically structured interconnected nerve circuits, activity within the nerve nets appears to be adjusted to the momentby-moment changing conditions of environment and/or body orientation (changes which could not be anticipated genetically) by proprioceptive feedback. Although little is known regarding the exact struc-
HUMAN MOVEMENT ture of vertebrate nerve nets, a large
amount
of in-
formation has accumulated regarding proprioceptors
and fects
their structure,
upon the
mode
of function,
activity of muscles.
Some
and
reflex ef-
of this knowl-
edge has been derived from clinical and laboratory studies on humans, but the greater portion and the most detailed information has, of course, come from the study of other mammals, especially monkeys and cats. It is not wise to transpose indiscriminately from one species to another but, where interspecies similarities and instances of parallel evidence exist, speculation regarding the operation of the same mechain man is justified, especially as the basis for the formulation of hypotheses and for the design of experiments. According to Sherrington, proprioceptors are those end organs which are stimulated by actions of the body itself. They are somatic sensory organs located so as to secure inside information and to effectively bring about cooperation and coordination among muscles. The nervous system uses these sensory receptors to modify and adjust muscle function so that peripheral automatic (subconscious) regulation will dominate in most of our so-called voluntary or volitional movements. When proprioceptors are stimulated by movement or position, impulses traverse neural chains to act upon muscles in diverse and interrelated ways. By exciting various proprioceptors, contraction of any muscle tends to organize other muscles to cooperate with it. In the parlance of the electronic engineer, these reflexes operate as negative feedback loops by means of which
nisms
motor activity becomes
in
large
measure
self-regu-
words, aspects of the movement process muscle tension, absolute muscle length,
lating. In other
such
as velocity of change in muscle length, joint angle, joint movement, head position, and contact with surfaces
act as stimuli to initiate signals in nerve fibers which are fed back into the central nervous system. In some way as yet unknown, this information is compared with the desired pattern which nature or conditioning has established. If the afferent signal indicates any divergence from this pattern, centers in the nervous system modify efferent signals so that the activity of the proper muscles is appropriately increased or decreased to correct the difference. Proprioceptors may be conveniently classified into three groups: the muscle proprioceptors, the proprioceptors of the joints and skin, and the labyrinthine and neck proprioceptors.
MUSCLE PROPRIOCEPTORS The muscle proprioceptors are the neuromuscular spindles and the Golgi tendon organs, both of which are incorporated into the gross structure of the muscle itself.
Neuromuscular Spindles Neuromuscular spindles are highly specialized sense organs which are distributed among the bundles of contractile fibers in the muscles. They are found through-
Proprioceptors and Associated Reflexes
mass of the muscle but tend to be more con There are more centrated in the central portion. spindles in man's phasic muscles than in his tonic (postural) muscles, as would be expected since the former more precise control. The neuromuscular require spindle is probably the most important and surely the
the spindle reflect both the rale of change in length (phasic response) ami the ultimate length finally achieved and maintained (tonic response) Both as peels of muscle length are signaled by variations in the firing frequency of the afferent neurons serving the re-
out the
most
complex
of
proprioceptive
the
ceptor.
One
receptors.
expects, and finds, structural complexity associated with functional complexity. In the case of the muscle spindle, its structure presents an outstanding duality which is also reflected in its function. usually
The muscle spindle
is
sensitive to length and.
Structure of the Spindle details vary slightly from spindle to depending upon the particular function of the muscle in which the spindle lies. In general, each consists of a fluid-filled capsule 2 to 20 long and enclosing 5 to 12 small specialized muscle fibers (Fig. 14.1). These are known as intrafusal fibers, to distinguish
Structural
spindle,
when
mm
stretched, responds to both constant length, as in maintained position or posture, and changing length, as
during movement.
The
firing of the sensorv
neurons of
rxGWm
Figure 14.1.
The neuromuscular
spindle. A, a
muscle spindle
in situ, lying in parallel
with the extrafusal
muscle fibers. A spindle consists of a fluid-filled capsule containing small intrafusal muscle fibers of which there are two types The two outer intrafusals are nuclear bag fibers which are percapsular The three lying centrally are nuclear chain intrafusal fibers and are intracapsular. Innervation is omitted (From Gardner. E B. 1969. Proprioceptive reflexes and their participation in motor skills Quest XII: Fig. 1-B. p 5 B, photomicrograph of a spindle in cross section, demonstrating its multi-layered capsule and the diameters of the nuclear bag UFb) and nuclear chain (IFc) intrafusal muscle fibers Gamma efferent axons (Ge) and extrafusal muscle fibers (EF) are identified (From Truex, R. C. and Carpenter, M B 1969 Human Neuroor contractile
)
.
anatomy. Ed
6. Fig
9-
1
2.
p
1
84
195
Baltimore: The Williams
&
Wilkins Company.)
196
SCIENTIFIC BASES OF
UNDERSTANDING THE
them from the contractile or extrafusal fibers of the muscle. The latter, when stimulated by their large alpha motor neurons, contract to produce the muscle's tension.
Intrafusal fibers differ from contractile muscle fibers
HUMAN MOVEMENT Most muscle spindles receive two types of afferent innervation, designated primary and secondary. The two types of afferent neuron are distinguished by differences in sensory ending and by differences in axon The primary afferent neurons terminate in an-
size.
in several ways. Their diameters range from one-tenth to one-fourth the diameter of the contractile fiber:
nulospiral
their nuclei are concentrated in the central or equato-
afferents
rial region rather than being distributed throughout the fiber; and the contractile material is restricted to
the polar ends. There are two distinct sizes of intrafusal fibers (Fig. 14.1). Each spindle contains one to three large intrafusal fibers ranging from 12 to 26 \i in diameter and one to eight smaller intrafusal fibers with diameters ranging from 4 to 12 n- These two types of receptor cells differ not only in diameter but in length. The smaller fibers are contained entirely within the spindle capsule (intracapsular fibers), while the larger fibers pass well beyond the capsule (percapsular fibers). In the large fibers the centrally located nuclei are aggregated into a swollen baglike region in the equatorial portion and hence these are called nuclear bag fibers. There may also be a single-file projection of
known as the myotube, extending outward from the bag region on either side. The smaller intrafusal fibers contain only a single column of nuclei through their equatorial region. These are known as nuclear chain fibers. The large bag fibers, extending well beyond the capsule, attach to the connective tissues and endomysia of the contractile muscle fibers. In some instances, a single nuclear bag fiber may pass several nuclei
through several capsules each having a nuclear bag. In such cases the structure is known as a tandem spindle. Although the significance of tandem spindles is not yet clear, they are probably concerned in the intricate role of the spindle in muscle regulation. The chain intrafusals, fully contained within the capsule, attach to the inner surface of the capsular connective tissue at either end. The two types of intrafusal fibers also vary in viscosity, the bag fibers being more viscous than the chain fibers. Viscosity may determine the type of contraction of the intrafusal fibers, a characteristic which has an important influence upon its function. The innervation of the two types of intrafusal fibers also differs.
Spindle Innervation
Afferent Innervation. Afferent (sensory) neuron endings are intimately associated with the intrafusal fibers and are stimulated mechanically when the fibers are stretched. Impulses then pass over the axons and enter the spinal cord by the dorsal roots. Within the spinal gray matter they distribute to a number of pathways. Most prominent, however, is their influence upon their own muscle group. In general, spindle afferents exert
an excitatory
upon the muscle in which they lie, a facilitatory effect upon synergistic muscles, and an inhibitory effect upon antagonistic muscles.
An important
effect
exception
is
discussed later.
regions
endings
of the
which
intrafusal
coil
fibers
around the nuclear while the secondary
terminate juxta-equatorially. i.e.. farther toward the striated polar regions, either in smaller coils or in flower-spray endings. Axons of primary afferents are large group I fibers (known as la), while the secondaries fall into group II of the Lloyd classification. The two types of afferent neurons distribute differently to the two types of intrafusals (Fig. 14.21. Each spindle has only one primary afferent. It enters the spindle and branches to supply an annulospiral ending to each of the intrafusal fibers of the spindle, both bag and chain. Each spindle receives one to five of the smaller secondary afferents. Their endings are restricted almost entirely to the chain fibers.* and their axons rarely branch, the axon to ending ratio being essentially 1:1. The two types of afferents differ in sensitivity, the primary afferents having much lower thresholds to stretch than do the secondaries. Only a few millimeters of stretch per second are sufficient to activate them. Furthermore, the primary afferents signal both phasic and tonic stretch, while the secondaries signal tonic length only.
The
primary-
afferent neuron signals the phasic length state of the its impulse frequency during phasic response. The frequency reflects, not length as such, but rare of change in length, i.e.. velocity of the stretch. When stretching is com-
muscle by changes
in
stretch. This is the
pleted, the frequency of discharge drops to a constant level appropriate to the new tonic length. This is the tonic response (Fig. 14.3). When a small stretch is rapidly imposed, the phasic response frequency rises sharply and then drops markedly when stretching ceases. The difference between the maximal frequency attained during the phasic portion of the stretch and the level to which frequency settles in the tonic response is called the dynamic index. The tonic value is taken at 0.5 second after the final position has been reached. The contrast between the responses of primary and secondary spindle afferents during a slow stretch is illustrated in Figure 14.4. Efferent Innervation. Intrafusal fibers are supplied with motor innervation in the form of small gamma-
sized neurons known as gamma motor neurons or fusiform neurons, whose cell bodies lie in the anterior horn of the gray matter of the spinal cord. Axons of these neurons leave the ventral root, travel to the mus-
and terminate in motor endings on the contractile polar end regions of the intrafusal fibers. Each spindle receives 7 to 25 cle in the appropriate spinal nerve,
(average 10 to 15) efferent neurons. Impulses traveling * There is some disagreement among authorities regarding the completeness of the limitation of secondary afferents to the chain intrafusal muscle fibers.
Proprioceptors and Associated Reflexes
197
2
3T^ FIGURE
14.2.
Intrafusal fibers
with equatorial region
A
picture
filled
and
their innervation.
A
large nuclear
bag
intrafusal fiber
is
shown above
with nuclei and with contractile polar ends extending beyond the limits of the
nuclear chain fiber
is
shown below,
smaller
in
diameter and. shorter, with the characteristic
is pictured on the two types of intrafusal ends in coiled terminals (annulospiral endings) on the nuclear region of each intrafusal, while the smaller secondary afferents (2) have branched endings (flower sprays) located on the outer parts of the nuclear region, and appear only on the chain intrafusals Efferent innervation is also shown The gamma (fusimotor) neuron (3) ends in gamma plates located quite far out on the polar regions of the nuclear bag fiber The nuclear chain fiber receives another type of gamma neuron (4) which terminates in gamma trail endings situated closer to the equatorial region (From Gardner. E. B. 1969. Proprioceptive reflexes and their participation in motor skills. Quest XII: Fig. 1-B. p. 5)
row The
single fibers
of nuclei
in
its
central
region
Afferent innervation
neuron
single large primary afferent
(/)
to the connective tissues of the extrafusal muscle fibers,
1 2
FIGURE 14.3. Phasic and tonic responses of the spindle primary afferent neuron to interrupted stepwise increases in muscle length. Each stretch, denoted by the solid bars on the time scale, involved the same amount of stretch but was imposed at
a
different
rate
as indicated by the time. After each stretch
new length was maintained, a. stretch was applied: b, the beginning
the
at the
was
completion of the stretch:
attained:b'.
stretches
Note
c'.
initial
frequency before
of the stretch:
frequency after the
d.
c,
frequency
new
length
and b". c". d". responses to subsequent
d'
that
during each stretch
the
frequency (b
new constant
to
c.
the
impulse discharge increased phasic response) but dropped
of
each new length atThe small double-ended vertical arrows represent the dynamic index for each stretch Hypothetical, based on Matthews. P. B 1968 Central regulation of the activity of skeletal muscle In The Role of the Gamma System in Movement and Posture. Revised edition. New York: Association back to
tained
a
(d.
the
tonic
level consistent with
response).
C
for
Aid of Crippled Children.)
over
these fusimotor neurons evoke contraction of the polar ends of the intrafusal fibers just as impulses in the large alpha motor neurons evoke contraction in the large contractile fibers, but contraction of the exerts no detectable influence on muscle an intrafusal fiber is connected at both ends either to the interior wall of the capsule or intrafusals
tension. However, since
the shortening of its polar ends imposes a stretch upon the nuclear region (Fig. 14.5). Afferent endings are activated just as they are during passive stretch of the whole muscle. Stretch produced by gamma innervation may be referred to as internal stretch, while stretch imposed by gravity, an outside force, or shortening of an antagonistic muscle is designated as external stretch. Impulses generated in afferent neurons, whether by internal or external stretch, traverse neural circuits to the muscles. The structural duality of the muscle spindle is also reflected in its motor innervation: there are two types of gamma neurons (Fig. 14. 2. A). Existence of the two types is supported by anatomical, physiological, and pharmacological evidence. Anatomically there are two types of endings differentially located on the intrafusal fibers. There are endings found on the polar regions of nuclear bag fibers which resemble smaller versions of motor endplates, and these endings are known as gamma plates. On the nuclear chain fibers, more diffuse endings occur known
as
gamma
trails.
Gamma
trails are situated
more cen-
on the polar regions, i.e., closer to the equatorial region, sometimes overlapping the secondary sensory endings, while the plate endings occur more distally. Furthermore, in the muscle nerve there occur two distinct types of gamma-sized axons: one type is thickly myelinated, the other thinly myelinated. The two types show no separable differences in their axon diameters, overlapping over the whole range. Physiologically, some gamma neurons conduct rapidly and may be called fast fusimotor neurons, while others conduct more slowly (slow fusimotor neurons). There is little overlapping in conduction velocities between the two groups. Indirect evidence suggests that the thickly myelinated axons are the fast-conducting ones, although this needs further substantiation.
trally
UNDERSTANDING THE
198
BASES OF HUMAN MOVEMENT
SCIENTIFIC
Furthermore, the gamma neurons display two different types of influence on the primary afferents. Some gamma neurons, when stimulated concurrently with external stretch of the muscle, appear to produce an in-
;
crease in the dynamic index. In other words their action exaggerates the phasic response of the primary endings. Such neurons are called dynamic fusimotor neurons. Other gamma neurons markedly decrease the
dynamic index. These are known as static fusimotor neurons. They may also increase the tonic response this effect is less noticeable than is the reduction of the phasic response (Fig. 14.6). Pharmacologically, evidence for two separate gamma systems is found in Rushworth's investigation of drug effects on phasic responses as compared with tonic responses. He found that barbiturates depressed the tonic response but left the phasic responses unaffected, and that procaine completely suppressed the tonic response and reduced the phasic response. Moreover, Rushworth found that the phasic response was exaggerated in cerebellar disease, while the tonic response was absent. Other studies have shown that the anterior
somewhat, but
B FIGURE
fibers
>
Dynamic index
of
FIGURE
./,Secondary
/
Responses of primary and secondary spindle Upper curve the phasic frequency response of a priafferent neuron during
stretch of the muscle. afferent
under
Lower
same
new
length.
The
and
directly following a
Broken
vertical
was completed, and last
slow
curve, response of a secondary spindle
conditions.
point at which stretch at this
(mm)
14.4.
mary spindle
indicates
line
the muscle
point on each curve
is
was
held
the frequency
new length had been maintained for 0.5 second. Note the marked drop (dynamic index) in the response of the
recorded after the primary
afferent,
stretch,
while the secondary afferent has responded only to ab-
indicating
that
it
is
responding to velocity of
solute length. (Adapted from Harvey. R
J., and Matthews. P. B. C. 1961. The response of de-efferented muscle spindle endings in the cat's soleus to slow extension of the muscle. J. Physiol. (London) 157: 370. Cf. Matthews. P. B. C. 1968. Central regulation
of the activity of skeletal muscle. In The Role of the
Movement and
tem
in
New
York: Association for Aid of Crippled Children.)
Posture,
the
cerebellum
normally
inhibits
dynamic
activity, suggesting that in disease of the cere-
reduced or absent. Such differon the two types of response support their
this inhibition is
correlation with separate structural properties.
to relate the dynamic gammas to the plate endings, and therefore the nuclear bag fibers, and the static gammas to the trail endings and the chain fibers. For
-l_i-
afferents.
The intra-
It is
/
Stretch
fiber.
to
/
/
intrafusal
not known for sure which gamma axon is related which type of motor ending and, coincidentally, which type of intrafusal fiber. Indirect evidence seems
X
/*
an
are
ential effects
/
of
state with polar
bellum
Primary
stretch
attached. A, a nuclear bag fiber in the neutral ends uncontracted B. the same fiber under gamma (fusimotor) stimulation. Polar ends have contracted, putting the nuclear region under stretch.
fusal
gamma
/:\
Internal
bars on either side represent tendons to which the
vertical
lobe
120
14.5.
revised
edition.
Gamma
Fig.
1
7.
p.
Sys32.
example, the primary afferent neurons have their endings on both types of intrafusal fibers and are influenced by both gammas; however, the secondary afferents, whose endings are restricted almost entirely to chain fibers, are activated only by static gammas. Examined from another viewpoint, if dynamic gammas end in the plate endings on the nuclear bags as suggested, they should influence the primary afferents but not the secondaries, which is the actual experimental finding. And if static gammas end on chain intrafusals, they should affect both types of afferent ending, and, in fact, the static fusimotor neurons can drive* both primary and secondary afferents. So it seems likely that the dynamic fusimotor neurons distribute to the nuclear bag intrafusal fibers and the static fusimotors to the chain intrafusals. Evidence is accumulating that the type of contraction of the two intrafusal fibers differs. This is significant because the nature of intrafusal contraction may determine the afferent response, while the particular type of gamma neuron simply activates a particular type of intrafusal fiber. Smith has shown that bag fibers contract slowly on a local, graded manner. This would *
A
neuron
is
considered to drive another neuron
that other neuron to respond one for one to
limited
number
of cvcles.
its
when
it
causes
frequency over a
Proprioceptors and Associated Reflexes
be consistent with the phasic response in which fire quency increases with the rate of stretch. The smaller chain fibers, however, contract in a faster, twitchlike manner, and complete tetanus can be evoked in them bj about 15 impulses per second. This would be com patible with the tonic response toa maintained stretch. the extent of tetanus in the intrafusal fiber determining the frequency in the afferent neuron. Since the primary .rents ser\e both types of intrafusal fiber, they would be expected to signal both phasic and tonic stretch, while the secondaries, associated mainly with the chain fibers, would signal only tonic length; this is in fact the case. Further, if it is the dynamic type of
gamma
which serves the bag
and evokes
fibers
appropriate
to
14.7).
After
gamma
chain
denervation,
fibers
axons has been demonstrated histologically Ada! and Barker (1965) and electrophysiological^ by Bessou, Emonel Denand, and Laporte U!>
(U
>.
O-
5
2
%
"a
J= .2
E
3
£^ ?
c
=•=
ffl
>
B o
a
**
—
ro
o
CO CO 4
o
t
S
-o
5
5
_ -
£e> ~
= _ a £
JI
E,
_q
o
C
U
-Q
-
TO
a>
CO]
Q. UJ
U ffl
t-
tar.
228
OJ
TO
-o
E
a
449 540 Ma .4014 569 446 511 599 443 540 .4353 569 an .4090 440 .10597 .10657 9.3S31 .99437 434 626 3573 887 716 .3315 431 655 4.^ 746 .3060 684 775 .2800 424 713 10742 .10805 9.2553 .99421 834 418 771 2303 .2052 415 soo 863 .1803 412 Bsa B29 S58
922
.1555
205 234 263 291
409
9.1309 .99406 .1065 402
.10887 .10952 916 .10981 945 .11011 .10973 040 .11002 070 .11031 .11099 060 128 158 089 1S7 118 217 147 .11176 .11246
.0S21 399 .0579 396 .033S 393 9.0098 .99390 8.9860 3S6 .9623 383 .9387 380 .9152 377 8.8919 .99374 .8686 370
270 305 335 364
.5-455 .5.225
'
367 364 360
60 59
58 57 56 65 54 53 52 51 60 49
48 47 46 46 44
494 523 552 580
570 600 629 659
.11609 .11688
638 667 696 725
812 840 869
718 747 777 806
895 924 954
.4071 .3863 .3656
300 297 293
.11898 .11983 8.3450 .99290 927 .12013 .3245 286 042 .3041 956 283 072 .2838 .11985 279 .12014 101 .2636 276 .12043 .12131 8.2434 .99272 071 160 .2234 269 190 .2035 100 265 .1837 129 219 262 158 249 .1640 258 .12187 .1227S 8.1443 .99255
Cos
Cot
-
83°
Tan
Sin
6 7
8 9
10 11 12 13 14
16
274
302
.12331 .12426
360 389 418 447
456 485 515 544
.12476 .12574
504 533 562 591
603 633 662 692
.12620 .12722 649 751
20
.12764 .12869
39 38 37 36 36 34 33 32
21
793 899 822 929 851 958 880 .12988
15
.11465 .11541
6
308 338 367 397
40
.11754 .11836 8.4490 .99307 783 865 .42S0 303
423 452 482 511
3 4
216 345
16 17 18 19
31
349 378 407 436
i
2
.121S7 .12278
43 42 41
.7996 8.7769 .99357 .7542 354 .7317 351 .7093 347 .6S70 344 8.6648 .99341 .6427 337 .6208 334 .5969 331 .5772 327 8.5555 .99324 .5340 320 .5126 317 .4913 314 .4701 310
.11320 .11394
Sin
6
Tan
30 29 23 27 26 26 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 14 13 12 11
10 9
8 7 6 5 4 3
2 1
22 23 24 26 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 36 36 37 38 39 40 41
42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 60 51 52 53 54 56 56 57 58 59
60 '
678 706 735
781 810 840
.12908 .13017
937 966
047 076 106 136
Cot
Cos
B.1443 .1248 .1054 .0860 .0667 8.0476 .0285 8.0095 7.9906 .9718 7.9530 .9344 .9158 .8973 .8789 7.8606 .8424 .8243 .8062 .7882 7.7704 .7525 .7348 .7171 .6996 7.6821 .6647 .6473
.99255
787 817 846 876
.99237
233 230 226 222
.99200 197 193 189
215 211 208 204
Cot
3 4 5
6 7
8 9
10 11 12
13 14
15
186
41
.99182 178 175 171 167 .99163 160 156 .6301 152 .6129 148
40
20
39 38 37 36 35 34 33 32
21
.99144 141 137 133 129 .99125 122
30 29 28 27 26
30
26 24 23 22
35 36
.2531 .2375 .2220 .2066
118 114 110 .99106 102
Tan 82°
31
22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 31
32 33 34
.13917 .14054 046 084 .13975 113 .14004 143 033 173 .14061 .14202
090 119 148 177
232 2G2 291 321
.14205 .14351 234 3M
263 292
320
410 440 470
.14349 .14499
378 407 436 464
529 559 588 618
.14493 .14648
522 551 580 608
Cot 7.1
.1004 .0855 .0706 .0558
.9827 990 6.9682 .98986 .9538 982 .9395 978 .9252 973 .9110 969 6.8969 .98965 .8*28 961 .8087 957 .8548 953 .8408 948 6.8269 .98944
678 707 737 767
.8131 .7994 .7856 .7720
.14781 .14945 810 .14975 838 .15005
867 896
034 064
.14925 .15094 124 954 153 .149i>2 .15011 183
6.6912 .6779 .6646 .6514 .6383 6.6252 .6122 .5992 .5863 .5734 6.5606 .5478 .5350 .5223 .5097 6.4971 .4846
.15069 .15243
41
272 126 302 332 155 362 184 .15212 .15391 241 421 .4721 270 431 481 .4596 299 .4472 327 511 .15356 .15540 6.4348 570 .4225 385 .4103 414 600 .3980 442 630 .3859 471 660 .15500 .15689 6.3737 529 719 .3617 557 749 .3496 779 .3376 586 .3257 615 809 .15643 15838 6.3138
16
083 079 075 071
14 13 12
.99067
10
063 059 055 051
9
51
8
52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60
11
7
6 6
4 3 2 1
940 936 931 927
.14637 .14796 6.7584 .98923 .7448 826 919 666 .7313 914 695 856 .7179 910 723 886 .7045 906 752 915
40
091
028 019 015
011 7.0410 .99006 .0264 .99002 7.0117 .98998 6.9972 994
21
.99087
Cos
154 .99027
20
42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50
Sin
Tan
37 38 39
19 18 17 16
098 094
.13773 .13906 7.1912 .99047 802 935 .1759 043 831 .1607 039 965 .1455 860 .13995 035 889 .14024 .1304 031 .13917 .14054 7.1154 .99027
Cos
51
60 49 48 47 46 46 44 43 42
.99219
1
2
16 17 18 19
.12995 .13024 .13053 .13165 7.5958 081 .5787 195 110 224 .5618 139 .5449 254 168 284 .5281 .13197 .13313 7.5113 226 343 .4947 254 372 .4781 283 402 .4615 312 .4451 432 .13341 .13461 7.4287 370 .4124 491 399 .3962 521 427 550 .3800 456 580 .3639 .13485 .13609 7.3479 514 .3319 639 543 .3160 669 572 .3002 698 600 .2844 728 .13629 .13758 7.2687
658 687 716 744
251 248 244 240
1
60 59 58 57 56 66 54 53 52
Sin
040
213
097
Cos
Tan
Cot
81
c
.98902
897 893 889 884 .98880
876 871 867 863
60 59 58 57 50 65 54 53 52 51
60 49 48 47 40 46 44 43 42 41
40 39 38 37 36 35 34 33 32 31
30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22
854 849 845 841
21 20 19 18 17 16
.98836
15
832 827 823 818
14 13 12 11
.98814
10
.98858
809 805 800 796 .98791
787 782 778 .773 .98769
Sin
9 8
7 6 6 4 3 2 1
244
Appendix C
10° Sin
Cos Cot Tan 15838 6.3138 98769 764 .3019 868 760 .2901 898 755 .2783 928 751 .2666 958 15988 6.2549 .98746 741 .2432 16017 737 .2316 047 732 .2200 077 728 .2085 107
Sin
Tan
Il Cot
Cos
Sin
Tan
e
Cot
Cos
|
o 1
2 3
4 5 6 7
g 9 10 11
12 13 14
16 16 17 18 19
20 21 22 23 24
15643 672 701 730 758 15787 816 845 873 902 15931 959 15988 16017 046 .16074 103 132 160
16137 167 196
226 256 16286 316 346 376 405
189 .16218 .16435
465 495 525 555
246 275 304 333
25 .16361 .16585 615 390 26 645 419 27 674 447 28 704 476 29 30 .16505 .16734 764 533 31 794 562 32 824 591 33 854 620 34 35 .16648 .16884 914 677 36 944 706 37 .16974 734 38 763 .17004 39 40 .16792 .17033 063 820 41 093 849 42 878 L23 43 153 906 44 45 .16935 .17183 213 964 46 243 47 .16992 273 48 .17021 303 050 49 50 .17078 .17333 107 303 51 393 136 52 423 164 53 453 193 54 55 .17222 .17483 513 250 56 279 543 57 573 308 58 603 336 59 60 .17365 .17633
Cos
1
Cot
6.1970 .98723 718 .1856 714 .1742 709 .1628 704 .1515 6.1402 .98700 695 .1290 690 .1178 686 .1066 681 .0955 6.0844 .98676 671 .0734 667 .0624 662 .0514 657 .0405 6.0296 .98652 648 .0188 643 6.0080 638 5.9972 633 .9865 5.9758 .98629 624 .9651 619 .9545 614 .9439 609 .9333 5.9228 .98604 600 .9124 595 .9019 590 .8915 585 .8811 5.8708 .98580 575 .8005 570 .8502 565 .8400 561 .8298 5.8197 .98556 551 .8095 546 .7994 541 .7894 536 .7794 5.7694 .98531 526 .7594 521 .7495 516 .7390 511 .7297 5.7199 .98506 501 .7101 496 .7004 491 .6900 .6809 486 5.6713 .98481
Tan 80°
Sin
60 59 58 57 56 55 54 53 52
1
2 3
4 6 6 7
8
51
9
60 49 48 47 46 46 44 43 42
10 11 12 13 14
16
41
16 17 18 19
40
20
39
21
38
22 23 24 26 26 27 28 29
37 36 35 34 33 32 31
30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21
20
30 31 32 33
34 35 36 37 38 39 40
19 18 17 16
41
16
45
14 13 12 11
46 47 48 49 50
10 9 8 7
6 6
4 3
2 1
'
42 43 44
51 52 53
54 65 56 57 58 59 60
17365 .17633 5.6713 98481 393 .6617 663 476 422 693 .6521 471 451 723 .6425 466 479 753 .6329 461 17508 .17783 5.6234 .98455 537 813 .6140 450 565 843 .6045 445 594 873 .5951 440 623 903 .5857 435 .17651 .17933 5.5764 .98430 680 963 .5671 425 708 .17993 .5578 420 737 .18023 .5485 414 766 053 .5393 409 .17794 .18083 5.5301 823 113 .5209 852 143 .5118 880 173 .5026 909 203 .4936 .17937 .18233 5.4845 966 263 .4755 .17995 293 .4665 .18023 323 .4575 052 353 .4486 .18081 .18384 5.4397 109 414 .4308 138 444 .4219 166 474 .4131 195 504 .4043 .18224 .18534 5.3955 252 564 .3868 281 594 .3781 309 624 .3694 338 654 .3607 .18367 .18684 5.3521 395 714 .3435 424 745 .3349 452 775 .3263 481 805 .3178 .18509 .18835 5.3093 538 865 .3008 567 895 .2924 595 925 .2839 624 955 .2755 .18652 .18986 5.2672 681 .19016 .2588 710 046 .2505 738 076 .2422 767 .2339 106 .18795 .19136 5.2257 824 .2174 166 852 197 .2092 881 227 .2011 257 .1929 910
.98404
399 394 389 383
Cot
Tan 79°
.19081
59 58 57
1
2 3
56 55 54 53 52 51 50 49
48 47 46 45 44 43 42
4 6
109 138 167 195 .19224
6 7 8 9
252
10
.19366
11
12 13 14
395 423 452 481
15
.19509
16 17 18
538 566 595 623
281
309 338
19438 5.1446 468 .1366 498 .1286 529 .1207 559 .1128 .19589 5.1049 619 .0970 649 .0892 .0814 680 710 .0736 .19740 5.0658 770 .0581 .0504 801 831 .0427 861 .0350 .19891 5.0273 921 .0197 952 .0121 .19982 5.0045 .20012 4.9969 .20042 4.9894 073 .9819
41
19
.98378
40
373 368 362 357
39 38 37 36 35 34 33 32 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19
20 .19652 21 680 22 103 .9744 709 .9669 23 737 133 164 .9594 24 766 25 .19794 .20194 4.9520 224 .9446 26 823 254 851 .9372 27 880 285 .9298 28 315 .9225 29 908 30 .19937 .20345 4.9152 376 .9078 31 965 406 .9006 32 .19994 33 .20022 436 .8933 051 466 .8860 34 36 .20079 .20497 4.8788 527 .8716 36 108
.98352
347 341 336 331 .98325
320 315 310 304 .98299
294 288 283 277 .98272
267 261 256 250
37 38 39
40 41
18 17 16
42 43 44
.98245
16
240 234 229 223
14 13 12
45 46
.98218
10
212 207 201 196
9 8
.18938 .19287 5.1848 .98190 967 317 .1767 185 .18995 347 .1686 179 .19024 378 .1606 174 052 408 .1526 168 .19081 .19438 5.1446 .98163
Cos
60
Sin
11
7 6
6
4 3 2 1
/
47 48 49 60 51
.98163 157 152 146 140 .98135 129 124
118 112 .98107 101
096 090 084 .98079
073 067 061 056
78°
50 49 48 47 46 45 44 43 42 41
40 39 38 37 36 36 34 33 32
.98021
016 010 .98004 .97998 .97992
987 981 975 969 .97963
958
52 53 54 65 .20649 .21104 4.7385 .97845 677 134 .7317 839 56 164 .7249 57 706 833 734 195 827 .7181 58 225 59 763 .7114 821 60 .20791 .21256 4.7046 .97815
Tan
51
044 039 033 027
770 .8147 910 336 .20364 .20800 4.8077 .97905 .8007 899 393 830 .7937 893 421 861 .7867 887 450 891 921 .7798 881 478 .20507 .20952 4.7729 .97875 .7659 869 535 .20982 563 .21013 .7591 863 857 592 043 .7522 073 .7453 851 620
Cot
59 58 57 56 55 54 53 52
.98050
557 .8644 952 136 .8573 946 165 588 618 .8501 940 193 .20222 .20648 4.8430 .97934 679 928 250 .8359 922 279 709 .8288 739 307 .8218 916
Cos
60
Sin
31
30 29 28 27
26 25 24 23 22 21
20 19 18 17
16
15 14 13 12 11
10 9 8 7 6
6 4 3 2 1
'
245
Appendix C
13°
12°
T
S.n .207 iM
1
BM
2
84S
o
877
4
905
5
.20933
6
888
7
.209911
S
.21019
9 10 11
12 13 14
15 16 17 IS 19
20
047 .21076 104 138 161 188 .21218 246
275 303 331 .21360
21
22 23 24 25 26 27 2S 29 30
417 445 474 .21502 530 559 587 616
31 32
672
33 34 35 36 37 38 39
.21644
701 729
758 .21786
814 843 871 899
40
.21928
41
956
42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50
.21985 .22013
51 52 53
54
240 268 297 325
55
.22353
56 57 58 59 60
382 410 438 467
041 22070 098 126 155 183 .22212
.22495
Cos
Tan
Cot
Cos
4.7046 .97815 .6979 BOO 988 .6912 316 803 797 347 .6845 .6779 791 877 4.0712 .97784 .81408 .6646 778 488 77: 469 .6580 499 .6514 766 .644J. 760 529 .21560 4.6382 .97754 .6317 748 580 742 .6252 621 735 651 .6187 .6122 729 688 .21712 4.6057 .97723 .5993 717 743 773 711 .5928 .5864 705 S04 .5800 834 698 21S64 4.5736 .97692 S95 .5073 686 .5609 925 6S0 .5546 673 956 667 21986 .54S3 .22017 4.5420 .97661 047 .5357 655 .5294 648 07S .5232 642 10S .5169 139 636 .22169 4.5107 .97630 .5045 623 200 .4983 617 231 .4922 261 611 292 .4860 604 .22322 4.4799 .97598 .4737 353 592 .4676 585 383 .4615 579 414 .4555 573 444 .22475 4.4494 .97566 .4434 560 505 .4373 536 553 .4313 547 567 4253 597 541 .22628 4.4194 .97534 .4134 658 528 4075 689 521 719 .4015 515 .3956 508 750 .22781 4.3897 .97502 .3838 496 811 .3779 489 842 .3721 872 483 .3662 476 903 .22934 4.3604 .97470 .3546 964 463 .22995 .3488 457 .3430 .23026 450 .3372 056 444 .23087 4.3315 .97437 .21256
Cot
I
77°
Tan
Sin
60 59
58 57 56 55 54 53 52 51 50 49 4S 47 46 45 44 43 42 41
40 39 38 37 36 35 34 33 32 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24
Cos Sin Tan Cot 6 .22495 .23087 4.3315 .97437 .3257 430 523 117 i .3200 552 148 424 2 .3143 417 179 580 3 209 .3086 411 608 4 5 .22637 .23240 4.3029 .97404 271 .2972 665 398 6 7 8 9 10 11
12 13 14
15 16 17 18 19
20 21
23 22 21
22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 36 36 37 38 39
20
40
19 18 17 16
41
15 14 13 12 11
10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3
2 1
'
14°
42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53
54 55 56 57 58 59 60
693 722 750
301 .2916 332 .2859 363 .2803 .22778 .23393 4.2747 807 424 .2691 835 455 .2635 485 .2580 863 .2524 892 516 .22920 .23547 4.2468 578 948 .2413 .22977 608 .2358 .23005 639 .2303 670 .2248 033 .23062 .23700 4.2193 731 .2139 090 762 .2084 118 793 .2030 146 823 .1976 175 .23203 .23854 4.1922 231 885 .1868 260 916 .1814 946 .1760 288 .1706 316 .23977 .23345 .24008 4.1653 373 .1600 039 .1547 401 069 .1493 429 100 .1441 458 131 .23486 .24162 4.1388 .1335 514 193 .1282 542 223 .1230 571 254 599 285 .1178 .23627 .24316 4.1126 .1074 656 347 684 377 .1022 .0970 712 408 740 439 .0918 .23769 .24470 4.0867 .0815 797 501 .0764 825 532 .0713 853 562 .0662 882 593 .23910 .24624 4.0611 .0560 938 655 966 .0509 686 .23995 .24023
717 747
.0459 .0408
391
384 378
59 58 57 56 56 54 53 52 51
325 318 311 .97304
365 358 351
345 .97338 331
298 291 284 278 .97271
264 257 251 244 .97237
230 223 217 210
|
76
Tan c
Sin
6 .24192 220 i 249 2 277 3 305 4 5 .24333 362 6 7 390 8 418 9 446 10
.24474
11 12 13
503 531 559 587
14 15
.24615
41
18 19
644 672 700 728
40
20
.24756
39 38 37 36 35 34 33 32 31 30 29 28 27 26
21
784 813 841 869
16 17
22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29
.24897
925 954
30
.24982 .25010 .25038
31 32 33
066 094 122 151 .25179
.97203 196 189 182 176 .97169 162 155 148 141
25 24
34 35 36
23 22 21
37 38 39
207 235 263 291
20
40
.25320
19 18 17 16
41 42 43
348 376 404 432
.97134 127 120 113 106 .97100
15
093 086 079 072
9
14 13 12 11
10 8 7 6 5
4 3
2 1
4.0108 .97030
.24192 .24933
Cot
60
50 49 48 47 46 45 44 43 42
.97371
.24051 .24778 4.0358 .97065 079 .0308 809 058 840 .0257 108 051 .0207 136 871 044 902 .0158 037 164
Cos
1
Sin
'
Tan
Cot
Cos
.24933
4.0108 .0058 4.0009 3.9959 .9910 3.9861 .9812 .9763 .9714 .9665 3.9617 .9568 .9520
.97030
964 .24995 .25026
056 .25087 118
023 015 008 .97001
.96994
987 149 980 180 973 211 966 .25242 .96959 273 952 304 945 .9471 335 937 .9423 366 930 .25397 3.9375 .96923 .9327 916 428 .9279 459 909 .9232 490 902 .9184 894 521 .25552 3.9136 .96887 .9089 880 583 .9042 873 614 .8995 645 866 .8947 858 676 .25707 3.8900 .96851 .8854 844 738 .8807 837 769 .8760 829 800 .8714 822 831 .25862 3.8667 .96815 .8621 807 893 .8575 924 800 955 .8528 793 .8482 786 .25986 .26017 3.8436 .96778 .8391 771 048 .8345 764 079 .8299 756 110 .8254 749 141 .26172 3.8208 .96742 .8163 203 734 235 .8118 727 266 .8073 719 .8028 712 297 .26328 3.7983 .96705 .7938 697 359 .7893 390 690 .7848 421 682 .7804 675 452 .26483 3.7760 .96667 .7715 515 660 .7671 546 653 577 .7627 645 .7583 608 638 .26639 3.7539 .96630 .7495 670 623 .7451 701 615 .7408 733 608 .7364 764 600
44 45 .25460 488 46 47 516 545 48 49 573 60 .25601 629 51 657 52 685 53 54 713 55 .25741 769 56 57 798 826 58 59 854 60 .25882 .26795 3.7321 .96593
Cos
Tan
Cot
75°
Sin
60 59 58 57 56 56 54 53 52 51
60 49 48 47 46 45 44 43 42 41
40 39 38 37 36
35 34 33 32 31
30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21
20 19
18 17 16
15 14 13 12 11
10 9 8 7
6 5
4 3
2 1
/
246
Appendix C
15 '
Sin
Tan
.25S&2 .26795
3
910 938 966
4
.25994
6
.26022 .26951 050 .26982 079 .27013
1
2
6
7 8 9 10 11 12 13
14
15 16 17 18 19
20 21
22 23
107
359 387 415
500 528 556
.26976
40
27004 032 060 088
47 48 49 60 51 52 53 54 66 56 57 58 59
60
201 232
326 357 388
.26443 .27419 471 451
39
44 46 46
044
.26303 .27263 294 331
24 25 .26584 26 612 27 640 28 668 29 696 30 .26724 752 31 32 780 33 808 34 836 36 .26864 892 36 920 37 948 38
41 42 43
826 857 888 920
076 135 .26163 .27107 191 138 219 169 247 275
116
27144 172
200 228 256 .27284
312 340 368 396 27424 452 480 508 536 27564
Cos
c
482 513 545 .27576
607 638 670 701
16° Cot
Sin
Tan
17° Cot
Cos
Tan
Cot Cos 29237 30573 3.2709 95630 265 605 .2675 622 293 637 .2641 613 321 669 .2607 605 348 700 .2573 596 Sin
|
3.7321 .96593 585 .7277 578 .7234 570 .7191 562 .7148
3.7105 .7062 .7019 .6976 .6933 3.6891 .6848 .6806 .6764 .6722 3.6680 .6638 .6596 .6554 .6512 3.6470 .6429 .6387 .6346 .6305 3.6264 .6222 .6181 .6140 .6100
.27732 3.6059 764 .6018 795 .5978 826 .5937 858 .5897 .27889 3.5856 921 .5816 952 .5776 .27983 .5736 .28015 .5696 .28046 3.5656 077 .5616 109 .5576 140 .5536 172 .5497 .28203 3.5457 234 .5418 266 .5379 297 .5339 329 .5300 .28360 3.5261 391 .5222 423 .5183 454 .5144 486 .5105 .28517 3.5067 549 .5028 580 .4989 612 .4951 643 .4912 .2*675 3.4874
Cot
Cos
Tan 74°
.96555
547 540 532 524 .96517 509 502
494 486 .96479
471 463 456
448 .96440
433 425 417 410 .96402
394 386 379 371 .96363
355 347 340 332 .96324
316 308
60 59
1
58
2 3
57
56 66 54 53
4
52 51
8 9 10
60 49 48 47 46 46 44 43 42 41 40 39 38 37 36 36 34 33 32 31 30 29 28 27 26 26
301
24 23 22
293
21
.96285
20
277 269
19 18 17 16
261 253 .96246 238
230 222 214 .96206 198 190 182 174
.96166 158 150 142 134 .96126
Sin
16 14 13 12 11
10 9 8 7
6 5 4 3
2 1
6 6 7
11 12 13 14
15 16 17 18 19
20 21
22 23 24 26 26 27
28 29 30 31
32 33 34 36 36 37 38 39 40 41
42 43 44 46 46 47 48 49
50 51
52 53 54 65 56 57 58 59
60
27564 28675 3.4874 592 706 .4836 .4798 620 738 648 769 .4760 676 801 .4722 27704 2S832 3.4684 731 864 .4646 759 895 .4608 927 .4570 787 815 958 .4533 27843 28990 3.4495 .4458 871 29021 .4420 899 053 927 0S4 .4383 955 116 .4346 27983 .29147 3.4308 .4271 28011 179 .4234 039 210 242 .4197 067 274 .4160 095
.96126 118 110 102
094 .96086
078 070 062 054 .96046
037 029 021 013 .96005 .95997
989 981 972
60 59 58 57 56 56 54 53 52 51 50 49 48 47 46
45 44 43 42 41
.28123 .29305 3.4124 .95964 40 956 39 337 .4087 150 948 38 368 .4050 178 940 37 400 .4014 206 432 .3977 931 36 234 .28262 .29463 3.3941 .95923 35 915 34 495 .3904 290 907 33 318 526 .3868 .3832 898 32 558 346 890 31 590 .3796 374 .28402 .29621 3.3759 .95882 30 874 29 653 .3723 429 865 28 685 .3687 457 857 27 .3652 485 716 849 26 748 .3616 513 .28541 .29780 3.3580 .95841 25 811 .3544 832 24 569 843 .3509 824 23 597 .3473 816 22 875 625 807 21 906 .3438 652 .28680 .29938 3.3402 .95799 20 .3367 791 19 708 .29970 .3332 782 18 736 .30001 .3297 774 17 033 764 766 16 065 .3261 792 .28820 .30097 3.3226 .95757 16 .3191 749 14 128 847 .3156 740 13 160 875 .3122 732 12 192 903 724 11 .3087 224 931 3.3052 .95715 10 .30255 .28959 707 9 287 .3017 .28987 698 319 .2983 8 .29015 690 351 .2948 7 042 .2914 681 6 382 070 6 .29098 .30414 3.2879 .95673 664 .2845 4 446 126 .2811 656 3 478 154 .2777 647 2 509 182 639 1 .2743 541 209 .29237 .30573
Cos
Tan 73°
Sin
2
3
4 5 .29376 .30732 3.2539 .95588 404 6 764 .2506 579 432 7 796 .2472 571 460 8 828 .2438 562 9 487 860 .2405 554 10 .29515 .30891 3.2371 .95545 543 11 923 .2338 536 571 12 955 .2305 528 599 .30987 13 .2272 519 626 .31019 14 .223s> 511 15 .29654 .31051 3.2205 .95502 682 16 083 .2172 493 710 17 115 .2139 485 737 147 .2106 476 18 765 467 19 178 .2073 20 .29793 .31210 3.2041 .95459 821 21 242 .2008 450 849 22 274 .1975 441 876 23 306 .1943 433 904 338 .1910 424 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39
40 41
42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 65 56 57 58 59
60
3.2709 .95630
Cot
1
'
.29932 .31370
960 .29987 .30015
043
402 434 466 498
3.1878 .95415 .1845 407 .1813 .1780 .1748
398 389 380
.30071 .31530 3.1716 .95372 098 562 .1684 363 126 594 .1652 354 154 626 .1620 345 182 337 658 .1588
3.1556 .95328 .1524 319 .1492 310 .1460 301 .1429 293 .30348 .31850 3.1397 .95284 376 882 .1366 275 914 403 .1334 266 431 946 .1303 257 459 .31978 .1271 248 .30486 .32010 3.1240 .95240 042 .1209 514 231 542 074 .1178 222 670 106 .1146 213 597 139 .1115 204 .30625 .32171 3.1084 .95195 653 203 .1053 186 .1022 680 235 177 267 708 .0991 168 299 .0961 159 736 .30763 .32331 3.0930 .95150 791 363 .0899 142 819 396 .0868 133 846 428 .0838 124 874 460 .0807 115 .30902 .32492 3.0777 .95106
.30209 .31690
237 265 292 320
Cos
722 754 786 818
Cot
Tan 72°
Sin
60 59 58 57 56 65 54 53 52 51
60 49 48 47 46 46 44 43 42 41
40 39 38 37 36 35 34 33 32 31
30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21
20 19 18 17 16
15 14 13 12 11
10 9 8 7 6
6
4 3 2 1
247
Appendix C
20°
19°
18°
'
T
Sin
Tan
Cot
32492 3.0777 524 .0746 i 957 556 .0716 2 .0686 a .30985 688 4 .31012 621 .0655 5 .31040 32653 3.0625 .0595 6 068 885 095 717 .0565 7 123 .0535 749 8 151 .0505 188 10 .3117$ 32S14 3.0475 .0445 11 206 S46 ^7^ 233 .0415 13 261 911 .0385 14 .0356 943 us 15 31316 32975 3.0326 344 33007 .0296 16 372 .0267 17 040 .0237 399 072 18 427 .020S 104 20 .31454 33136 3.0178 21 4S2 .0149 169 22 510 .0120 201 537 .0090 233 24 565 .0061 266
30902 929
u
U
a
25 26
27 as 29
30 31 32
33 34 35 36 37
3S 39
40 41
42 43 44 45 46 47 45 49 50 51 58
53
M 55
56 57 5s 59
60
Cos 95106 097 OSS 079
070 95061 052 043 033 024 95015 95006 94997 9SS 979 94970 961 952 943 933 94924 915 906 897 888
.31593 .3329S 3.0032 .94878 869 620 330 3.0003 64 B 860 363 2.9974 675 395 .9945 851 703 427 .9916 842 .31730 .33460 2.9887 .94832 758 492 .9858 823 786 524 .9829 814 813 .9800 805 557 841 589 .9772 795 .31868 .33621 2.9743 .94786 896 777 654 .9714 768 923 686 .9686 951 718 .9657 758 .31979 .9629 749 751
.32006 .33783 2.9600 034 .9572 816 061 848 .9544 089 .9515 881 116 913 .9487 .32144 .33945 2.9459 171 .33978 .9431 199 .34010 .9403 227 043 .9375 254 075 .9347 .32282 34108 2.9319 309 140 .9291 337 173 .9263 364 205 .9235 392 238 .9208 .32419 34270 2.9180 447 303 .9152 474 335 .9125 502 368 .9097 529 400 .9070 .32557 34433 2.9042
Cob
Cot
Tan 71°
.94740
730 721 712 702 .94693 684
674 665 656 94646 637 627 618 609 94599 590 580 571 561 .94552
Sin
Sin
Tan
Cot
Cos
32557 34433 2.9042 94552 542 584 465 .9015 498 .8987 533 612 523 639 530 .8960 563 .8933 514 667 2.8905 94504 .32694 34596 628 .8878 495 722 661 485 749 .8851 .8824 476 777 693 .8797 726 466 804 .32832 34758 2.8770 94457 791 .8743 447 859 824 .8716 887 438 .8689 914 856 428 889 .8662 418 942 .32969 .34922 2.8636 .94409 954 .8609 399 .32997 .8582 390 .33024 .34987 .8556 051 .35020 380 052 .8529 370 079
33106 .35085 2.8502 .94361 118 .8476 351 134 150 .8449 342 161 183 .8423 189 332 216 .8397 322 216 .33244 .35248 2.8370 .94313 281 .8344 303 271 314 .8318 293 29S
346 .8291 326 284 379 .8265 274 353 33381 .35412 2.8239 .94264 445 .8213 254 408 477 .8187 245 436 510 .8161 463 235 543 .8135 490 225 .33518 .35576 2.8109 .94215 608 .8083 545 206 641 .8057 196 573 674 .8032 186 600 707 .8006 627 176 .35740 2.7980 .94167 .33655 772 .7955 157 682 805 .7929 710 147 838 .7903 737 137 .7878 871 127 764 .33792 .35904 2.7852 .94118 937 .7827 108 819 .7801 098 846 35969 .7776 088 874 36002 035 .7751 901 078 33929 36068 2.7725 .94068 101 .7700 956 058
.33983 .34011
038 .34065
093
134 167 199
.7675 .7650 .7625
049 039
029
36232 2.7600 .94019 265 .7575 .94009 298 .7550 .93999 331 .7525 989 364 .7500 979
120 147 175 .34202 .36397 2.7475 .93969
Cos
Cot
Tan
70°
Sin
Tan
Cot Cos 6 .34202 .30397 2.7475 93969 95'.) i 229 .7450 430 919 2 257 .7425 463 3 284 .7400 939 496 4 5 6 7
8 9
10 11
12 13 14
Sin
311
529
.7376
.34339 .36562 595 366
2.7351 .7326 .7302 .7277 .7253
393 421 448
628 001
694
.34475 .36727
503 530 557 584
760 793 826 859
16
.34612 .36892
16 17
639 925 666 958 694 .36991 721 .37024
18 19
20 .34748 21 775 22 803 23 830 24 857 26 .34884 26 912 27 939 28 966 29 .34993 80 .35021 31 048 32 075 33 102 34 130 36 .35157 36 184 37 211 38 239 39 266 40 .35293 41 320 42 347 43 375 44 402 46 .35429 456 46 484 47 48 511 49 638 60 .35565 592 61 619 52 647 53 674 54 66 .35701 728 66 755 57 782 58 69 810 60 .35837
Cos
.37057
090 123 157
190 .37223
256 289 322 355
929 93919 909 899 889 879
2.7228 .93869 .7204 859 .7179 849 839 .7155 .7130 829 2.7106 .93819 809 .7082 799 .7058 .7034 789 779 .7009 2.6985 .93769 .6961 759 748 .6937 738 .6913 728 .6889 2.6865 .93718 .6841 .6818 .6794 .6770
708 698 688 677
60 59 58 57 50 55 54 53
52 51
50 49 48 47 46 46 44 43 42 41
40 39 38 37 36 35 34 33 32 31
.37388 2.6746 .93667 657 422 .6723 647 455 .6699 637 488 .6675 626 521 .6652 .37554 2.6628 .93616 606 588 .6605 596 621 .6581 654 585 .6558 575 687 .6534 .37720 2.6511 .93565 555 754 .6488 544 .6464 787 534 .6441 820 524 853 .6418 .37887 2.6395 .93514 503 920 .6371 493 .6348 953 .6325 483 .37986 .6302 472 .38020
30
2.6279 .93462 452 .6256 441 .6233 431 .6210 .6187 420 2.6165 .93410 400 .6142 .6119 389 379 .6096 .6074 368 2.6051 .93358
10 9 8
.38053
086 120 153 186 .38220
253 286 320 353 .38386 |
Cot
Tan 69°
Sin
29 28 27
26 25 24 23 22 21
20 19 18 17 16
16 14 13 12 11
7
6
6 4 3
2 1
/
248
Appendix C
21 /
1
2 3
4 6 6 7
8 9
10 11
12 13 14
15 16 17 18
Sin
217 .36244 271
19
.36379
21
406 434 461 488
32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43
Cot
2.5826 .93253 .5804 243 .5782 232 .5759 222 .5737 211 854 .38888 2.5715 .93201 .5693 190 921 .5671 180 955 .5649 169 .38988 .5627 159 .39022 .39055 2.5605 .93148 .5583 137 089 .5561 127 122 .5539 116 156 .5517 106 190 .39223 2.5495 .93095 .5473 084 257
.36108 .38721 135 754 162 787 190 821
20
31
22°
.36515
542 569 596 623
290 324 357
.5452 .5430 .5408
074 063 052
.36650 .39391
2.5386 .5365 .5343 .5322 .5300 2.5279 .5257 .5236 .5214 .5193 2.5172 .5150 .5129 .5108 .5086 2.5065 .5044 .5023 .5002
.93042
677 704 731 758
425 458 492
626
.36785 .39559
812 839 867 894
593 626 660 694
.36921 .39727 948 761 .36975 795 .37002 829
031 020 .93010 .92999 .92988
978 967 956 945
Cot
Tan 68°
80
10
40
20
39 38 37 36 35 34 33 32 31 30 29 28 27 26 26 24 23 22
21
21
20
924 913 902 892
19 18 17 16
.92881
16
870 859 849 838
14 13 12
.92827
10
816 805 794 784
9
.92773
6 4 3 2
762 751 740 729 .92718 |
Sin
11
8 7
6
1
'
Sin
23°
Tan
Cot
5 6 7
8 9 11
12 13 14
16 16 17 18 19
22 23 24 26 26 27 28 29
.37595 .40572 2.4648 .4627 622 606 649 640 .4606 676 674 .4586 .4566 703 707 .37730 .40741 2.4545 .4525 757 775 784 809 .4504 811 843 .4484 .4464 838 877 .37865 .40911 2.4443 .4423 892 945 .4403 919 .40979 946 .41013 .4383 047 .4362 973 .37999 .41081 2.4342 .38026 .4322 115 053 149 .4302 .4282 080 183 .4262 107 217
.38134 .41251 2.4242 .4222 161 285 .4202 188 319 .4182 215 353 .4162 241 387 80 .38268 .41421 2.4142 .4122 455 295 31 .4102 322 490 32 524 .4083 349 33 .4063 558 34 376 36 .38403 .41592 2.4043 .4023 430 626 36 .4004 37 456 660 .3984 38 483 694 .3964 39 728 510 40 .38537 .41763 2.3945 797 .3925 41 664 .3906 42 691 831 .3886 43 617 865 .3867 44 644 899 46 .38671 .41933 2.3847 .3828 46 698 .41968 .3808 47 725 .42002 .3789 48 752 036 .3770 49 070 778 60 .38805 .42105 2.3750 .3731 51 832 139 .3712 52 859 173 .3693 53 207 886 .3673 54 242 912 66 .38939 .42276 2.3654 310 .3635 56 966 345 .3616 67 .38993 379 .3597 58 .39020 .3578 413 59 046 60 .39073 .42447 2.3559
Cot
Tan
Cot
67
c
/
Cos
6 .37461 .40403 2.4751 .92718 .4730 707 488 436 i 697 516 470 .4709 2 .4689 642 504 686 3 538 .4668 675 569 4
59 58 57 56 66 54 53 52 51 60 49 48 47 46 45 44 43 42 41
.92935
029 44 862 45 .37056 .39896 083 46 930 110 47 963 137 .39997 48 164 .40031 49 .4981 60 .37191 .40065 2.4960 218 51 098 .4939 52 245 132 .4918 272 53 166 .4897 54 299 200 .4876 56 .37326 .40234 2.4855 56 353 267 .4834 57 380 301 .4813 58 407 335 .4792 59 434 369 .4772 60 .37461 .40403 2.4751 Cos
/
Cos
35837 .38386 2.6051 .93353 420 .6028 318 864 337 891 453 .6006 487 327 .5983 918 520 .5961 316 945 35973 .38553 2.5938 .93306 587 295 36000 .5916 620 .5893 285 027 654 .5871 274 054 081 687 .5848 264
298 325 352
22 23 24 26 26 27 28 29 30
Tan
c
.92664
653 642 631 620 .92609
598 587 576 565 .92554 643
532 621 510 .92499
488 477 466 455
60 59 58 57 56 66 54 53 52
1
2 3
4 6 6 7
8
51 50
9 10
49 48 47 46 45 44 43 42 41 40 39 38 37 36 35 34 33 32
11 12 13 14
15 16 17 18 19
20
31
21 22 23 24 26 26 27 28 29
.92388
30
30
377 366 355 343
29 28 27 26 26 24 23 22
31 32 33 34
.92444
432 421 410 399
.92332 321
310 299 287
21
.92276
20
265 254 243 231
19 18 17 16
.92220
16
209 198 186 175
14 13 12 11
.92164 152 141 130 119 .92107
10
096 085 073 062
4
9
8 7
6 6 3
2 1
.92050
Sin
/
35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43
44 46 46 47 48
Sin
Tan
Cot
.39073 .42447 100 482 127 516 153 551
Cos
2.3559 .92050
60
.3539 039 .3520 028 .3501 016 .3483 .92005
59 58 67 56
.91994
66 54
180 585 .39207 .42619 2.3464 234 654 .3445 260 688 .3426 287 722 .3407 314 757 .3388 .39341 .42791 2.3369 367 826 .3351 394 860 .3332 421 894 .3313 448 929 .3294 .39474 .42963 2.3276 601 .42998 .3257 528 .43032 .3238 655 067 .3220 681 101 .3201 .39608 .43136 2.3183 635 170 .3164 661 205 .3146 688 239 .3127 715 274 .3109 .39741 .43308 2.3090 768 343 .3072 795 378 .3053 822 412 .3036 848 447 .3017 .39875 .43481 2.2098 902 616 .2980 928 650 .2962 955 585 .2944 .39982 620 .2925 .40008 .43654 2.2907 035 689 .2889 062 724 .2871 768 .2853 088 115 793 .2835 .40141 .43828 2.2817 168 862 .2799 195 897 .2781 .2763 221 932 248 .43966 .2745 .40275 .44001 2.2727 .2709 301 036 .2691 328 071 .2673 355 105 .2655 381 140
982 971 959 948 .91936
925 914 902 891
Cot
Tan 66°
51
60 49
48 47
.91879
46 46
868 856 845 833
44 43 42 41
.91822
40
810 799
39 38 37 36
787 775 .91764 762 741 729 718 .91706
694 683 671
660 .91648
636 625 613 601 .91690
36 34 33 32 31
30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21
20
678 666 655 543
19 18 17 16
.91531
15
619 508 496 484
14 13 12
49 60 .40408 .44175 2.2637 .91472 210 .2620 51 434 461 244 .2602 52 449 461 279 .2584 53 488 437 314 .2666 425 54 614 66 .40541 .44349 2.2549 .91414 567 384 .2531 402 66 594 418 .2513 390 57 .2496 621 453 378 58 59 647 488 .2478 366 .44523 2.2460 60 .40674 .91355
Cos
53 52
Sin
11
10 9 8 7
6 5 4 3 2 1
i
249
Appendix C
|
Tan
Cot
1
2
700
m
59.!
ni
662
.;
4
6 6 7
S
\>o BOO
m
1
913
.40939
11 12 13
966
15 16 17 18 19
20 21
22 23 24 35 26 27 28 29
30 31
32 33 34
36 36 37 38
39 40 41
42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49
60 61
52 53 54
2408
627
319 307
.3390 2.2373 .91295 2355 383 rsa 272 707 .2338 .2320 802 380 248 SJ7 .2303 .91236 .44873 2.2286
.40808 .44697
10
14
668
2268
907 942
.2251 .2234 .2216
.40992 .41019 .44977 045 .45012
224 212 200 188 .91176 164 152 140
.41072 .45047 2.2199 .2182 0S2 09S .2165 125 117 152 .214S 151 .2130 128 17S 1S7 .41204 .45222 2.2113 .91116 104 231 257 .2096 092 257 292 .2079 080 327 .2062 2S4 .2045 068 362 310 .41337 .45397 2.202S .91056
363 390 416 443
432 467 502 638
.41469 .45573
496 522 549 675
608 643 678 713
.41602 .45748
628 655 681 707
784 819 854 889
.41734 .45924
760 960 787 .45995 813 .46030 840 065 .41866 .46101 892 136 919 171
945 972
206 242
.41998 .46277 .42024 312 051 348
077 104
383 418 66 .42130 .46454 56 156 489 57 183 525 68 209 660 69 235 595 60 .42262 .46631
Cm
Cot
|
.2011 .1994 .1977
044 032 020
.1960 2.1943 .1926 .1909 .1892 .1876 2.1859 .1842 .1825 .1808 .1792 2.1775 .1758 .1742 .1725 .1708 2.1692 .1675 .1659 .1642 .1625 2.1609 .1592 .1576 .1560 .1643 2.1527 .1510 .1494 .1478 .1461 2.1445
.91008 .90996
Tan
65°
/
Cos
2.2460 .01355 .2443 343 331 2426
.40074 .44523
26*
25°
24° Sin
984 972 960 948 .90936
924 911 899 887
60 59 5S 57 56 55 54 53 52 51
50 49 4S 47 46 45 44 43 42 41 40 39 38 37 36 35 34 33 32 31 30 29 28 27
26 25
.90875
24 23 22 21 20
863 851 839 826
19 18 17 16
.90814
15
802 790 778 766
14 13 12 11
.90753 741
10
729 717 704
8 7 6 5
.90692
680 668 655 643
9
4
3 2 1
.90631
Sin
'
Sin
Tan
Cot
Cos
6 .42202 .46631 2.1445 .90631 .1429 618 666 i 388 Q 702 .1413 606 315 594 341 737 .1396 3 .1380 682 367 772 4 6
6 7
8 9 10 11 12 13 14
15 16 17
18 19
20 21 22
23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39
40 41 42
43 44 45 46 47 48 49 60 51 52
63 54 66 56 57 58
69 60
.42394 .4680S 2.1364 .90569 557 .1348 420 843 .1332 545 446 879 532 914 .1315 473 .1299 520 499 950 .42525 .46985 2.1283 .90507 .1267 495 552 .47021 483 578 056 .1251 .1235 470 604 092 .1219 458 631 128 .42657 .47163 2.1203 .90446 433 199 .1187 683 234 .1171 421 709 270 .1155 408 736 396 762 305 .1139 .42788 .47341 2.1123 .90383 377 .1107 371 815 358 841 412 .1092 346 867 448 .1076 .1060 334 894 483 .42920 .47519 2.1044 .90321 946 555 .1028 309 .1013 296 972 590 626 .0997 284 .42999 .43025 662 .0981 271 .43051 .47698 2.0965 .90259 077 733 .0950 246 769 .0934 233 104 805 .0918 221 130 .0903 208 156 840
2.0887 .90196 .0872 209 912 183 948 .0856 171 235 .0840 158 261 .47984 .0825 146 287 .48019 .43313 .48055 2.0809 .90133 091 .0794 120 340 127 .0778 108 366 163 .0763 095 392 082 198 .0748 418 .43445 .48234 2.0732 .90070 270 .0717 057 471 306 497 .0701 045 342 623 .0686 032 378 .0671 019 649 .43575 .48414 2.0655 .90007 .0640 .89994 602 450 .0625 628 486 981 521 .0609 968 654 .0594 680 657 956 .43706 .48593 2.0579 .89943 629 .0564 733 930 .0549 759 665 918 785 701 .0533 905 .0518 892 811 737 .43837 .48773 2.0503 .89879
.43182 .47876
Cos
Cot
Tan 64°
Sin
Tan
Sin
60 59 68 67 56 66 54 53 52
1
2
889
845
3
Jit.
881
S 12
917
4
6 6 7
8
51
9
60 49 48 47 46 46 44 43 42
10 11
12 13 14
15
41
16 17 18 19
40
20
39 38 37 36 36 34 33 32
21 22 23
31
30 29 28
24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31
24 23 22 21
32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39
20
40
19 18 17 16
41 42 43
27
26 26
15 14 13 12 11
10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
'
.43837 .48773 883 809
44 46 46 47 48 49 60 51
52 53 54 66 56 57 58 59 60
.43968 .43094 18989 .44020 .19020 .
046 072
002 098
.44098 .49134 124 170 151 200 177 242
203
278
.44229 .49315 255 351 281 387
307 333
Cot
Cos
2.0503 .diss .0473 .0458 .0443 2.0428 .0413 .0398 .0383 .0368 2.0353 .0338 .0323 .0308 .0293 2.0278
.89879 S07
.0263 .0248 .0233 .0219
423 459
854 341
828 .89816 803 790
777 764 .89752
739 726 713 700 .89687
674 662 649 636
.44359 .49495 2.0204 .89623 .0189 385 532 610 .0174 411 568 597 .0160 437 584 604 .0145 464 640 571 .44490 .49677
516 542 568 594
2.0130 .89558
713 749 786 822
.0115 .0101 .0086 .0072
545 532 519 506
60 50 58 57
56 55 54
53 52 51
50 49 48 47
4G 45 44 43 42 41
40 39 38 37 36 35 34 33 32 31
.44620 .49858 2.0057 .89493 .0042 480 646 894 .0028 467 672 931 454 698 .49967 2.0013 1.9999 441 724 .50004 .44750 .50040 1.9984 .89428 415 .9970 776 076 .9955 402 802 113 .9941 389 149 828 .9926 376 854 185 .44880 .50222 1.9912 .89363 .9897 350 906 258 337 932 295 .9883 324 958 .9868 331 311 .44984 .9854 368
30
1.9840 .89298 285 .9825 272 .9811 259 .9797 245 .9782 1.9768 .89232 .9754 219 .9740 206 .9725 193 .9711 180 1.9697 .89167 .9683 153 .9669 140 .9654 127 .9640 114
16
.45010 .50404 036 441
062 088 114
477 514 550
.45140 .50587 166 623 192 660
218 243
696 733
.45269 .50769
295 806 321 843 347 879 373 916 .45399 .50953 1.9626 .89101
Cos
Tan
Cot
63
a
Sin
29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 14 13 12 11
10 9 8 7 6 6 4 3 2 1
/
250
Appendix C
28°
27° /
1
2 3 4
Sin
477 503 554 580 606 632 .45658
12 13 14
684 710 736 762
15
.45787
16 17 18 19
813 839 865 891
20
.45917
21 22 23
942 968
11
24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34
35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42
43 44 45 46 47 48 49 60 51
52 53 54 65 56 57 58 59 60
Cot
Cos
1.9626 .89101 087 .9612 074 .9598 061 .9584 063 048 .9570 099 .51136 1.9556 .89035 021 .9542 173 .9528 .89008 209 .9514 .88995 246 981 .9500 283 .51319 1.9486 .88968 955 .9472 356 942 .9458 393 928 .9444 430 915 .9430 467 .51503 1.9416 .88902 888 .9402 540 875 .9388 577 862 .9375 614 848 .9361 651 .51688 1.9347 .88835 .9333 822 724 .9319 808 761 .9306 795 798 782 .9292 835
.45399 .50953 425 .50989 451 .51026
5 .45529 6 7 8 9 10
Tan
.45994 .46020 .46046 .51872
072 097
909 946
123 .51983 149 .52020 .46175 .52057 201 094 226 131 252 168
278
205
.46304 .52242
330 355 381 407
279 316 353 390
.46433 .52427
458 484 510 536
464 501 538
575
.46561 .52613
587 613 639 664
650 687 724 761
.46690 .52798
716 742 767 793
836 873 910 947
.46819 .52985
844 870 896 921
53022 059 096 134
.46947 .53171
Cos
Cot
1.9278 .88768 .9265 755 .9251 741 .9237 728 .9223 715
1.9210 .9196 .9183 .9169 .9155 1.9142 .9128 .9115 .9101 .9088 1.9074 .9061 .9047 .9034 .9020 1.9007 .8993 .8980 .8967 .8953 1.8940 .8927 .8913 .8900 .8887 1.8873 .8860 .8847 .8834 .8820
'
.88701
688 674 661 647 .88634 620 607 593 580 .88566 553 539
59 58 57 56 66 54 53 52 51 50
49 48 47 46 46 44 43 42 41
40 39 38 37 36 36 34 33 32 31
30 29 28 27
26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19
.88499
16
485 472 458 445
14 13 12
.88431
10
417 404 390 377
9 8 7 6
11
6 4 3 2 1
Tan
Sin
1
973
2 3 4
.46999 .47024
6 6
.47076 .53358 101 395 127 432 153 470
7
8 9
10 11
12 13 14
16 16 17 IS 19
20
Cos
/
050
178
229 255 281 306
37
38 39 40 41 42 43 44 46
46 47 48 49 60 51
52 53 54 65 56 57 58 59
1.8676 .88158 .8663 144 .8650 130 .8637 117 .8624 103
582 620 657 694
.47332 .53732
358 383 409 434
1.8611 .88089 .8598 075 .8585 062 .8572 048 .8559 034
769 807 844 882
.47460 .53920
537 .54032 662 070
36 36
.8755
957 511 .53995
.47588 .54107 614 145 639 183
665 690
254 240
1.8741 .88226 .8728 213 .8715 199 .8702 185 .8689 172
507
486
31 32 33 34
.8768
.47204 .53545
22 23 24
26 26 27 28 29 30
1.8807 .88295 .8794 281 .8781 267
208 246 283 320
21
60
1.8807 .88295
62°
Cot
c
Tan
Sin
Cot
Cos
1.8040 .8028 .8016 .8003 .7991 1.7979 .7966 .7954 .7942 .7930 1.7917 .7905 .7893 .7881 .7868 1.7856 .7844 .7832 .7820 .7808 1.7796 .7783 .7771 .7759 .7747 1.7735 .7723 .7711 .7699 .7687
.87462
60
448 434 420 406
59 58 57 56 56 54 53 52 51 60 49 48 47
1.7675 .7663 .7651 .7639 .7627 1.7615 .7603 .7591 .7579 .7567
.87036 021 .87007 .86993
|
18 17 16
349 336 322 308
Tan
.46947 .53171
60
526 512
.88363
Sin
29 /
220 258
.47716 .54296 741 333 767 371
328
203
.48354 .55241
379 405 430 456
279 317 355 393
.48481 .55431
Cos
Cot
7
60 49 48 47 46 46 44 43 42
10
8 9
.48862 .56003
22 23 24 26 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33
21
1.8291 .87743 729 .8278 715 .8265 .8253 701 .8240 687
20
40
19 18 17 16
41
1.8228 .87673 .8215 659 .8202 645 .8190 631 .8177 617
16
1.8165 .87603 .8152 589 .8140 575 .8127 561 .8115 546 1.8103 .87532 .8090 518 .8078 504 .8065 490 .8053 476 1.S040 .S7462
10
42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50
9
51
8 7 6
52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59
Tan
1
61
c
Sin
14 13 12 11
5
4 3 2 1
60 /
697 736 774
16 16
34 35 36 37 38 39
25 24 23 22
659 684 710
786 888 811 926 837 .55964
35 34
26
.48608 .55621 634 659
.48735 .55812 761 850
1.8482 .87951 .8469 937 .8456 923 .8443 909 .8430 896
798 784 770 756
469 507 545 583
12 13 14
21
33 32 31 30 29 28 27
506 532 557 583
11
39 38 37 36
.8341 .8329 .8316 .8303
.48099 .54862 124 900 150 938 175 .54975 201 .55013 .48226 .55051 252 089 277 127 303 165
53 52 51
20
522 560 597 635
786 824
4 6 6
40
1.8354 .87812
048 073
3
41
.47844 .54484
.47971 .54673 .47997 711 .48022 748
1
2
1.8546 .88020 .8533 .88006 .8520 .87993 .8507 979 .8495 965
409 446
869 895 920 946
.48481 .55431
17 18 19
1.8418 .87882 868 .8405 854 .8392 840 .8379 .8367 826
793 818
|
60 59 68 57 56 65 54
888 913 938 964
041 079 117 156
.48989 .56194 .49014 232
040 065 090
270 309 347
.49116 .56385 424 141 166 462 192 501
217
539
.49242 .56577
268 293 318 344
616 654 693 731
.49369 .56769
394 419 445 470
808 846 885 923
.87391
377 363 349 335 .87321
306 292 278 264 .87250
46 45
235 221 207
42
44 43
193
41
.87178 164 150 136 121 .87107
40
093 079 064 050
978 .86964
949 935 921 906
39 38 37 36 35 34 33 32 31
30 29 28 27 26 26 24 23 22 21
1.7556 .86892 .7544 878 863 .7532 849 .7520 834 .7508 1.7496 .86820 805 .7485 791 .7473 .7461 777 762 .7449 1.7437 .86748 .7426 733 719 .7414 704 .7402 690 .7391
20
580 619 657 696
1.7379 .86675 .7367 661 .7355 646 632 .7344 .7332 617
5 4
.50000 .57735
1.7321 .86603
.49495 .56962 521 .57000
546 571 596
039 078 116
.49622 .57155 647 193
672 232 697 271 723 309 .49748 .57348 773 386 798 425 824 464 849 503 .49874 .57541
899 924 950 .49975
Cos
|
Tan
Cot
60°
Sin
19
18 17 16
16 14 13 12 11
10 9 8 7
6
3
2 1
Appendix C
30° '
Sin
6 1
2
3 4 5 6 7
8 9
10 11
12 13 14
15 IS 17 IS 19
20 21
22 23 24 36 26 27 28 39
30 31 32 33 34 36
36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 46 46 47 48 49 60 51
62 53 54 66 56 57 58 59 60
1
Tan
Cot
.60000 .57735 774 025
050 076
813 S51
101
890
.50126 .57929 151 .57968 176 .5S007 201 046 •227
085
.50252 .58124 277 162
301 327 352
201
240 279
.50377 .58318
403 428 453 47S
357 396 435 474
.50503 .58513
31 Cob
1.7321 .86803 .7309 588 .7297 573 .7286 559 .7274 544
1.7262 .86530 .7251 515 .7239 501 .7228 486 .7216 471
1.7205 .86457 .7193 442 .7182 427 .7170 413 .7159 39S 1.7147 .86384 .7136 369 .7124 354 .7113 340 .7102 325 1.7090 .86310 .7079 295 .7067 281 .7056 266 .7045 251
552 638 553 591 578 631 603 670 .50628 .5S709 1.7033 .86237 748 654 .7022 222 679 7S7 .7011 207 704 826 .6999 192 729 865 .6988 178 .50754 .58905 1.6977 .86163 779 944 .6965 148 804 .58983 .6954 133 829 .59022 .6943 119 854 061 .6932 104 .50879 .59101 1.6920 .86089 140 904 .6909 074 179 929 .689S 059 954 218 .6887 045 .50979 258 .6875 030 .51004 .59297 1.6864 .86015 029 336 .6853 .86000 054 376 .6842 .85985 079 415 .6831 970 454 104 .6820 956 .51129 .59494 1.6808 .85941 154 533 .6797 926 179 573 .6786 911 204 612 !6775 896 229 651 .6764 881 .51254 .59691 1.6753 .85866 279 730 .6742 851 304 770 .6731 836 329 809 .6720 821 354 849 .6709 806 .51379 .59888 1.6698 .85792 404 928 .6687 777 429 .59967 .6676 762 454 .60007 .6665 747 479 046 .6654 732 .51504 .60086 1.6643 .85717
Cos
Cot
Tan 59°
1
Sin
Sin
60
6
59 58 57 56 66 54 53 52
i
51
60 49 48 47 46 46 44 43 42
2 3
4
15
41
40
20 21
22 23
24 26 26 27 28
31
29
30 29 28 27 26 26 24
30 31
32 33 34
35
30 29 28
275 299 324 349
.52621
7 6
5
4 3
2 1
53
54 56 56 57 58 69
320 360 400 440
.52374 .61480
45 46 47 48
8
200 240
.52250 .61280
522 547 572 597
49 50 51 52
50 49 48 47 46 46 44 43 42 41
1.6319 .85264 .6308 249 .6297 234 .6287 218 .6276 203 1.6265 .85188 .6255 173 .6244 157 .6234 142 .6223 127 1.6212 .85112 .6202 096 .6191 081 .6181 066 .6170 051
200 225
.52498
9
066 091
33 32 31
41 42 43 44
11
041
57 56 56 54 53 52 51
35 34
40
10
68
02487 527 568 608 649 62689 730 770 811 852 62892 933 62973 63014 055 63095 136 177 217 258 63299 340 380 421 462 63503 544 584 625 666 63707 748 789 830 871
310 294 279
19
14 13 12
59
62092 53017
60
1.6372 .85340 .6361 325
20
15
1.6643 .85717 .6632 702 .6621 687 .6610 672 .6599 657
.52126 .61080 151 120 175 160
21
18 17 16
Tan
1.6479 .85491 .6469 476 .6458 461 .6447 446 .6436 431 1.6426 .85416 .6415 401 .6404 385 370 .6393 .6383 355
399 423 448 473
23
Sin
Coa
.51877 .60681 902 721 927 761 952 801 .51977 841 .52002 .60881 026 921 051 .60960 076 .61000 101 040
36 37 38 39
22
205 245
Cot
6 .51628 .60284 1.6588 .85642 .6577 627 653 324 6 678 364 .6566 612 7 703 403 .6655 597 8 728 .6545 582 443 9 10 .51753 .60483 1.6534 .85567 778 522 .6523 551 1) 803 562 .6512 536 12 828 .6501 521 602 13 852 642 .6490 506 14 16 17 18 19
39 38 37 36 36 34 33 32
32°
Tan
.51504 .600S6 529 126 554 165
579 604
o
520 561 601 641 .61681 721 761 801 842 .61882
646 922 671 .61962 696 .62003 720 043 .52745 .62083
770 794 819 844
124 164 204
245
.52869 .62285
893 918 943 967
325 366 406 446
.6351 .6340 .6329
1.6160 .6149 .6139 .6128 .6118 1.6107 .6097 .6087 .6076 .6066
40 39
38 37 36
27
26 25 24 23 22 21
20 19 18 17
020
16 15 14
.85005 .84989
13 12
.85035
974
H
.84959
to
943 928 913 897
9
1.6055 .84882 .6045 866 .6034 851 .6024 836 .6014 820
5
8 7 6 4 3
2 1
60 .52992 .62487 1.6003 .84805 r
Cos
2f>,
Tan
Cot
58
c
Sin
/
.53115 140 164 189 214
53238 263 288 312 337 53361 386 411 435 460 53484 609 634 558 583 .53607
632 656 681 705 53730 754 779 804 828
Cot
Cos
1.6003 .84805 789 .5993 .5983 774 .5972 759 .5962 743
1.5952 .5941 .5931 .5921 .5911
84728 712 697
60" 69 r>s
57 66 65 64
681
63 62
666
51
1.5900 .84650 .5890 635 .5880 619 .5869 604 .5859 588
50 49 48
1.5849 84573 .5839 557 .5829 542 526 .5818 .5808 511 1.5798 .84495 .5788 480 .5778 464 .5768 448 .5757 433 1.5747 .84417 402 .5737 .5727 386 .5717 370 :5707 355
45 44 43 42
84339 324 308 292 277
30
1.5697 .5687 .5677 .5667 .5657
47 40
41
40 39
38 37 36 35 34 33 32 31
29 28
27 26
1.5647 .84261 .5637 245 230 .5627 214 .5617 .5607 198
25 24 23 22
1.5597 .84182 167 .5587 151 .5577 .5567 135 .5557 120
20
.54097 .64322 1.5547 .84104 .5537 088 122 363 404 .5527 072 146 446 .5517 057 171 041 487 .5507 195 .54220 .64528 1.5497 84025 569 .5487 84009 244 610 .5477 .83994 269 978 652 .5468 293 693 962 .5458 317 54342 .64734 1.5448 .83946 930 775 .5438 366 817 .5428 915 391 899 415 858 .6418 899 .5408 883 440 .83867 54464 .64941 1.5399
15
.53853 .63912
953 877 902 .63994 926 .64035 076 951 .53975 .64117 158 .54000 199 024
049 073
Cos
240 281
Cot
Tan 57°
Sin
21 19 18 17
16 14 13 12
11
10 9
8 7 6
5 4 3 2 1
Appendix C
252
34°
33° I
6 i
2 3
4 5
6 7
8 9 10 11
12 13
14 15 16 17 18 19
20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29
30 31 32
33 34 35 36 37 38
39 40 41
42 43 44 46 46 47 48 49 60 51 52 53 54 55
56 57 58 59 60
Sin
Tan
.54464 .64941 488 .64982 513 .65024
537 561
065 106
.54586 .65148 610 189 635 231
659 683
272 314
.54708 .65355
732 756 781
805
397 438 480 521
.54829 .65563
854 878 902 927
604 646 688 729
.54951 .65771
975 .54999 .55024
048
813 854 896 938
.55072 .65980
097 121 145 169 .55194
218 242 266 291 .55315
339 363 388 412 .55436
460 484 509 533
66021 063 105 147 66189 230 272 314 356 66398 440 482 524 566 66608 650 692 734 776
.55557 .66818 581 860
605 902 630 944 654 .66986 .55678 .67028 702 071 726 113 750 155 775 197 .55799 .67239
Cot
Cos
1.5399 .83867 851 .5389 835 .5379 819 .5369 .5359 804
1.5350 .83788 .5340 772 .5330 756 .5320 740 .5311 724 1.5301 .83708 .5291 .5282 .5272 .5262
692 676 660 645
1.5253 .83629 .5243 613 .5233 597 .5224 581 .5214 565
1.5204 .5195 .5185 .5175 .5166 1.5156 .5147 .5137 .5127 .5118 1.5108 .6099 .5089 .5080 .5070 1.5061 .5051 .5042 .5032 .5023 1.5013 .5004 .4994 .4985 .4975 1.4966 .4957 .4947 .4938 .4928 1.4919 .4910 .4900
60 59
i
2 3
51
60 49
48 47
46 45 44 43 42 41
40
533 517 501 485
39 38 37 36 36 34 33 32 31
453 437 421
405 .83389 373
356 340 324 .83308
292 276 260 244
30 29 28 27 26 26 24 23 22 21
.83228
20
212 195
19 18
179 163 .83147
17
131
115
098 082
16
15 14 13 12 11
.83066
10
050 034 017
8
9
.4891 .4882 .83001
7 6
282 324 366 409
1.4872 .82985 .4863 969 .4854 953 .4844 936 .4835 920
6 4
.55919 .67451
1.4826 .82904
823 847 871 895
Cos
Cot
Tan 56°
Sin
Cos Sin Tan Cot 6 .55919 .67451 1.4826 .82904
58 67 56 55 54 53 52
.83549
.83469
35° /
f
3
2 1
t
4 6 6
7
943 968 .55992 .56016
493 536 578 620
.56040 .67663
064 088
705 748 790 832
.4816 .4807 .4798 .4788
887 871 855 839
1.4779 .82822 .4770 806 .4761 790
.4751 773 112 .4742 757 136 10 .56160 .67875 1.4733 .82741 917 .4724 724 184 11 .4715 708 12 208 .67960 .4705 692 232 .68002 13 045 .4696 675 256 14 16 .56280 .68088 1.4687 .82659 .4678 130 643 16 305 173 .4669 626 17 329 215 .4659 610 18 353 258 .4650 593 19 377 20 .56401 .68301 1.4641 .82577 343 .4632 561 21 425 386 .4623 544 22 449 429 .4614 528 23 473 .4605 471 511 24 497 26 .56521 .68514 1.4596 .82495 .4586 557 478 26 545 .4577 600 462 27 569 .4568 642 446 28 593 .4559 429 685 29 617 30 .56641 .68728 1.4550 .82413 .4541 771 396 31 665 .4532 814 380 32 689 .4523 857 363 33 713 .4514 347 900 34 736 36 .56760 .68942 1.4505 .82330 .68985 .4496 314 36 784 .4487 297 37 808 .69028 .4478 281 071 38 832 .4469 114 264 39 856 40 .56880 .69157 1.4460 .82248 .4451 231 200 41 904 .4442 214 243 42 928 198 286 .4433 43 952 329 .4424 181 44 .56976 46 .57000 .69372 1.4415 .82165 416 .4406 148 024 46 .4397 132 459 47 047 502 .4388 115 48 071 545 .4379 098 49 095 50 .57119 .69588 1.4370 .82082 631 .4361 065 51 143 048 675 .4352 52 167 718 .4344 032 53 191 .82015 761 .4335 54 215 66 .57238 .69804 1.4326 .81999 .4317 982 847 56 262 965 891 .4308 57 286 .4299 949 934 58 310 .4290 932 59 334 .69977 60 .57358 .70021 1.4281 .81915
8 9
Cos
Tan
Cot
55
a
Sin
60 59 58 57
56 65 54 53 52 51 50 49 48 47
46 46 44 43 42
1
2 3 4
6 6 7
8 9
10 11 12 13 14
15
Sin
Tan
Cot
.57358 .70021 381 064 405 107 429 151 453 194 .57477 .70238 501 281
524 548 572
325 368 412
.57596 .70455
619 643 667 691
499 542 586 629
.57715 .70673
738 762 786 810
717 760 804 848
41
16 17 18 19
40
20
.57833 .70891
39 38 37 36 36 34 33 32
21
857 935 881 .70979 904 .71023 928 066
31
30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22
22 23
24 25 26 27 28 29
047 285 30 .58070 .71329 094 31 373 32 118 417 33 34
35 36
21
37 38 39
20
40
19 18 17 16
41
15 14 13 12 11
10 9 8
7 6 5
4 3 2 1
/
.57952 .71110 976 154 .57999 198 .58023 242
42 43 44 46 46 47 48 49 50 51
52 53 54 65 56 57 58 59 60
141 461 505 165 .58189 .71549
212 236 260 283
593 637 681 725
.58307 .71769
330 354 378
813 857 901 946
401 .58425 .71990 449 .72034
472 496 519
078
567 590 614 637
255 299 344 388
122 167 .58543 .72211
.58661 .72432
684 708 731 755
477 521 565
610
.58779 .72654
Cos
Cot
Cos
1.4281 .81915 .4273 899 .4264 882 .4255 865 .4246 848
1.4237 .81832 .4229 815 798 .4220 .4211 .4202
782 765
1.4193 .81748 .4185 731 714 .4176 .4167 698 .4158 681 1.4150 .81664 .4141 647 .4132 631 .4124 614 597 .4115 1.4106 .81580 .4097 563 .4089 546 .4080 530 .4071 513 1.4063 .81496 479 .4054 462 .4045 445 .4037 .4028 428 1.4019 .81412 395 .4011 378 .4002 .3994 361 .3985 344 1.3976 .81327 .3968 310 .3959 293 276 .3951 259 .3942 1.3934 .81242 225 .3925 .3916 208 .3908 191 .3899 174 1.3891 .81157 140 .3882 123 .3874 106 .3865 089 .3857 1.3848 .81072 055 .3840 038 .3831 021 .3823 .3814 .81004 1.3806 .80987 .3798 970 .3789 953 .3781 936 .3772 919 1.3764 .80902
Tan
54°
Sin
60 59 58 57 56 66 54 53 52 51
60 49 48 47 46 45 44 43 42 41
40 39 38 37 36 35 34 33 32 31
30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21
20 19 18 17 16
15 14 13 12 11
10 9
8 7 6
6 4 3
2 1
/
Appends
37°
36'
6 i *
3 4
5 6
7 s 9 10 11
12 13 14
15 16 17 18 19
20 21
22 33 34 26 26 27 2S 29 90 31
32 33 34 35
36 37 38 39 40 41
42 43 44 46 46 47 48 49 60 51
52 53 54 66 56 57 58 59 60
Sin
Tan
.58779
79654 699 743 788 B39 72877
bu 8M 849 879 5S896 aao 943
Cot
921
72906
987 .73010 .58990 055 .59014 .73100 037 144 061 189 234 084 108 278 .59131 .73323 154 368 178 413 201 457 225 502 .5924S .73547 272 592 295 637 318 681
342
726
.59365 .73771
389 412 436 459
816 861
906 951
.594S2 .73996 506 .74041
529 552 576
086
131 176 .59599 .74221
622 646 669 693
267 312 357 402
.59716 .74447
739 763 786 809
492 538 583 628
.59832 .74674
856 879 902 926
719 764 810 855
.59949 .74900
972
946
.59995 .74991 .60019 .75037
042
082
.60065 .75128 089 173 112 219 135 264 158 310 .60182 .75355
Cos
Cot
Cos
1.3764 .80902 .375,''
.3747 .3739 .3730
1.3722 .3713 .3705 .3697 .36S8
1.3680 .3072 .3663 .3655 .3647
'
888 867 850 833 .80816 799 782 765 748 .80730 713 696 679 662
1.363S .80644 .3630 627 .3622 610 .3613 593 .3605 576
60 59 58 57 56 56 54 53 52 51
60 49 48 47 46 46 44 43 42
6 i
2 3 4
6 6 7
8 9
10
1.3514 .80386 .3506 368 .3498 351 .3490 334 .3481 316
30 29 28 27 26 26 24 23 22
21
22 23
24 26 26 27 28 29
30 31
21
32 33 34 36 36 37 38 39
1.3432 .80212 .3424 195 .3416 178 .3408 160 .3400 143 1.3392 .80125 .3384 108 .3375 091 .3367 073 .3359 056
20
40
19 18 17 16
41
1.3351 .80038 .3343 021 .3335 .80003 .3327 .79986 .3319 968
10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3
1.3311 .79951 .3303 934 .3295 916 .3287 899 .3278 881
13 12 11
2 1
1.3270 .79864
Tan 53°
Sin
/
251 274 .60298 .75584 321 629 344 675 367 721 767 390 .60414 .75812
553 088 576 134 699 180 622 226 .60645 .76272 668 318 691 364 714 410
20
14
447 492 538
.60529 .76042
41
16
228
14
40
1.3473 .80299 .3465 282 .3457 264 .3449 247 .3440 230
Cot
15
12 13
1.3597 .80558 .3588 541 .3580 524 .3572 507 .3564 489 1.3555 .80472 .3547 455 .3539 438 .3531 420 .3522 403
31
Tan
437 858 460 904 483 950 506 .75996
11
16 17 18 19
39 38 37 36 35 34 33 32
Sin
.60182 .75355 205 401
42 43 44 46 46 47 48 49 60 51 52 53 54
56 56 57 58 59 60
738
456
.60761 .76502
784 807 830 853
548 594 640 686
.60876 .76733
899 922 945 968
779 825 871 918
.60991 .76964 .61015 .77010
038 061 084
057
103 149 .61107 .77196 130 242 153 289 176 335 199 382 .61222 .77428
245 268
475
291
568 615
314
521
.61337 .77661
360 383 406 429
708 754 801
848
.61451 .77895
474 941 497 .77988 520 .78035 543 082 .61566 .78129
Cos
38° '
Cos
1.3270 .79864 .3262 846 .3254 829 .3246 811 .3238 793
1.3230 .79776 .3222 758 .3214 741 .3206 723 .3198 706 1.3190 .79688 .3182 671 .3175 653 .3167 635 .3159 618 1.3151 .79600 .3143 583 .3135 565 .3127 547 .3119 530 1.3111 .79512 .3103 494 .3095 477 .3087 459 .3079 441 1.3072 .79424 .3064 406 .3056 388 .3048 371 .3040 353
60 59 58 57 56 66 54 53 52
Sin Tan Cot Cos 6 .61566 .78129 1.2799 .78801 i
2
3 4
704 410 .2753 726 457 .2740 749 504 .2738 772 551 .2731 .61795 .78598 1.2723 818 645 .2715 841 692 .2708 864 739 .2700 887 786 .2693 .61909 .78834 1.2685 932 881 .2677 955 928 .2670 .61978 .78975 .2662 .62001 .79022 .2655 .62024 .79070 1.2647 046 117 .2640 069 164 .2632 092 212 .2624 115 259 .2617 .62138 .79306 1.2609 160 354 .2602 183 401 .2594 206 449 .2587 229 496 .2579
8 9
10
34 33 32 31
11 12 13
14
16 16 17 18 19
20 21
22 23 24 26 26 27 28 29 30
30
1.2993 .79247 .2985 229 .2977 211 .2970 193 .2962 176
26 24 23 22 21
35 36
1.2954 .79158 .2946 140 .2938 122 .2931 105 .2923 087
20
40
19 18 17 16
41
1.2915 .2907 .2900 .2892 .2884 1.2876 .2869 .2861 .2853 .2846 1.2838 .2830 .2822 .2815 .2807 1.2799
.79069 051
16
Tan
Sin
52°
29 28 27
26
31
32 33 34
37 38 39
.62251 .79544
274 297 320 342
591 639
686 734
.62365 .79781
388 411 433
829 877 924
456 .79972 .62479 .80020
502 524 547 570
067 115
615 638 660 683
306 354 402 450
.78980
10
42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 60
962 944 926 908
9
51
8
52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59
.62819 .80738
60
.62932 .80978
033 .79016 .78998
.78891
873 855 837 819
14 13 12 11
7
6 6
4 3 2 1
.78801 '
.2792 .2784 .2770 .2709
.61681 .78363
7
60 49 48 47 46 46 44 43 42
40 39 38 37 36 35
175
222 209 316
5
51
41
589 612 635 658
6
1.3032 .79335 .3024 318 .3017 300 .3009 282 .3001 264
Cot
2b/
(
163 211 .62592 .80258
.62706 .80498
728 751 774 796 842 864 887 909
Cos
546 594 642 690 786 834 882 930 Cot
783 765 747 729
1.2761 .78711
694 676 658 640
60 59 58 57 56 56 54 53 52 51
604 586 568 550
60 49 48 47 46
.78532
46
514 496 478 460
44 43 42
.78442
40
424 405 387 369
39 38 37 36
.78351
36
333 315 297 279
34 33 32
1.2572 .78261 243 .2564 225 .2557 206 .2549 188 .2542 1.2534 .78170 152 .2527 134 .2519 116 .2512 098 .2504
30
1.2497 .78079 061 .2489 043 .2482 025 .2475 .2467 .78007
20
1.2460 .77988 970 .2452 952 .2445 934 .2437 .2430 916 1.2423 .77897 .2415 879 861 .2408
15
843 824
7 6
.2401 .2393
.78622
1.2386 .77806 788 .2378 .2371 769 751 .2364 .2356 733 1.2349 .77715
Tan 51°
Sin
41
31
29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 19 18 17 16 14 13 12 11
10 9 8
5
4 3 2 1
/
254
Appendix C
40°
39° Sin
o i
2 3
4 5 6
7
8 9
10
n
12 13
14 15 16 17 18 19
20 21
22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39
40 41
42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51
52 53 54 56 56 57 58 59 60
Tan
Cot
Cos
Sin
Tan
.62932 .80378 955 .81027 .62977 075 123 .63000 171 022
1.2349 .77715 696 .2342 678 .2334 .2327 660 .2320 641
.64279 .83910 301 .83960 323 .84009
.63045 .81220
1.2312 .77623 .2305 605 .2298 586 .2290 568 .2283 550
.64390 .84158
068 090
268 316 364 413
113 135 .63158 .81461 1.2276 .77531 510 .2268 513 180 558 203 .2261 494 606 225 .2254 476 .2247 248 655 458 .63271 .81703 1.2239 .77439 293 752 .2232 421 316 800 .2225 402 338 849 .2218 384 898 .2210 361 366 .63383 .81946 1.2203 .77347 406 .81995 .2196 329 428 .82044 .2189 310 092 451 .2181 292 141 473 .2174 273 63496 .82190 1.2167 .77255
238 .2160 236 287 .2153 218 563 336 .2145 199 385 585 .2138 181 .63608 82434 1.2131 .77162 483 630 .2124 144 518 540
531 653 580 675 629 698 63720 82678 727 742 776 765 825 787 874 810 .63832 82923 854 82972 877 83022 899 071 120 922 63944 83169 966 218 .63989 268 .64011 317 033 366 .64056 83415 078 465 514 too 123 564 145 613 .64167 83662 712 190 212 761 234 811 256 860 64279 83910
Cos
Cot
.2117 .2109 .2102
1.2095 .2088 .2081 .2074 .2066
1.2059 .2052 .2045 .2038 .2031
1.2024 .2017 .2009 .2002 .1995 1.1988 .1981 .1974 .1967 .1960
1.1953 .1946 .1939 .1932 .1925
125 107
088 77070 051 033 77014 76996 76977 959 940 921 903 76884 866 847 828 810 76791 772 754 735 717 76698 679
1.1918
661 642 623 76604
Tan
Sin
50°
346 368
059 108
41 Cot
Cos
1.1918 .76604 .1910 586 .1903 567 548 .1896 .1889 530 1.1882 .76511 492 .1875 .1868 473
412 208 258 435 307 .1861 455 457 .1854 436 479 357 64501 .84407 1.1847 .76417 457 398 524 .1840 546 507 .1833 380 556 .1826 361 568 342 590 606 .1819 64612 .84656 1.1812 .76323 635 304 706 .1806 657 756 .1799 286 679 806 .1792 267 .1785 248 701 856 .64723 .84906 746 .84956 768 .85006
790 812
057 107
.64834 .85157
856 878
207 257 308 358
901 923 .64945 .85408
1
2 3
4 5 6 7
8 9 10 11
12 13 14
192 173 154 1.1743 .76135 .1736 116
22 23
1.1708 .76041
.1702 458 022 .64989 509 .1695 .76003 .65011 559 .1688 .75984 033 609 .1681 965 .65055 85660 1.1674 .75946 .1667 077 710 927 100 761 .1660 908 122 811 .1653 889 144 862 .1647 870 .65166 85912 1.1640 .75851 188 85963 .1633 832 .1626 210 86014 813 .1619 232 064 794 254 .1612 775 115 .65276 86166 1.1606 .75756 298 216 .1599 738 320 267 .1592 719 .1585 700 342 318 364 368 .1578 680 .65386 86419 1.1571 .75661 .1565 642 408 470 .1558 623 430 521 .1551 452 572 604 474 623 .1544 585 .65496 86674 1.1538 .75566 547 725 .1531 518 776 .1524 528 540 827 .1517 509 562 878 .1510 490 584 65606 86929 1.1504 75471
Cot
49°
Tan
Sin
492 543 595 646
.65978 .66000
21
097 078 059
.65825 .87441
16 17 18 19
20
.1729 .1722 .1715
672 082 694 133 .65716 .87184 738 236 759 287 781 338 803 389
847 869 891 913
24
25 26 27 28 29 30 31
32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41
42 43 44 45 46 47
48 49 60 51
956
022
749 801 852 904
.66044 .87955 066 .88007
088 109
059 110 162
131 .66153 .88214 175 265 197 317
218 240
369 421
.66262 .88473
284 306 327 349
524 576 628 680
.66371 .88732
393 414 436 458
784 836 888 940
.66480 .88992 501 .89045 523 097 545 149 566 201 .66588 .89253
610 632 653 675
306 358 410 463
.66697 .89515
718 740 762 783
52 53 54 55 56 57 58 69
.66805
60
.66913
827 848 870 891
Cos
c
Tan
.65935 .87698
210
.1771 .1764 .1757 .1750
Sin
.65606 .86929 628 .86980 650 .87031
15
1.1778 .76229
967
Cos
/
Cot
Cos
1.1504 .1497 .1490 .1483 .1477 1.1470 .1463 .1456 .1450 .1443 1.1436 .1430 .1423 .1416 .1410 1.1403 .1396 .1389 .1383 .1376 1.1369 .1363 .1356 .1349 .1343 1.1336 .1329 .1323 .1316 .1310
.75471
452 433 414 395 .75375
356 337 318 299 .75280 261 241
222 203 .75184 165 146 126 107
44 43 42 41
39 38 37 36 35 34 33 32
.75011
.74992
973 953 934 915
1
60 49 48 47 46 45
40
1.1270 .74799 .1263 780 760 .1257 .1250 741 .1243 722 1.1237 .74703 .1230 683 .1224 664 .1217 644 625 .1211 1.1204 .74606 .1197 586 567 .1191 .1184 548 528 .1178 1.1171 .74509 .1165 489 .1158 470 .1152 451 431 .1145
Tan
51
069 050 030
1.1303 .74896 .1296 876 .1290 857 .1283 838 .1276 818
48°
59
58 57 56 65 54 53 52
.75088
567 620 672 725 89777 1.1139 .74412 .1132 392 830 .1126 373 883 935 .1119 353 89988 .1113 334 90040 1.1106 .74314 Cot
60
Sin
31
30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16
15 14 13 12 11
10 9 8 7
6 5
4 3 2 1
'
Appendix
42°
6 i
Sin
Tan
.66913 085
90040 093
Cot
956
3 4
5
6 7 s
9 10 11
12 13
M
15 16 17 IS 19
20 81 22
23 24 25 26 27 28 29
30 31
32 33
34 35 36 37 38
39 40 41
42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 60 51
52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60
146 199 .66999 SSI .67021 .90304 043 357
064 0S6
410
463 107 516 .67129 .90569 151 SSI 172 674 727 194 215 781 .67337 .90834 258 B87 940 380 301 .90993 323 .91046 .67344 .91099 153 366 206 387
409 430
259 313
.67452 .91366
473
495 516 538
419 473 526 580
.67559 .91633 6>7 580 602 740 794 623
645
847
.67666 .91901 688 .91955 709 .92008
730
062
752 116 .67773 .92170
795 816 837 859
224 277 331 385
.67SS0 .92439 901 493
923 944 S65
547 601 655
.67987 .92709 .68008 763
029 051 072
817 872 926
Cos
1.1106 .74S14 .1100 398 276 .1093 .1087 356 .1080 337 1.1074 .74217 19S .1067 17S .1061 159 .1054 139 .1048 1.1041 .74120 100 .1035 .1028 OSO .1022 061 041 .1016
1.1009 74022 .1003 .74002 .0990 .73983 .0990 963 .0983 944 1.0977 .73924 .0971 .0964 .0958 .0951
904 885 865 846
1.0945 .0939 .0932 .0926 .0919 1.0913 .0907 .0900 .0S94 .0888 1.0881 .0S75 .0869 .0862 .0856 1.0850 .0843 .0837 .0831 .0824 1.0818 .0812 .0805 .0799 .0793
.73826
806 7>7
767 747 .73728
708 688 669 649 .73629
610 590 570 551
.68200
Cos
Cot
59
1
2 3
51
9 10
742 .68412 .93797
11 12 13
434 852 455 906 476 .93961 497 .94016
50 49 48 47 46 45 44
43 42 41
40 39 38 37 36 35 34 33 32 31 30 29
28 27
26 25 24 23 22 21
20
472 452
19 18 17 16
.73432
16
413 393 373 353
14 13 12 11
1.0786 .73333 .0780 314 .0774 294 .0768 274 .0761 254
10 9 8
Tan 47°
Sin
Tan
.68200 .93252 22 306 242 360 264 415
58 57 56 55 54 53 52
511 491
1.0755 .73234 .0749 215 .0742 088 195 .0736 143 175 197 .0730 155 .93252 1.0724 .73135
Sin
60
.73531
.68093 .92980 115 .93034
136 157 179
44°
43° '
7
6 5
4 3 2 1
'
4 6 6 7
8
14
15 16 17 18 19
2Jv3
469
.68306 .93524
327 349 370 391
578 633 688
.68518 .94071 539 125 561 180
582 603
235 290
Cot
.07
1
.0705 .0699
1.0661 .72937 917 .0655 .0649 897 .0643 877 .0637 857
1.0630 .72837 817 .0624 .0618 797 .0612 777 757 .0606 1.0599 .72737 .0593 717 .0587 697
21
645 400 666 455 688 510 .0581 .0575 709 565 .68730 .94620 1.0569 751 676 .0562 77'? 731 .0550 793 786 .0550 841 814 .0544 .68835 .94896 1.0538 857 .94952 .0532 878 .95007 .0526 899 062 .0519 920 118 .0513 .68941 .95173 1.0507 962 229 .0501 .68983 284 .0495 .69004 340 .0489 025 395 .0483 .69046 .95451 1.0477 067 .0470 506 088 562 .0464 109 618 .0458 673 .0452 130 .69151 .95729 1.0446 172 785 .0440 .0434 193 841 .042S 214 897 235 .95952 .0422 .69256 .96008 1.0416 277 064 .0410 298 120 .0404 319 176 .0398 340 232 .0392 .69361 .96288 1.0385 344 382 .0379 .0373 403 400 424 457 .0367 445 513 .0361 .69466 .96569 1.0355
31
32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43
44 45 46 47 48 49 60 51
52 53 54
55 56 57 58 59 60
Cos
Cot
096 076 056
1.0692 .73036 .0686 .73016 .0680 .72996 .0674 976 .0668 957
.68624 .94345
Tan 46°
'
Cos
1.0724 .73135 .0717 116
20 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30
('
677 657 .72637
617 597 577 557 .72537
517 497 477 457 .72437
417 397 377 357
60 59 58 57 56 66 54 53 52 51
60 49 48 47 46 46 44 43 42
Sin
6 6 7 8 9
.69570 .96850 591 907 612 .96963 633 .97020
1.0325 .71833 .0319 813 792 .0313 .0307 772
752
51
10
.69675 .97133 696 189
1.0295 .71732 .0289 711 .0283 691 .0277 671 .0271 650
50 49 48 47 46 45 44 43 42
4
11
12 13 14
15
41
16 17 18 19
40
20
39 38 37 36 35 34 33 32
21
22 23
24
654
717 737 758
625 681
076
246 302 359
.69779 .97416
800 821 842 862
472 529 586 643
.69883 .97700
904 925 946 966
756 813 870 927
.69987 .97984 .70008 .98041
30 29
30
.70091 .98270
28
32 33 34 36 36
27
26 25
31
317 297 277 257
19 18 17 16
.72236
15
45
216
14 13 12 11
46 47 48 49 60
10 9
095 075 055
8
.72035 .72015 .71995
6 4 3 2
7 6
1
.71934 Sin
4S7 508 529 549
25 26 27 28 29
31
'
Cos
58 57 56 65 54 53 52
3
.72337
974 954
Cot
738 794
i
2
24 23 22 21 20
196 176 156 .72136 116
Tan
.69466 .90569
1.0355 .719:it 91 .0349 .0343 B94 .0337 .0331 853
6
37
38 39 40 41
42 43 44
51 52 53 54
65 56 57 58 59 60
029 049 070
098 155 213
1
.0301
1.0265 .71630 .0259 610 .0253 590 .0247 569 .0241 549 1.0235 .71529 .0230 508 .0224 488 .0218 468 .0212 447 1.0206 .71427 .0200 407 .0194 386 .0188 366 .0182 345
1.0176 .71325 112 327 .0170 305 132 384 .0164 284 153 441 .0158 264 174 499 .0152 243 .70195 .98556 1.0147 .71223 215 613 .0141 203 671 .0135 236 182 .0129 257 728 162 277 .0123 141 786 .70298 .98843 1.0117 .71121 .0111 319 901 100 .0105 339 .98958 080 360 .99016 .0099 059 381 073 .0094 039 .70401 .99131 1.0088 .71019 422 189 .0082 .70998 247 .0076 978 443 957 463 304 .0070 484 362 .0064 937 .99420 .70916 .70505 1.0058 525 478 .0052 896 546 536 .0047 875 567 .0041 855 594
587
652
.70608 .99710
628 768 649 826 670 884 690 .99942 .70711 1.0000
Cos
.0035 834 1.0029 .70813 .0023 793 772 .0017 752 .0012 731 .0006 1.0000 .70711
Tan
Cot
45°
Sin
60 59
41
40 39 38 37 36 36 34 33 32 31
30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23
22 21
20 19 18 17 16
15 14 13 12 11
10 9
8 7 6 6
4 3 2 1
'
INDEX
A hand (see St nation bands) Acceleration of body parts. 64 I7t>
Acetylcholine esterase (AChase), 171 Action current. 106 Action potential (se* Potential, action) Act in -filaments
(see
also
104
Analysis of segmental velocities effective rotation of spine when pelvis in motion, 70 overhand throw, 66, 68, 69, 72, 73
68
>:iing to illustrate. t^4. 67,
Acetylcholine (ACh), 171, action of. 171
with gravity board and three BCBles,
Negative. IS2 Positive. 167
Sliding
displacement of hand and forearm, 66 angular displacement of trunk due to
theory). 134. 136. 153. 154. 155. 156 in
is
angular
filament
--viation with tropomyosin laxed muscle. 143
Centripetal acceleration, 57
re-
pelvic
and spinal
rotation, 66, 70, 71
calculations of linear velocities resulting from angular displacements, 68 for determining amount of
method
Circuits,
neural,
combination
gamma
188,
L90 191,
L93
repeating,
191
189,
of, 191
loop, 203
convergent,
divergent,
Golgi tendon organ circuits, 208-209 reverberating, 175, 191 spindle afferent, 200, 203 two-neuron circuit, 190-191, Circular motion angular acceleration, 56-57
in contraction. 142
protraction at sternoclavicular joint,
centripetal acceleration, 57
in myofibril. 132
68. 72
radial acceleration, 57
subunits oi (F-aetin. G-actin), 132, 133 Activation. oi muscle. 140. 144, 158 Active state. 13S. 149. 150. 155. 159, 187 decay in fast vs. slow muscle fibers, 159 in activation oi muscle. 135 in development of overt tension. 149, 150 in muscle twitch. 147-148 in post-tetanic potentiation. 150 in tetanic contraction. 150 study by quick release, 148 study by quick stretch. 148 Actomyosin. 132. 135. 136, 140. 143. 159
Adaptation (accommodation). 149 decline of generator potential in sensory neurons, 181-182
in,
182
131.
134,
condensation of. to produce ATP, 138 in muscle metabolism. 136-138 in oxygen debt. 138 in regulation of muscle metabolism, 139
Adenosine triphosphate (ATP).
131,
Co-contraction, 30, 200, 202
Archimedes principle, 110 ATP (see Adenosine triphosphate) ATPase (see also Adenosine triphosphate, 135, 155, 159
correlation with speed of contraction, 155 in contraction, 144
slow muscle fibers, 158-159 in hydrolysis of ATP, 135-136 in relaxation, 143, 144 Available energy, 138, 151 in fast vs.
segment, 162, 170, 172, 174, 176
muscle fibers. 131 muscle metabolism. 136-138 oxygen debt, 138 regulation of muscle metabolism, 139
in relaxation. 143, 144 production of by condensation of ADP, 138 from food compounds, 136, 138
from Krebs cycle and ETS, 137
Backswing Golgi tendon organ function spindle function
in,
in,
224
224, 226
muscle), 137 in size of, 32 Bridges (cross-bridges) 133, 148, 150, 153, 154, 155, 156, 157 action of, in contraction, 142-143 heavy meromysin and, 132, 142 in development of tension, 148 in myofibrils, 131-132 in post-tetanic potentiation, 150 in tetanic contraction, 150 relation to economy of energy, 156 relation to increased muscle strength, 157 relation to shortening speed, 155 Buoyancy, 110 centers of, 110
synapse, 175
location
velocity
201
167
of,
Connective
tissues, in muscle, 128, 129
Contractile components, 147, 148, 150, 151 Contractile elements (see also Contractile components), 128, 129
Contraction chemistry
of,
of,
of velocity of contraction on,
154-159 nature of, 134-144 contraction time, 150 excitation-contraction
coupling,
139-
140 excitation of muscle, 134
filament theory
slicing
of,
142-143
relaxation, 143-144
speed of (see also Contraction, velocity of),
154-155,
187
as a scalar quantity, 155
chemical reaction rates as factors
in,
155
isometric contraction, 155
in
in relation to load, 155
intrinsic shortening speed, 155, 159 of,
isotonic,
by the segmental method, 105-106 fractions of body, using tables
in,
of, in
saltatory, 166
150-152
eccentric,
Center of gravity, 103
Adenosine diphosphate)
Afterpotential(s). 167. 187
polarity
166
166-168
151-152, 153, 156, 159, 227 isometric, 151, 152, 153, 155, 156, 204
Cation(s), 162
Adjustment to load; 201. 203, 226 Electromyograms of, 228, 229
tsee
of,
types
rephosphorylation of by CP, 137
ADP
in,
characteristics
effect
in glycolysis. 137
gamma neurons in, 203 primary afferents of spindle
action) 162, 163, 164, 166
action current
134-139 147-159 effect of muscle length on, 151-154 effect of stimulus on, 147-151
Bony prominences, change
high energy bands in. 134 hydrolysis of. by ATPase, 135-136 in contraction, 134-135, 144 in excitation. 144
Conditioned response(s), 204, 219 in sports, 226 Conduction, nerve (see also Potential,
magnitude
Biological oxidation (see also Metabolism, 139,
140. 141 as energy source. 134-137
in
Citric acid cycle, 137
Anion(s), 162
initial
and distance, 56
velocity
Circulation in muscle, 129
hillock, 161, 162, 171
135. 136, 137. 139. 141
in
the
Axon(s)
of receptor cells. 182
Adenosine diphosphate (ADP).
in
throw,
Axolemma, 162
of joint receptors. 209
in
tangential acceleration, 57-58
68-72 determining wrist extension, amount of, 70-71 Anatomical position, 6, 6 Angular momentum, 54
underhand
in overlap. 142. 143
Swearingen method, 105 with gravity board and single 103-104
257
of,
105
scale,
151,
152,
153,
155,
156,
204
velocity of (see also Contraction, speed of), 138, 155-158, 159, 224 as a vector quantity, 155 in eccentric, isometric and
contraction, 156
• i
258
Index Endurance,
continued continued influence of load upon, 156
Contraction
velocity of
influence upon development of force,
156 in relation to
economy
of
movement,
156
maximal, 156 156-157 optimal, Q 10 of, 157 Contraction strength increased by impulses from joint receptors, 224 Contracture, 138, 149 Coordination of movement, controlled by proprioceptive feedback. 237 Creatine phosphate (CP), 131, 137-138, 141 Critical level, 171, 172, 173, 175, 176
Cross-bridges (see Bridges) Cutaneous feedback, in timing and transitions, 225
Cutaneous
proprioceptors,
210-212,
225,
importance to spotter in gymnastics, 225 Cutaneous stimuli from contact with environment, 225 from contact with equipment used, 225 from contact with other body parts, 225 Cytochromes, 137
Energy cost
Fiber(s)
effect of
muscle length
in negative vs.
relation to contractile velocity,
in
effects
neurons, 198 index, 196, 200
components,
147,
148,
149,
150,
155, 159
in isotonic contraction, 156 in production of overt tension, 149, 150 in relaxation, in tension in
143, 144
development. 135
work production, 129
Equilibrating forces, 98-101 determination of force acting on distal end of humerus, 98, 100 determination of rotatory and secondary components biceps, 100 determination of TMF, 98, 100 Equilibrium, 107-111
Electromyograms (EMG), 226, 228, 229 motor unit potentials, 185, 186 of adjustment to load, 201, 228, 229 Electromyography of reciprocal inhibition, 30 Electron transport system (ETS) ATP production in, 137, 141 electron cascade, 138
enzymes processes
EMG
of, in,
137 137
Electromyogram) Endoplasmic reticulum, 161 (see
of neuron, 161
sarcoplasmic reticulum compared with, 133
all-or-none response, 147, 185
arrangement in muscles, 128, 154 chemical composition of, 130-131 extrafusal,
in
on, 111
space orientation, 111
length of in stretched
111
Equilibrium reflexes (see also Labyrinthine proprioceptors), 214, 218
Excitation-contraction
in,
muscle.
Force(s)
88 as effort, 39 resistance,
as
139-140
139-142
movement,
223, 224, 225
39
components, positive and negative, 97 composition of, 88 graphical, by parallelogram, 91 graphical, by polygon, 92 concurrent, 87, 88, 89, 91 graphical composition, 91-92
composition, by parallelograms, 91-92 graphical composition, by polygons, 92 graphical composition of hip abductors, 91-92 mathematical composition, solution, 95-96, 97-98 graphical
209, 223, 224, 225,
227, 231
by disinhibition, 173 presynaptic, 174 synaptic, 171-172 (see Flavin
contracted
acting on the bodv, external and internal.
Excitation time, 149 Exteroceptors, 180, 211 172,
vs.
mean lengths in frog sarcomere, 154 Flavin adenine dinucleotide (FAD), 137
as objective in
169 coupling,
calcium in, 139-140 sarcoplasmic reticulum sodium in, 140 T system in, 140
159
142-143
110-111
coupling,
131-132,
132
unstable, 108
168,
muscle,
molecular subunits of, 132 myosin (see also Myosin), 132, 142, 154 overlap of, in contraction (see also sliding filament theory), 135, 142, 143, 153, 154 theory of sliding, 142-143
Equilibrium in water, 110-111 dynamic. 111 proprioceptive system, dependency
FAD
207
(phasic, white),
actin (see also Actin), 132, 142, 154 arrangement in the myofibril, 131-132 bonding between (see also Bridges),
under dynamic conditions, 109-110 under static conditions, 107-108
Facilitation,
196,
157-159 response to repetitive stimulation, 149-151 response to single pulse, 147-149 slow (tonic, red), 157-159 striation bands of, 130 nerve (see Neurons) fast
Filaments
parallel vs. series,
128 passive stretch of, 153 Elasticity, 128, 129. 159
197, 207
percapsular, 196
excita-
of receptors, 180-181
1
196,
muscle
tory)
-secretion Elastic
156
Excitation of muscle, 130, 134, 144, 151 of nerve, 162, 164-165, 166
gamma
195,
intracapsular, 196
the vertical floater, 110, 111
in synaptic inhibition, 173, 175
Dynamics,
intrafusal,
in,
EPP (see Potential, endplate) EPSP (see Potential, postsynaptic,
static (floating),
Dendrites, 161, 162, 163, 168, 170, 176, 189
Dynamic
111
153 positive work, 151
visual feedback,
Dale-Feldberg law, 171 Degrees of freedom at joints, 3
inhibition,
Feedforward, 174
over a minimal base, 109-110 neutral, 108 potential energy and, 107-108 Stable, 107
225 muscle belly, 225
coordination of arms and legs, 225 174 positive, 164, 204, 212 spindle, 204 visual use in learning water ballet skills, in
over a changing base, 110
effect of pressure over bone,
on action of
libers,
dynamic
Cutaneous reflexes
Drug
slow muscle
dynamic
227 contribution to specific reflexes, 211 in equilibrium, 212 in righting reflexes, 211, 212 morphology of, 210 reflexes of, 211, 212, 224, 231
effect of pressure over
in fast vs.
159 Energy. 81-83 conservation of (law), 81 kinetic, 81 potential, 81 related to equilibrium, 107-108
muscle
adenine dinucleotide)
Fascicles (fasciculi), 128, 184
external, 151
Fatigue
force-velocity relation,
slow muscle fibers, 159 of synapses, 175 Feedback, 193, 206, 207, 209, 219, 223, 225, 231 cutaneous in timing of performance, 225
eccentric contraction, 151 in isometric contraction, 151 in isotonic contraction, 151
in fast vs.
racilitative
from joint receptors, 224 Irom joint receptors, importance
in
155-156
in
internal, 151
mathematical composition, solu92-93 resolution of, 88-89 biceps, mathematical solution, 95 graphical, 89, 90 parallel,
tion,
Index Peace coupler, Force velocit) curs g
vv
96,
in iioi^i
magnitude
o!
relation
Golgi tendon effect on. 224
organ
delayed,
reset,
Gamma Gamma
in,
reciprocal.
224
acid
(GABA),
171
202, 203, 204, 205, 219, 226,
motor (fusimotar)
neurons
(see
138
metabolism
of,
by biological oxidation.
Glycogen. 137, muscle, 137
in
muscle
in
post-tetanic
167.
194.
neurons
of.
shape of planet. 85-86 universal, law of. 85 variation with altitude and latitude, 86 Gravity boards. 104 Gravity distance (table!. 239 GTO (see Golgi tendon organ) of.
54
Half-relaxation time, 150
Heat in
heat:
muscle.
138-139 shortening,
activiation.
relaxation. 138 recover,- heat. 138-139
Meromyosin, heavy
uniaxial, 3 fibers,
164-165 159
vertical, 19, 8, 9, 10
movements, 6-27 abduction-adduction, 12-15
Joint
potential. 162-164
165-
15-16 15-16
at the shoulder, 15,
of fingers
131,
162,
163,
164,
in action potential generation,
and
toes, 15
at acromioclavicular joints, 27 165,
164-165
in excitation-contraction coupling, 140
potential, 162-164
in recovery of resting potential,
165-
166
at sternoclavicular joints
elevation-depression, 24, 25-26 protraction-retraction, 24, 26
circumduction, 15, 17 flexion, approximation of volar or ventral surfaces,
6,
12
flexion-extension,
6,
the ankle, 12, 14
coordination centers, 190 function of the neuron. 188-190 neural circuits, 189, 190-191
at
neuromuscular, function, 219
of elbow,
152
(movements of
the shoulder girdle), 24-27, 25, 26 circumduction, 27
synaptic transmission, 170
Integration
horizontal,
12
plantar
15.
and
dorsiflexion,
18 fingers
wrist,
and
toes,
12
of hip, 12, 13
of limbs, labyrinthine receptors in, 217 Intensity-duration curve, 149 Interneurons, 189 inhibitory', 172 Interoceptors, 180 IPSP (see Potential, postsynaptic, inhibi-
of shoulder, 12, 14 23-24, 24
inversion-eversion,
compromise axes for, 23, 11 movements of the scapula, 27 neutral or midposition of forearm, 20 of the axial skeleton. 20
flexion-extension,
Irradiation of impulses from joint receptors,
224
peripheral control. 194 Zone (see Striation bands)
band (see Striation bands) Immersion technique for determining
of the wrist, 9
167. 171, 172
in
column
20(13)
4, 11,
of the shoulder. 8 of the shoulder girdle, 8
172 synaptic transmission, 170
membrane
//
head). //
at the hip, 15,
sodium (Na T ),
foot 4,
of the axial skeleton (vertebral
164, 165,
in synaptic inhibition,
in
and
of the ankle
176
in relaxation, 143
in
10
19, 27, 8, 9,
of the phalanges, 9
135,
143
slow muscle
membrane
longitudinal,
multiaxial, 3
of the knee,
172
131,
tory)
I
Hypotheses, neurophysiologies! central control. 194
H
potential, 162-164
relaxation,
degrees of freedom, 3
of the elbow, 9
166
affect of
production
membrane
biaxial, 3
of the forearm, 9 of the hip, 10
in recovery of resting potential,
autogenic inhibition by. 209. 224. 231 comparison with spindle. 207. 208 examples of reflexes. 209 in voluntary movement. 209 reflexes, follow through, effect on, 224 Gradients chemical 164. 165 concentration, of ions. 165 Gravitation
Gyration, radius
131.
150
144 172
in action potential generation,
in
distinguishing characteristics. 208 effects on muscles. 208-209
16
Joint axes
and
potentiation,
143,
(CI),
in fast vs.
208
metacarpophalangeal, 3, L2 metatarsophalangeal, 3 pivot, 20 radioulnar, 20. 23, 23 shoulder (glenohumerall. .(,
131
fiber.
167, 172, 182
137
tendon organ(s) (GTO).
(see
176
144,
142,
muscle, 135-136 135-136, 144 in excitation-contraction coupling, 139-140 in excitation of muscle, 140, 144 in fast vs. slow muscle fibers, 158
in
207-209, 224. 231
HMM
135.
contraction.
magnesium (Mg* + ),
in.
12
12
wrist. 3. 12 131.
potassium (K*), 131, 162, 163,
ATP
3,
within the forearm. 20, 23, 23
159
in synaptic inhibition,
substrate synthesis of
knee,
sternoclavicular, 3 tarsometatarsal, 23
166 fibers,
calcium (Ca ++ ),
in
158
139,
oxygen debt. 138
initial
171,
Ions
chloride
Glycolysis. 137, 138, 139. 141 ATP production in. 137. 141
afferent
muscle
in relaxation,
aerobic phase. 137 138 anaerobic phase. 137
Golgi
173,
172. 2(H). 205. 217. 221
gradients.
in last
in
loop, 203, 204
Spindle innervation, efferent) Generator potential, ISO. 181, 185
in
172
in activation of
224
Glucose,
173
disinhibition, 173 recurrent (surround).
reflexes,
Ionic
bias.
172
1S3
Golgi tendon organ functions
Gamma-aminobutvnc
"I
'\
intervertebral,
sensory input, L82 action potential in, 171
postsynaptic,
155 15€
of,
Forward swing
Gamma
tendon organs, 209
in regulation ol
20.
21
lateral flexion (abduction), 20,
rotation,
20,
22
22
movements at and acromioclavic-
of the shoulder girdle (see
sternoclavicular
Joint(s)
acromioclavicular, 3 3, 12 atlantoaxial, 4
ular joints)
pronation-supination, 20-23. 23 radius, the moving bone, 23 radial and ulnar deviation of the hand
ankle.
I
seg-
mental weights, 105-106, 106 Inhibition. 223. 224. 226, 227, 231
atlantooccipital, 3
costovertebral, 3
at the wrist, 23, 24
autogenic (see also Golgi tendon organs). 209
elbow.
conscious, in motor learning, 225, 226, 231
hip, 3, 15
interphalangeal, 3
at hip, 19,
presynaptic, 173-174
intertarsal, 23
at shoulder, 19, 19
3,
12
glenohumeral
range (shoulder),
15
of,
6
medial (outward)
rotation,
(inward)
20
and
lateral
260 Joint
Index 209-210,
proprioceptors,
212,
224,
Labyrinth proprioceptors, 212-216
interconnections, 210 compression as stimulus, 209, 227, 231 contribution to kinesthetic perception,
in
neck
reflexes,
183
216-217
209 sensitivities of, 209 types of, 209, 210 locations
inertia
of,
traction as stimulus, 209, 231
from,
irradiation
receptors,
to
in-
crease contraction strength, 224 Joint types ball
and
socket, 3
Kinematic analysis, 1 Kinematic approach, 1 Kinematic chain, 4-5, 35,
4,
5
closed, 4-5, 4, 5
open, 5 Kinematics, 59
Kinematics mobility terminology (engineers), 59, 60
movement
of
momentum, 79
(Newton's
equipment used. 61
second
Kinetic analysis, 1 Kinetic analysis scales, 113-122 determination of compression forces at the acetabulum, 119-122
TMF
class, 39,
abductors and weight of
TMF
hamstrings and weight of lever, 119-121 resultant, size of forces, 121-122 determination of TMF abductors 117-119 determination of TMF hamstrings, 114— of,
113-114
Kinetic approach, 1 Knee jerk, 200-201 137, 139, 140
inhibition
225-226
anal-
4, 4,
5
Link boundaries and segmental centers of gravity, 233 (see Meromyosin, light)
line (see Striation
bands)
equilibrium reflexes, 214, 218, 231 post -rotatory movements, 214 in posture, 212,
216
labyrinthine righting reflexes, 212, 214, 215, 218, 226, 227 tonic labyrinthine reflexes (TLR), 212, 214. 217. 225. 227
187, 193, 219, 224, 225, 227
skill(s),
conscious
inhibition
labyrinthine reflexes
spindle and
synaptic inhibition
in,
conductance,
Motor
ion, 164, 165, 167
depolarization, 164
176
excitation, 166
216,
and
223 in,
membrane)
226
of,
150
slow, 186-188
"catch"
Meromyosin
(HMM), 132, (LMM), 132
218,
definition, 129, 184 fast
potential (see Potential,
in,
units, 150, 176, 184-188, 199
asynchrony of response
critical level, 164, 165, 170,
light
214,
in,
tendon organ reflexes
Motor system, 184-188
Metabolism
reflexes
223-224
active transport through, 163
heavy
of
225-226 definition, 223 feedback mechanisms and, 223 Golgi tendon organ reflexes and, 223 joint and cutaneous reflexes in, 224-225
reflexes, consciously inhibited, 225
permeability, 164
212-214
Motor
223, 231
effect of spindle reflexes on,
Membrane
semicircular canals, 214-216 acceleratory reflexes, 214
between acceleration of gravity, time, velocity and length of drop, 53
relation
neck reflexes in, 225 preparatory movements effect of Golgi tendon organ reflexes on, 223
Mass, 85
location, 212, 213
212, 213
deceleration, 52
225
Local excitatory state, 164, 165 Local sign, 212, 231
Maximal body length, 153 Mechanical advantage, 40
utricles,
constant acceleration due to gravity,
Motor endplates(s), 158 Motor learning, 193, 219, Motor nerve, 150
in body, 3-4, 4
in integration of limbs, 217
of.
49
acceleration, 52
rotatory, 49
conservation of (law), 79
Labyrinth(s)
re-
43
while standing on toes, 43, 44 Linear forces, definition, 86, 87 Linear momentum, 54, 55 Linear movement, rotational and, ogies between, 56, 55 Link(s), 3-4
M of,
tonic, 225
morphology
linear,
translatory, 49
in quiet standing,
137
Labyrinthine reflexes, 225 skills,
angular, 49, 51 curvilinear, 49
velocity, 52
LMM
Krebs cycle (see also Metabolism, muscle) of,
Motion
rectilinear, 49
Leverage
joint axes and,
coenzymes
40
third class, 39, 40
117 gravity line, location
resistance arm), 39
body, 43-45 when muscular tension becomes a sistance, 45
122
lever, 121
motor
arm and
in the
direction of resultant,
of, 139 arms, 41, 42 in body, 42 muscle, 42, 44, 45 short, advantages and disadvantages, 45-48 Moment of force, 39, 41, 54 Moment of inertia, 54 Momentum, 78-81 absorption of, 78-79 application of force and changes in, 78 change per unit time effect of, 78-79 conservation of, 79-81 conservation of (law), 79 receiving a force, effect of time consumed on, 78-79
regulation
52-53
parts (effort
of football punt, 60
cycle, 137, 140
Moment
77
first),
47
analysis, 59-63
data required, 59
in
Krebs
oxidative, 130, 159
lengthened by implement, 45, 47 lengthened by implement, suitable size and weight of, 48 shortening to decrease length of RMA, 48 shortening to increase speed of movement, 48 brachioradialis as effort in a seond or third class lever, 43-44, 45 first class, 39, 40 long, advantages and disadvantages, 45,
plane, 3
glycolysis, 137, 138, 139, 141
of mass, 79
body-
pivot, 3
from
momentum, 54
of angular
electron transport system (ETS), 137, 141
of energy, 81
77, 78 motion, Newton's, 77-78 universal gravitation, 85 Length-tension phenomenon (see Tension, tension-length relationship) Lengthening reaction, 202 Leverts), 39
hinge, 3
from
third), 77
mass and acceleration (Newton's second),
reflexes of, 209, 210, 226, 231
Joint
anaerobic, 137
and reaction (Newton's
conservation conservation conservation conservation
supporting reaction, 209
in signaling joint-position, 211
182,
aerobic, 137
225
Law(s) of action
167,
217, 218, 225
of,
in sport skills,
210
receptors,
muscle
examples
afferent
in positive
glucose (see also Glycolysis), 136-137
reflexes
225, 227
mechanism
in
homogeneity of composition 135, 142, 143, 144
motor
slow
units, 187
187
recruitment order types of, 187-188
of,
188
of,
186,
/t)Ui'\
not all-or none. 1S4 185, L86 response characteristics of, 185 186
secondary (compression stabilising and decompression dislocation), B9 where applied while or shortening lengthening, 36 36
129. 184
i
Movement
59 69
analysis
data required, 58 extremity m football punt. •
tn>
61
by
affected
from
Movement, voluntary,
191, 193, 194
884 Golgi tendon organ spindle innervation velocity of,
33,
187, 188,
biceps brachii. 127. 128 crureus. 1ST
of
attachment
moment arm,
158-159, 187.
peri merit >.
ex-
-
fibers.
157-159
fibers,
classification into three types.
159 correlation of his-
differences:
and chemical with physio-
tological
logical characteristics.
Muscle moment arms factors which affect length hip and knee, 36, 38
38
sibility.
pectoralis. 128
32
(contractility,
elasticity,
disten-
of
on
levers
184
joint
effect of lengths of
moment arms on
function, 38 of. 36,
38
components, 128
Muscle
29. 89-91,
90
stretch
(external),
223 lengthening eccentric i. 35 shortening (isotonic), 35 (
Muscle force as a resistance. 36
as effort, 35-36
components rotatory. 89
effect
of.
and
227
227, 231
postural reflexes, 226, 227 responses, adjustment to
load.
229
ory), 132, 142, 153, 154, 155, 156
and
standing long jump, 227 Neuromuscular junction, 130,
134, 184, 187
of, 176, 198 motor, 143, 150, 151, 168
alpha, 129, 186, 196, 199, 209 classification
of,
by
Erlanger
and
Gasser, 129, 167, 168 cross-union and hetero-innervation
experiments, 187
gamma
(see
Spindle
innervation,
efferent)
sarcoplasmic reticulum and T system, 133-134 Muscle tension (see Tension, developed) Muscle weakness, spindle reflexes used in correction of, 224 Myelin sheath, 161, 162 Myofibrils (see Muscle structure, ultramicroscopic) Myoglobin, 129 Myosin, 131 filaments (see also Sliding filament thein contraction
scale,
in,
in,
fast vs. slow, 186, 187
myofibril striation bands, 131, 142
Muscle contraction
practice exercises
chemical transmission at, 171 Neuron(s) collateral branches of, 162, 168, 171. 174. 191, 200 recurrent, 168, 171, 173 conduction velocity, 167
Myosin) 131-133
red and white. 29 spurt and shunt. 29 tonic and phasic. 29
reflexes inhibited
driving
myofibril filaments (see also Actin
classification
Neurons,
as a specialized synapse, 176
chemical composition of fiber, 130-131 histology of fiber, 129-130 neuromuscular junction, 130 ultramicroscopic, 131-134 chemical structure of myofibrils. 131-132 myofibrils. 131-134. 139
capacity,
and
epi-
Muscle amplitude. 36 contractors and expanders, 29
muscle (see also
spindle reflexes, 226 (endo-,
microscopic, 129-131
stapedius. 127. 128
also Spindle innervation,
efferent). 196-199, 207
skeletal
226, 228,
myotendinous junction, 129 tendon function, 129
soleus. 159. 187. 188
(.see
efferent (see also Spindle innervation,
simple
128-129 arrangement, 128 fiber bundles (fasciculi), 128 fiber size, 128
sartorius. 128
Muscle components.
127
irritability),
fiber,
phasic and tonic. 29 platysma, 184
mechanics
of,
fiber! s),
penniform. 29 peroneus. .-"
tibialis anterior. 159.
(TNR), 216. 217-218. 225, 231 with head dorsiflexed, 225 with head rotation. 225 with head ventriflexed, 225
tonic
motor, alpha), 129 Neuroglia, 161 Neurokinesiological analysis dive for height
127-129
elastic
216-217
reflexes active in, 227
properties
connective-tissues perimysia), 128 of, 38,
and limb move-
of trunks
righting. 214, 215, 231
to
Muscle shortening, effect moved. 45, 35, 46 Muscle structure
interosseus. 205 multijoint. mechanics
in
207. 218
of,
ments by, 225 motor skills, 225
afferent
38
gross,
reflexes, 216 218. 225
joint receptors in,
Muscle functional excursion. 36 Muscle insufficiency, active and passive,
flexor digitorum longus. 159. 187 gastrocnemius. 127. 128. 155, 184, gluteus maximus. 127. 128
infraspinatus. 12S
dinu
afferent), 196, 197, 207
Muscle
gracilis. 1ST
adenine
Nicotinamide adenine dinu
(see
examples
counteracting or neutralizing, 31
theories regarding interconversion, 187 first lumbrical. 1S4
188
Nicotinamide
(see
Nerve supply to neuromuscular spindle
long, 33
158-159
129
ion,
cleotide phosphate)
stabilizing. 31
and hetero-innervation
crass union
M
facilitation
35
conjoint, 31
(phasic)-slow (tonic). 195
fibers,
its
LMM)
illMM,
ol i
cleotide)
Neck
joint,
synergists. 31
deltoid. 127, 128
two
bony promi-
passage of tendon or muscle over bony prominences, 32 33, 33, 34 antagonists, 30 fixators. 32 movers, 30 prime movers. 30 stabilization vs. fixation, 32
antigravity-postural. 29
fast
to
13,
endinoua junct
.'i
affected bj
209 in. 803 204 156-156, 209 in,
Muscles) abdominal.
\l\
NADP distance
affected bv length of
ballistic. 283,
i
NAD
Muscle function, 29 32 affected bj attachment nences, 32
sca'u
usefulness, 64
ubunita
stretch, 142-143
in the myofibril, 132
in muscle stimulation, 150, 203, 204 phasic vs. tonic, 186, 187 pool(s), 184, 219 role in determining properties of motor units, 186-187 sensory, 129, 161 classification of, by Lloyd, 167, 168
Neuropil, 168
Nicotinamide adenine dinucleotide (NAD), 137
Nicotinamide adenine dinucleotide phosphate (NADP), 137 Nociceptors, 180
Norepinephrine (Nor-E), 171
262
Index labyrinthine (see Labyrinthine proprioceptors) muscle (see Spindle, neuromuscular and Golgi tendon organs)
Occlusion, 175 Oligodendrocytes, 161 Oscillation
damping in
201, 202, 212
of,
muscle, 150
Overlap (of muscle filaments), 135,
153, 154
in contraction,
PSP
142-143
Q l0 Parallel forces, definition, 86.
,
definition, 157
Quick Quick
righting (see Righting reflexes) (mvotatic), 201, 224, 226, 231
release, 148, 159
stretch
stretch, 148
Quiet standing, electromyogram
87
Perception sensory, 182, 183-184
"Phantom limb" phenomenon, 184 Positive supporting reaction, 205-207, 209
Planes of body, 6
Receptors) afferent neurons
63
as,
istry of) 143
cells, 179,
classification of, 179-180
180
Renshaw
cutaneous (see also Cutaneous proprioceptors), 210-212
7
PMA (see Projection moment arm)
Refractory period(s) of muscle, 150 of nerve, 166, 172 Relaxation, 127, 143-144, 147, 150, 231 chemistry of, 143-144 physical changes in, 143 Relaxing factor (see also Relaxation, chem-
179
midsagittal,
7
227,
half-relaxation time, 150
frontal (coronal), 6, 7
6,
of,
Radial acceleration, 57 Radian, 56 Radius of gyration, 54 Ranvier, nodes of, 161
kinesthetic, 204, 210, 225
transverse,
reaction, 212
209, 227, 231
24
6,
magnet
neck (see Neck reflexes)
postural (attitudinal), 212, 216, 226
Pacinian corpuscles, 183, 209, 210 Pain, 166, 167, 183 5,
227
labyrinthine, 210, 214, 218, 231
(see Potential, postsynaptic)
debt, 138
Pelvic girdle,
226-227
visual, joint,
placing reactions, 211, 212, 231 positive supporting reaction, 205-207,
132, 142, 143, 154
double, 142, 143, 153 single, 135, 143 153 Overt tension (see Tension, developed)
Oxygen
neck (see Neck reflexes) Pseudo-H zone (see also Striation bonds),
tonic labyrinthine, 227
cells, 171,
174
inhibition by, 173, 186
Response(s)
Post-tetanic potentiation (PTP) muscle, 150 synaptic, 175
definition. 179
all-or-none
Goldi tendon organs (see Golgi tendon
Potential
joint (see also Joint proprioceptors). 167,
motor unit, 184-185, 186 muscle, 147, 185 nerve, 168 conditioned in skills, 219, 223, 226, 231 of gamma neurons, 204 jerk, 200-201, 205 phasic (of spindle), 182, 195, 196, 197, 198, 199 examples of, 200-201
organs)
action, 151, 161, 162, 165, 170
conduction
in
of,
neurons,
166,
174 generation of. in neurons, 164, 165 in muscle, 134, 144 in T tubules, 140, 144 local, graded, in slow muscle fibers, 158 sodium theory of, 164 endplate (EPPK 176 equilibrium, 163 generator, 180, 181, 185
membrane,
labyrinthine (see Labyrinth proprioceptors)
neck (see neck reflexes) neuromuscular spindles neuromuscular) physiology of, 180-182
postural, 201 stretch, 153, 224
sensitivity
Primary movement objective of accuracy, 224 objective of strong force, 224
moment
88
ceptors)
negative aspects, 225 Proprioceptive system, dependency on, during water ballet skills, 111 Proprioceptors, 180, 194, 211 classification of, 194 conditioned responses in motor skills, 231
Cutaneous
propriocep-
tors)
of,
neck, 214, 215, 226, 227, 231 visual, 214, 215, 226, 227, 231
Receptor potential, 180. 181
Rigor. 138
Recruitment of motor units, 184
RNA
self regulating control of, 231
proprioceptors)
(see Ribonucleic acid)
Rope climbing, 36, 37 Rotational movement, 54-56
188
of sensory neurons, 181
Reflexes and synaptic inhibition of, 226 conscious inhibition of, in motor
skills.
225-226 equilibrium, 210, 214, 218, 231 extensor thrust, 207, 211, 227, 231
angular acceleration, 54 angular motion, 54 angular velocity, 54 linear and. analogies between, 56, 55 moment of force in, 54 moment of inertia, 54 torque in, 54
flexion (withdrawal), 211
Sarcolemma,
grasp, 212, 231
Sarcomere, 130,
in
motor
201
Ribonucleic acid (RNA), 134 Righting reflexes, 210, 211, 214, 215 body-on-body, 212, 214, 215, 231 body-on-head, 212, 214, 215, 231
Reciprocal inhibition, 30
of,
of,
vibration, 201
labyrinthine, 212, 214, 215, 216, 226, 227
179-180
extensor thrust, 227 226-227
129, 130, 134, 139, 144, 161 139,
140,
in
in stretched muscle, 142
labyrinthine, 226-227
of muscle fiber, 130 of myofibril, 142. 143
list of,
231
response, 227 stretch, 227
143,
153,
contracted muscle, 142-143
joint,
labyrinthine head righting, 227
142,
154, 155
skills
neck righting, 226, 227 neck righting, body following head
definition, 194
feedback, joim
179
68
Proprioceptive reflexes (see also Proprio-
(see
of,
types
of muscle fibers, 157
forces, finding
moment arm (PMA).
structure
order
in force analysis
equilibrium force (necessary arm), finding of, 88
cutaneous
167,
Cutaneous propriocep183, 210-212
anatomical basis, 182-183
receptor, 180, 181
of,
example also.
of sensory perception, 183-184
excitatory (EPSP), 171, 172, 174 inhibitory (IPSP), 172
Projection
(see tors),
165-166
two or more
tonic (of spindle), 182, 195, 197, 198, 199
181
specificity of, 182-183
postsynaptic (PSP), 169, 170
resultant of
of,
range, 183
resting, 162, 164, 169
Problems met
Spindles.
potential. 180, 181
165, 169, 170
of,
(see
sense organs, 178, 189
skin
ionic distribution in, 162-164
recovery
209-210
182, 183, 161,
Sacroplasmic
reticulum,
132-134,
140,
143, 144
differences from endoplasmic reticulum,
133 function
of,
140
263
Index contraction coupling,
in excitation
149 in fast \s slew muscle fibers. L58 Scalar quantity. 51
139
.uul
phasic
examples
159
dynamic
movement anahsis
of,
cells.
161
Segment, body,
4
body weight accord to somatotyp, of
IS
ins;
ntal mass, r egression equations determining
for
cntal velocities factors
determine
which
sequence
of
angular displacements of segments
of,
199, 207, 223,
198,
Si nai ion
231
in
index, L96, 200
functions
of,
joint actions
involved
of force exerted by. 105
tdavers, 235
Sensation (see also Perception). 182. 183184
Sensory input. 223 control by presynaptic inhibition. 174 regulation of. 181-182
summation
of,
181
threshold. 181
Sensory system. 179-184 Sensory unit. 180 Shortening reaction. 209 Skill(s).
Skin,
motor (see Motor
proprioceptors proprioceptors)
of
skills)
(see
Cutaneous
Sliding filament theory. 142-143 relation to tension-length curve,
Sodium pump.
154
Soma, neuron. 161 Specific gravity of
body segments. 237
Spindle(s)
207 innervation afferent (see Spindle innervation, afferent)
129,
in,
efferent (see Spindle innervation, efi
intrafusal fibers. 195, 196. 197. 207
bag. 195
chain. 195. 196 significance of tvpe of contraction in,
198-199 of.
205-207
neuromuscular. 129. 167. 182, 186, 194207. 209 structure. 195-196 duality of. 195. 196. 197, 209 tandem. 196
of inadequate stimuli, 165 spatial, 172, 175
synaptic, 175
temporal, 172, 175 unnecessary at neuromuscular junction, 176 Synapse(s) facilitation at, 171-172, 173 function of, 169-176 inhibition at, 172-174 properties of, 174-176 after-discharge, 175
nonlinearity of response, 175 polarity, 175
Spindle reflexes adjustment to load phasic response of primary afferents. 226 simple responses in, 226
summation, 175 synaptic delay, 174 threshold, 175 receptive site, 168, 170 structure of, 168, 169 subsynaptic membrane of, 168 transmission at, 169-171
motor skills back swing, 223, 226
forward swing, 223, 226 preparatory movements, 223 Spindle secondary afferents, decreased sensitivity of. 224 Spindle sensitivity, enhancement of, 223
types
Spindle innervation, afferent, 196, 199-201, 201-202. 207 of intrafusal fibers. 197. 207
173
electrical, 169
excitation-secretion coupling
in, 169 transmitter substance(s), 162. 169, 170171, 181 action upon subsynaptic membrane. 170 chemical, types of, 170-171
stabilized joints, 63
64
1
Steady state, in slow muscle fibers, 159 Stimulation (stimulus), 147-151 adequate, adequacy of, 148, 150 frequency of (see also Stimulation, repetitive), 150-151 effect upon muscle response, 150 in post-tetanic potentiation, 150 normal, in living animal, 150 repetitive, 149-151 muscle response to, 149-151 single pulse, 147-149 all-or-none response to, 147 characteristics of, 148-149 twitch response to, 147, 148-149 Stretch. 127, 152, 223
upon muscle
fiber striation bands.
142 effect
of, 168, 169,
Synaptic transmission, 162, 169-171 action of drugs on, 173, 175
data required, 63 scale, 63
effect
libers, 158
1
Subneural apparatus, 130 Substrate synthesis (see also Glycolysis). 137
204
vs. static, 198, 199,
of,
slow muscle
of input, 181
and pharmacological distinctions between. 197-198 neural circuits of, 199, 200, 203 innervation of intrafusal fibers, 197, 207 role of. in voluntary movement, 203-204
Statics.
fasl VS.
12 Stretched muscle, of muscle fiber. 130 of myofibril, 131, 136 Subcortical mechanisms, 194, 223
196,
electrical use of, 147
beta. 199. 205
instances of activity location of. 194-195
neurons,
204 effects on phasic acid tonic responses of spindles. 198, 199, 200 fast vs. slow, 197-198 types of, anatomical, physiological,
usefulness
comparison with Golgi tendon organs.
ferent
m
Static analysis
163, 165
bands
contraction, 142 L43 moderate, 112 L43
in excitation contraction coupling, 140
definition. 186
in
fibers to,
Summation, 184
202-204
conditioned response
dynamic
muscle
super-contracted, 143
197, 207. 223
methodology optimal sequence. 72, 74 value of determining. 72-74 Segmental weighus) immersion technique for determining. 105-106. 106 mathematical determination of. 106
moment
of,
(fusimotor)
slow
in
201 202
significance of, questions regarding. 204 196-199, Spindle innervation, efferent, 202 203. 205 by beta axons, 199, 205 effect upon primary afferent response to
gamma
72
t.i^t
strong, 143
stretch. 202
of, t>4
of
159
200 201
projection to cerebral cortex. 204 secondary, 196, 198, 201 202. 204, 205, 207. 224. 231
functions
in projectile skills
analysis
response, 153, 224
223,
Functions of, 199 201 neural circuits of. 2(H). 203
ol 63, 63
static analysis of, 63
Schwann
L99,
sensitivity
primary, 196,
Scale
responses,
tonic
23]
;
upon muscle response, 152-154
Dale-Feldberg law, 171 in autonomic nervous system, 171 quantal release of, 169, 172, 176 Synergy, 30-31
T
T
tubules,
system (see also Triads),
132-134 in excitation-contraction coupling, 140 in excitation of muscle, 144 Tangential acceleration, 57-58 Telodendria, neural, 161, 162, 163, 168 Tendon, 128, 129, 150 Tension developed (overt), 147. 148, 150, 155, 156
active state contractile effect of elastic
in, 147,
148
components
in. 147,
components
in.
147. 148, 149
in eccentric vs. isometric
and
internal, 197, 202
contraction, 152 influence of velocity upon, 156
passive, 129, 153
rate of
external, 197, 223, 227
148
muscle length on, 153
development
of, 156,
isotonic
159
264
Index
continued of, to muscle length. 152-154 elastic (see also Elastic components),
Tension
relation
147, 148, 153
Training, 157, 187
length relationship, 152-154. 223
curve
of, 153,
(transducers), 179, 181, Transduction 209 Transmitter substance (see Synaptic trans-
154, 159
153 optimal length, 153, 224 sliding filament theory in, 154 initial length, 152,
mission, transmitter substance) Transverse tubules (see T tubules) Tremor. 150 Triads (see also Sarcoplasmic reticulum). 133, 139-140
movement, 30 muscle, 128, 129, 142, 151 definition, 151
gradations of, 185 in shortening (isotonic) 155, 156 maximal. 153-154
contraction,
(tetanic
contraction),
138,
TLR
{see usee
Ton
.
Tori'-
ratio,
149,
Tonic neck
reflexes
Warm
(see also
effect
Work,
129, 134, 136. 138. 139, 151
components in. 129 equation for calculation of. 151 elastic
131,
in isotonic contraction. 151
negative, 151 output, relation to velocity, 156
Tropomyosin), 131, 132,
positive, 151
power and, 83
all-or-none, 147, 185
muscle. 138, 147. 150. 184. 185, 208
Z
seg-
on velocity of muscle
Twitch 212.
relaxa-
limb
Weight, 85
composition
144
(TLR),
up.
of
shortening. 157
(Appendix C), 241-255 Tropomyosin (see also Relaxation),
Troponin
muscle. 204, 212, 214, 223, 226 labyrinthine
Valsalva maneuver. 31 Vectors), 51 Vector quantity. 51, 155 Vertical floater. 110-111 Volumetric displacements ments. 105
-troponin system. 144 reflexes)
and
contract
response to single pulse. 147-148
tables of
reflexes)
214, 217, 218, 225
mathematical
(latent,
tion) of. 147
132, 159
150
Tonic labyrinthine
for
periods
of forces, 94
150, 185
Tetanus-twitch
Tricarboxylic acid cycle, 137 functions Trigonometric
needed
produced against resistance, 155 fttanus
Tonic neck reflexes (TNR), 212, 214, 216. 217-218, 225 examples of. 217, 218 Torque, 41, 54
line (disc) (see Striation
bands)